Yamaha RX-V2300 de handleiding

Categorie
Ontvanger
Type
de handleiding
OWNER’S MANUAL
RX-V2300
U
AV Receiver
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, USA 6660 ORANGETHORPE AVE., BUENA PARK, CALIF. 90620, U.S.A.
YAMAHA CANADA MUSIC LTD. 135 MILNER AVE., SCARBOROUGH, ONTARIO M1S 3R1, CANADA
YAMAHA ELECTRONIK EUROPA G.m.b.H. SIEMENSSTR. 22-34, 25462 RELLINGEN BEI HAMBURG, F.R. OF GERMANY
YAMAHA ELECTRONIQUE FRANCE S.A. RUE AMBROISE CROIZAT BP70 CROISSY-BEAUBOURG 77312 MARNE-LA-VALLEE CEDEX02, FRANCE
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS (UK) LTD. YAMAHA HOUSE, 200 RICKMANSWORTH ROAD WATFORD, HERTS WD1 7JS, ENGLAND
YAMAHA SCANDINAVIA A.B. J A WETTERGRENS GATA 1, BOX 30053, 400 43 VÄSTRA FRÖLUNDA, SWEDEN
YAMAHA MUSIC AUSTRALIA PTY, LTD. 17-33 MARKET ST., SOUTH MELBOURNE, 3205 VIC., AUSTRALIA
Printed in Malaysia
V958390-1
0100V2300(U)-cv1/4 02.8.9, 4:45 PM1
I CAUTION
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
Explanation of Graphical Symbols
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol,
within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert
you to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous
voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may
be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of
electric shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral
triangle is intended to alert you to the presence of
important operating and maintenance (servicing)
instructions in the literature accompanying the
appliance.
1 Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions
should be read before the product is operated.
2 Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions
should be retained for future reference.
3 Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product and in the
operating instructions should be adhered to.
4 Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions
should be followed.
5 Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before
cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners.
Use a damp cloth for cleaning.
6 Attachments – Do not use attachments not recommended
by the product manufacturer as they may cause hazards.
7 Water and Moisture – Do not use this product near water –
for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or
laundry tub; in a wet basement; or near a swimming pool;
and the like.
8 Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart,
stand, tripod, bracket, or table. The product may fall,
causing serious injury to a child or adult, and serious
damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand, tripod,
bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold
with the product. Any mounting of the product should
follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should use a
mounting accessory recommended by the manufacturer.
9 A product and cart combination should be
moved with care. Quick stops, excessive
force, and uneven surfaces may cause the
product and cart combination to overturn.
10 Ventilation – Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided
for ventilation and to ensure reliable operation of the
product and to protect it from overheating, and these
openings must not be blocked or covered. The openings
should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed,
sofa, rug, or other similar surface. This product should not
be placed in a built-in installation such as a bookcase or
rack unless proper ventilation is provided or the
manufacturer’s instructions have been adhered to.
11 Power Sources – This product should be operated only from
the type of power source indicated on the marking label. If
you are not sure of the type of power supply to your home,
consult your product dealer or local power company. For
products intended to operate from battery power, or other
sources, refer to the operating instructions.
12 Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped
with a polarized alternating current line plug (a plug having
one blade wider than the other). This plug will fit into the
power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you
are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try
reversing the plug. If the plug should still fail to fit, contact
your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not
defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug.
13 Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be
routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched
by items placed upon or against them, paying particular
attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the
point where they exit from the product.
14 Lightning – For added protection for this product during a
lightning storm, or when it is left unattended and unused for
long periods of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and
disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will prevent
damage to the product due to lightning and power-line
surges.
15 Power Lines – An outside antenna system should not be
located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other
electric light or power circuits, or where it can fall into such
power lines or circuits. When installing an outside antenna
system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching
such power lines or circuits as contact with them might be
fatal.
16 Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets, extension
cords, or integral convenience receptacles as this can result
in a risk of fire or electric shock.
17 Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects of any kind
into this product through openings as they may touch
dangerous voltage points or short-out parts that could result
in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind on
the product.
18 Servicing – Do not attempt to service this product yourself
as opening or removing covers may expose you to
dangerous voltage or other hazards. Refer all servicing to
qualified service personnel.
19 Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the
wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel
under the following conditions:
a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged,
b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into
the product,
c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water,
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
CAUTION
0101V2300_Cau_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM2
SAFETY INSTRUCTIONSIMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
CAUTION II
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE : DO NOT MODIFY THIS
UNIT!
This product, when installed as indicated in the
instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC
requirements. Modifications not expressly approved
by Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the
FCC, to use the product.
2. IMPORTANT : When connecting this product to
accessories and/or another product use only high
quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this
product MUST be used. Follow all installation
instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void
your FCC authorization to use this product in the USA.
3. NOTE : This product has been tested and found to
comply with the requirements listed in FCC
Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices.
Compliance with these requirements provides a
reasonable level of assurance that your use of this
product in a residential environment will not result in
harmful interference with other electronic devices.
This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and,
if not installed and used according to the instructions
found in the users manual, may cause interference
harmful to the operation of other electronic devices.
Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee
that interference will not occur in all installations. If
this product is found to be the source of interference,
which can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and
“ON”, please try to eliminate the problem by using one
of the following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being
affected by the interference.
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit
breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient
the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon
lead, change the lead-in to coaxial type cable.
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory
results, please contact the local retailer authorized to
distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the
appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Electronics
Corp., U.S.A. 6660 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA
90620.
The above statements apply ONLY to those products
distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its
subsidiaries.
EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING
MAST
GROUND
CLAMP
ANTENNA
LEAD IN
WIRE
ANTENNA
DISCHARGE UNIT
(NEC SECTION 81020)
GROUNDING CONDUCTORS
(NEC SECTION 81021)
GROUND CLAMPS
POWER SERVICE GROUNDING
ELECTRODE SYSTEM
(NEC ART 250. PART H)
ELECTRIC
SERVICE
EQUIPMENT
NEC
NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE
FCC INFORMATION (for US customers)
Note to CATV system installer:
This reminder is provided to call the CATV system
installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC that
provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular,
specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the
grounding system of the building, as close to the point of
cable entry as practical.
d) If the product does not operate normally by following
the operating instructions. Adjust only those controls
that are covered by the operating instructions as an
improper adjustment of other controls may result in
damage and will often require extensive work by a
qualified technician to restore the product to its normal
operation,
e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any
way, and
f) When the product exhibits a distinct change in
performance - this indicates a need for service.
20 Replacement Parts – When replacement parts are
required, be sure the service technician has used
replacement parts specified by the manufacturer or have
the same characteristics as the original part.
Unauthorized substitutions may result in fire, electric
shock, or other hazards.
21 Safety Check – Upon completion of any service or
repairs to this product, ask the service technician to
perform safety checks to determine that the product is in
proper operating condition.
22 Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The unit should be mounted
to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the
manufacturer.
23 Heat – The product should be situated away from heat
sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other
products (including amplifiers) that produce heat.
24 Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside antenna or
cable system is connected to the product, be sure the
antenna or cable system is grounded so as to provide some
protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges.
Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA
70, provides information with regard to proper grounding of
the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in
wire to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding
conductors, location of antenna discharge unit, connection
to grounding electrodes, and requirements for the
grounding electrode.
0101V2300_Cau_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM3
1 To assure the finest performance, please read this manual
carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference.
2 Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean
place — away from direct sunlight, heat sources, vibration,
dust, moisture, and/or cold. Allow ventilation space of at
least 30 cm on the top, 20 cm on the left and right, and
20 cm on the back of this unit.
3 Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances,
motors, or transformers to avoid humming sounds.
4 Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from
cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in a environment with
high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent
condensation inside this unit, which may cause an electrical
shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
5 Avoid installing this unit where foreign object may fall onto
this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to liquid dripping
or splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place:
Other components, as they may cause damage and/or
discoloration on the surface of this unit.
Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire,
damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and liquid
may cause electrical shock to the user and/or damage to
this unit.
6 Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain,
etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If the temperature
inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit,
and/or personal injury.
7 Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections
are complete.
8 Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat,
possibly causing damage.
9 Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords.
10 When disconnecting the power cord from the wall outlet,
grasp the plug; do not pull the cord.
11 Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might
damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth.
12 Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this
unit with a higher voltage than specified is dangerous and
may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.
YAMAHA will not be held responsible for any damage
resulting from use of this unit with a voltage other than
specified.
13 To prevent damage by lightning, disconnect the power cord
from the wall outlet during an electrical storm.
14 Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified
YAMAHA service personnel when any service is needed.
The cabinet should never be opened for any reasons.
15 When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time
(i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power plug from the wall
outlet.
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.
16 Be sure to read the “TROUBLESHOOTING” section on
common operating errors before concluding that this unit is
faulty.
17 Before moving this unit, press STANDBY/ON to set this
unit in the standby mode, and disconnect the AC power plug
from the wall outlet.
18 VOLTAGE SELECTOR (For China and General models
only)
The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit
must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE plugging
into the AC main supply.
Voltages are 110/120/220/240 V AC, 50/60 Hz.
WARNING
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK,
DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
This unit is not disconnected from the AC power source as
long as it is connected to the wall outlet, even if this unit
itself is turned off. This state is called the standby mode. In
this state, this unit is designed to consume a very small
quantity of power.
FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS
To prevent electric shock, match wide blade of plug to
wide slot and fully insert.
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian
ICES-003.
IMPORTANT
Please record the serial number of this unit in the
space below.
MODEL:
Serial No.:
The serial number is located on the rear of the unit.
Retain this Owner’s Manual in a safe place for future
reference.
III CAUTION
We Want You Listening For A Lifetime
YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer
Electronics Group want you to get the most out of your equipment
by playing it at a safe level. One that lets the sound come through
loud and clear without annoying blaring or distortion – and, most
importantly, without affecting your sensitive hearing.
Since hearing damage from loud sounds is often
undetectable until it is too late, YAMAHA and the
Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer
Electronics Group recommend you to avoid
prolonged exposure from excessive volume levels.
0101V2300_Cau_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM4
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
1
CONTENTS
ADVANCED OPERATION
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ................... 43
Control Area ............................................................ 43
Setting the Manufacturer Code ............................... 44
Learn Feature .......................................................... 45
Changing the Source Name in the Display
Window ............................................................... 46
Using the Macro Feature ......................................... 47
Clearing Learned Functions, Macros, Renamed
Source Names, and Setup Manufacturer Codes .. 49
Clearing a Learned Function ................................... 50
Each Component Control Area ............................... 52
SET MENU ........................................................... 57
Adjusting the Items on the SET MENU ................. 57
1 SPEAKER SET (speaker mode settings) ............ 58
2 LOW FRQ TEST ................................................ 61
3 L/R BALANCE (balance of the left and right
main speakers)..................................................... 62
4 HP TONE CTRL (headphone tone control) ........ 62
5 CENTER GEQ (center graphic equalizer) .......... 62
6 INPUT RENAME ............................................... 63
7 I/O ASSIGNMENT ............................................. 63
8 INPUT MODE (initial input mode) .................... 64
9 PARAM. INI (parameter initialization) .............. 65
10LFE LEVEL ........................................................ 65
11D-RANGE (dynamic range) ............................... 65
12SP DELAY .......................................................... 66
13DISPLAY SET .................................................... 67
14MEMORY GUARD ............................................ 67
156CH INPUT SET ................................................ 68
16ZONE2 SET ........................................................ 68
ADJUSTING THE LEVEL OF THE EFFECT
SPEAKERS ....................................................... 69
SLEEP TIMER ..................................................... 70
Setting the Sleep Timer ........................................... 70
Canceling the Sleep Timer ...................................... 70
ZONE 2 (FOR U.S.A., CANADA AND
AUSTRALIA MODELS) ................................ 71
ZONE 2 Connections .............................................. 71
Remote Control in ZONE 2 .................................... 72
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM PARAMETER
EDITING .......................................................... 73
What Is a Sound field? ............................................ 73
Sound Field Program Parameters ............................ 73
Changing Parameter Settings .................................. 74
Resetting a Parameter to the Factory-set Value ....... 74
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER
DESCRIPTIONS .............................................. 75
TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................... 79
GLOSSARY .......................................................... 84
SPECIFICATIONS .............................................. 86
INTRODUCTION
CONTENTS ............................................................ 1
FEATURES ............................................................. 2
GETTING STARTED ............................................ 3
Checking the Package Contents ................................ 3
Installing Batteries in the Remote Control ................ 3
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS ......................... 4
Front Panel ................................................................ 4
Remote Control ......................................................... 6
Using the Remote Control ......................................... 7
Front Panel Display ................................................... 8
Rear Panel ................................................................. 9
PREPARATION
SPEAKER SETUP ............................................... 10
Speakers to Be Used ................................................ 10
Speaker Placement .................................................. 10
Connecting the Speakers ......................................... 11
CONNECTIONS .................................................. 14
Before Connecting Components ............................. 14
Connecting Video Components ............................... 14
Connecting Audio Components .............................. 17
Connecting the Antennas ......................................... 19
Connecting to an External Amplifier ...................... 20
Connecting to the 6CH INPUT Jacks ..................... 20
Connecting the Power Supply Cords ...................... 21
Turning on the Power .............................................. 22
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY (OSD) .......................... 23
OSD Modes ............................................................. 23
Selecting the OSD Mode ......................................... 23
SPEAKER MODE SETTINGS .......................... 24
Summary of SPEAKER SET Items 1A through
1G ........................................................................ 24
ADJUSTING THE SPEAKER OUTPUT
LEVELS ............................................................ 25
Before You Begin .................................................... 25
Using the Test Tone (TEST DOLBY SUR.) ........... 25
BASIC OPERATION
BASIC PLAYBACK ............................................. 27
Input Modes and Indications ................................... 29
Selecting a Sound Field Program ............................ 30
Selecting PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC or
Neo: 6 .................................................................. 31
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING
(DSP) ................................................................. 33
Understanding Sound Fields ................................... 33
Hi-Fi DSP Programs ............................................... 33
CINEMA-DSP ........................................................ 33
Straight Decode ....................................................... 34
Sound Field Effect ................................................... 34
Features of DSP Programs ...................................... 35
Table of Program Names for Each Input Format .... 37
TUNING ................................................................ 38
Automatic and Manual Tuning ................................ 38
Presetting Stations ................................................... 39
Tuning in to a Preset Station ................................... 41
Exchanging Preset Stations ..................................... 41
BASIC RECORDING .......................................... 42
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM1
2
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, and the double-D symbol are trademarks
of Dolby Laboratories.
“DTS”, “DTS-ES Extended Surround” and “Neo: 6” are
trademarks of Digital Theater System, Inc.
FEATURES
Built-in 6-Channel Power Amplifier
Minimum RMS Output Power
(0.04% THD, 20 Hz – 20 kHz, 8)
Main: 110 W + 110 W
Center: 110 W
Rear: 110 W + 110 W
Rear center: 110 W
Multi-Mode Digital Sound Field
Processing
Dolby Pro Logic/Dolby Pro Logic Decoder
Dolby Digital/Dolby Digital EX Decoder
DTS/DTS ES Matrix 6.1, Discrete 6.1, DTS
Neo: 6 Decoder
CINEMA DSP: Combination of YAMAHA DSP
Technology and Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital
or DTS
Virtual CINEMA DSP
SILENT CINEMA DSP
Sophisticated AM/FM Tuner
40-Station Random Access Preset Tuning
Automatic Preset Tuning
Preset Station Shifting Capability (Preset
Editing)
Other Features
192-kHz/24-bit D/A Converter
“SET MENU” which Provides You with 14 Items
for Optimizing This Unit for Your Audio/Video
System
Test Tone Generator for Easier Speaker Balance
Adjustment
6-Channel External Decoder Input for Other
Future Formats
BASS EXTENSION Button for Reinforcing
Bass Response
On Screen Display Function Helpful in
Controlling This Unit
S Video Signal Input/Output Capability
Component Video Input/Output Capability
Video Signal Conversion (S Video Composite
Video) Capability for Monitor Out
Optical and Coaxial Digital Audio Signal Jacks
Sleep Timer
Remote Control with Preset Manufacturer Codes
and “Learning” Macro Capability
PROCESSOR DIRECT for no alteration of the
original signal
Custom Installation Facility (U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models only)
y indicates a tip for your operation.
Some operations can be performed by using either the buttons on the main unit or on the remote control. In cases when the button
names differ between the main unit and the remote control, the button name on the remote control is given in parentheses in this
manual.
This manual is printed prior to production. Design and specifications are subject to change in part for the purpose of the improvement
in operativity and others. In this case the product has priority.
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 2002.10.16, 11:422
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
3
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
PARAMETER
SET MENU
EFFECT
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AU X
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
Installing Batteries in the Remote
Control
1 Open the battery compartment cover.
2 Insert three supplied batteries (R6) in the
correct direction by aligning the + and –
marks on the batteries with the polarity
markings (+ and –) on the inside of the
battery compartment.
3 After new batteries are correctly inserted,
press the RESET button in the battery
compartment using a ball point pen or
similar object. (This does not clear the
contents of the memory.)
4 Replace the cover as pressing until it snaps
into place.
Notes on batteries
Change all of the batteries if you notice the condition
like; the operating range of the remote control
decreases, the indicator does not flash or its light
becomes dim.
Do not use old batteries together with new ones.
Do not use different types of batteries (such as alkaline
and manganese batteries) together. Read the packaging
carefully as these different types of batteries may have
the same shape and color.
If the batteries have leaked, dispose of them
immediately. Avoid touching the leaked material or
letting it come into contact with clothing, etc. Clean
the battery compartment thoroughly before installing
new batteries.
If the remote control is without batteries for more than
3 minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the
remote control, the contents of the memory may be
cleared. When the memory is cleared, insert new
batteries, set up the manufacturer code and program
any acquired functions that may have been cleared.
AM loop antenna
Indoor FM antenna
(Australia model only)
Indoor FM antenna
(U.S.A., Canada, China and
General models only)
Batteries (3) (R6)
Remote control
GETTING STARTED
Checking the Package Contents
Check your package to make sure it has the following items.
Power Cord
(U.S.A., and Canada models
only)
RESET button
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM3
4
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CD–R
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
D–TV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
V–AUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
PRESET
/TUNING
EDIT
MEMORY
MAN'L/AUTO FM
TUNING
MODE
AUTO/MAN'L MONO
FM/AM
1 32 45 6 7
8
90 w
e
r
q
t
y
u
d
s
opai
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
Front Panel
1 STANDBY/ON
Turns on and sets this unit in the standby mode. When
you turn on this unit, you will hear a click and there will
be a 4 to 5-second delay before this unit can reproduce
sound.
Standby mode
In this mode, this unit consumes a small amount of
power to receive infrared-signals from the remote
control.
2 6CH (INPUT)
Selects the source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks.
The source selected by pressing 6CH (INPUT) takes
priority over the source selected with INPUT (or the input
selector buttons on the remote control).
3 INPUT selector
Selects the input source you want to listen to or watch.
4 (INPUT) MODE
Sets the priority for the types of input signals (AUTO,
DTS, ANALOG) to receive when one component is
connected to two or more input jacks of this unit (see
page 31). Priority cannot be set when 6CH INPUT is
selected as the input source.
5 Remote control sensor
Receives signals from the remote control.
6 Front panel display
Shows information about the operational status of this
unit.
7 VOLUME
Controls the output level of all audio channels.
This does not affect the REC OUT level.
8 SPEAKERS A/B
Turn on or off the set of main speakers connected to the A
and/or B terminals on the rear panel at each time its
corresponding button is pressed.
9 BASS EXTENSION
Turns on or off the BASS EXTENSION function at each
time the button is pressed, this feature boosts the bass
frequency of the left and right main channels by +6 dB
(60 Hz) while maintaining overall tonal balance. This
boost is useful if you do not use a subwoofer.
0 PROCESSOR DIRECT
Turns on or off the PROCESSOR DIRECT function at
each time the button is pressed. When this is on, BASS,
TREBLE, and BASS EXTENSION are bypassed,
eliminating any alteration of the original signal.
(U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models)
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 8/21/02, 12:15 PM4
5
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
D
I
G
I
T
A
L
N
A
T
U
R
A
L
S
O
U
N
D
A
V
R
E
C
E
I
V
E
R
R
X
-
V
1
3
0
0
To open, press gently on the lower part of the panel.
q REC OUT/ZONE 2 (U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models)
Selects the source you want to direct to the audio/video
recorder and ZONE 2 outputs independent of the source
you are listening to or watching in the main room. When
set to the SOURCE/REMOTE position, the input source
is directed to all outputs.
REC OUT
Selects the source you want to direct to the audio/video
recorder independent of the source you are listening to or
watching. When set to the SOURCE/REMOTE position,
the input source is directed to all outputs.
w STEREO/EFFECT
Switches the normal stereo or DSP effect reproduction.
When STEREO is selected, 2-channel input signals are
directed to the main left and right speakers without effect
sounds. All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals except
for the LFE channel are mixed down to the main left and
right speakers.
e A/B/C/D/E
Selects one of the 5 preset station groups (A to E).
r PROGRAM l / h
Selects the DSP program.
t PRESET/TUNING l / h
Selects preset station number 1 to 8 when the colon (:)
appears next to the band indication on the front panel
display, and selects the tuning frequency when the colon
(:) does not appear.
y PHONES jack
Outputs audio signals for private listening with
headphones. When you connect headphones, no signals
are output to the OUTPUT jacks or to the speakers.
(There is an exception depending on the 1G SP B SET
setting on the SET MENU.)
u VIDEO AUX jacks
Inputs audio and video signals from a portable external
source such as a game console. To reproduce source
signals from these jacks, select V-AUX as the input
source.
i PRESET/TUNING EDIT
Switches the function of PRESET/TUNING l / h (the
colon (:) turns on or off) between selecting a preset
station number and tuning.
This button is also used to exchange the assignment of
two preset stations with each other.
o FM/AM
Switches the reception band between FM and AM.
p MEMORY (MANL/AUTO FM)
Stores a station in the memory. Hold down this button for
more than 3 seconds to start automatic preset tuning.
a TUNING MODE (AUTO/MANL MONO)
Switches the tuning mode between automatic and manual.
To select the automatic tuning mode, press this button so
that the AUTO indicator lights up on the front panel
display. To select the manual tuning mode, press this
button so that the AUTO indicator does not light up.
s BASS
Adjusts the low-frequency response for the left and right
main channels.
Turn the control to the right to increase or to the left to
decrease the low-frequency response.
d TREBLE
Adjusts the high-frequency response for the left and right
main channels.
Turn the control to the right to increase or to the left to
decrease the high-frequency response.
Note
If you increase or decrease the high-frequency or the low-
frequency sound to an extreme level, the tonal quality from the
center and rear speakers may not match that of the left and
right main speakers.
Opening and closing the front
panel door
When you want to use the controls behind the front panel
door, open the door gently pressing on the lower part of
the panel. When you are not using them, close the door.
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM5
6
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
PARAMETER
SET MENU
EFFECT
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
9
q
w
e
r
8
0
t
y
u
i
o
s
f
d
a
h
j
g
p
k
Remote Control
This section describes the controls and their functions of
the remote control. See REMOTE CONTROL
FEATURES on pages 43 to 56 for operating other
components with this remote control.
1 Infrared window
Outputs infrared control signals. Aim this window at the
component you want to operate.
2 RE-NAME
Used for changing the input source name in the display
window (see page 46).
3 TRANSMIT indicator
Flashes while the remote control is sending signals.
4 STANDBY
Sets this unit in the standby mode.
5 SYSTEM POWER
Turns on the power of this unit.
6 Display window
Shows the selected source component that you are
controlling.
7 SOURCE SELECT k/n
Selects the another component to control independently
from the input that has been selected by pressing an input
selector button.
8 10KEY/DSP
Selects the numeric button (10KEY) mode or DSP mode.
9 Operation buttons
Provides functions such as play, stop, skip, etc. for
operating your other components selected by the input
selector buttons.
0 EX/ES
Turns on or off the Dolby Digital EX or DTS ES decoder
with 10 KEY/DSP set to the DSP position.
q LEVEL
Selects the effect speaker channel to be adjusted and sets
the level.
w ON SCREEN
Selects the on-screen display (OSD) mode for your video
monitor.
e SLEEP
Sets the sleep timer.
r TEST
Outputs the test tone to adjust the speaker levels.
t CLEAR
Used for clearing functions acquired when using the learn
and rename features, and set manufacturer codes (see
page 49).
y LEARN
Used for setting up the manufacturer code or for
programming the functions of other remote controls (see
pages 44 46).
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM6
7
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
30°30°
Approximately 6 m (20 feet)
u MACRO
Used to program a series of operations for control by a
single button (see page 47).
i MACRO ON/OFF
Turns the macro function on and off.
o Å and ı
Switch the control area for the extra components that are
not connected to this unit without changing the input.
p Input selector buttons
Select the input source and change the control area.
a 6CH INPUT
Selects the source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks.
s DSP program/Numeric buttons
Select DSP programs or numbers according to the
position of 10KEY/DSP.
d MUTE
Mutes the sound. The MUTE indicator turns on when the
MUTE function is on. Press again to restore the audio
output to the previous volume level.
f VOLUME +/
Increases or decreases the volume level.
g STEREO/EFFECT
Switches the normal stereo or DSP effect reproduction.
When STEREO is selected, 2-channel input signals are
directed to the main left and right speakers without effect
sounds. All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals except
for the LFE channel are also directed to the main left and
right speakers.
h PARAMETER/SET MENU
Selects the PARAMETER mode or SET MENU mode.
j Cursor buttons k/n//+
Select and adjust DSP program parameters and SET
MENU items according to the position of PARAMETER/
SET MENU.
k Cover
Slides down to use the various setup buttons. Slides up
when these buttons are not being used.
Using the Remote Control
The remote control transmits a directional infrared beam.
Be sure to aim the remote control directly at the remote
control sensor on the main unit during operation.
Handling the remote control
Do not spill water or other liquids on the remote
control.
Do not drop the remote control.
Do not leave or store the remote control in the
following types of conditions:
high humidity or temperature such as near a heater,
stove or bath;
dusty places; or
in places subject to extremely low temperatures.
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM7
8
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
RL
LCR
RC RR
LFE
VIRTUAL
DTS
Neo
MOVIE TV THEATER
ENTERTAINMENT12
:6
DOLBY DIGITAL
PRO
LOGIC
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX
DSP
EX
MATRIXDISCRETE
ES
PCM
1
SILENT
SP
DIGITAL
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
STEREO
TUNED
MEMORY
dB
ft
m
S
P. DIRECT
BASS
MUTE VOLUME
SLEEP
AUTO
D
PRO LOGIC
/
AB
0q r tyui o ap
2
1456789
w e
3
1
DSP
indicator
Lights up when you select a digital sound field program.
2 Decoder indicators
When any of the decoders equipped on this unit
functions, the indicator lights up.
3 VIRTUAL indicator
Lights up when using Virtual CINEMA DSP (see page
33).
4 Input source indicator
Shows the current input source with a cursor.
5 AU TO indicator
Shows that this unit is in the automatic tuning mode.
6 SLEEP indicator
Lights up while the sleep timer is on.
7 MUTE indicator
Lights up while the MUTE function is on.
8 BASS indicator
Lights up while BASS EXTENSION is on.
9 VOLUME level indicator
Indicates the volume level.
0
PCM
indicator
Lights up when this unit is reproducing PCM (pulse code
modulation) digital audio signals.
q SILENT indicator
Lights up when headphones are connected with the sound
effect (see SILENT CINEMA DSP on page 32).
w SP A B indicator
Lights up according to which set of main speakers is
selected. Both indicators light up when both sets of
speakers are selected.
e Headphones indicator
Lights up when headphones are connected.
Front Panel Display
r DSP program indicators
The name of the selected DSP program lights up when
the ENTERTAINMENT, MOVIE THEATER 1, MOVIE
THEATER 2, TV THEATER or V/DTS SURROUND
DSP program is selected.
t Multi-information display
Shows the current DSP program name and other
information when adjusting or changing settings.
y STEREO indicator
Lights up when this unit is receiving a strong signal for an
FM stereo broadcast while the AUTO indicator is lit.
u TUNED indicator
Lights up when this unit tunes in to a station.
i MEMORY indicator
Flashes to show a station can be stored.
o P. DIRECT
Lights up while PROCESSOR DIRECT is on.
p Input channel indicator
Indicates the channel components of input signals being
received.
a
LFE
indicator
Lights up when the input signal contains the LFE signal.
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM8
9
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS
AC OUTLETS
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
S VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUTPUT
DIGITAL
INPUT
6CH INPUT
GND
AUDIO AUDIO VIDEO
CONTROL
OUT
SPEAKERS
TUNER
REMOTE
IN
75
UNBAL.
OUT
RC-232C
AM
ANT
GND
FM ANT
+12V
15mA
MAX.
COMPONENT VIDEO
S VIDEO
DVD
D-TV
/LD
CBL
/SAT
VIDEO
PR/ CR
DVD
MONITOR
OUT
CBL
/SAT
MAIN
MAIN
ZONE 2 OUT
REAR
REAR
CENTER CENTER
OUTPUT
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR
SELECTEUR D'INPEDANCE
SET BEFORE POWER ON
SUB
WOOFER
CENTER
CENTER
REAR
REAR
PB/ CB Y
R
R
R
L
L
R
L
L
R
L
R
L
OPTICAL
MD
/
TAPE
IN
(
PLAY
)
IN
(
PLAY
)
OUT
(
REC
)
OUT
(
REC
)
CD-R
CD-R
MD/TAPE
CD-R
DVD
CBL
/SAT
CD
CD
PHONO
IN
OUT
OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
VCR 2
/DVR
VCR 1
IN
MAIN
SURROUND
CD
D-TV
/LD
(SURROUND)
(SURROUND)
COAXIAL
+
L
R
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
MAIN A OR B:
A+B:
CENTER
4MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
:
MAIN A OR B:
CENTER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
:
A
B
1
9
0 q r tw
2
3
5
7
8
4 6
e
(U.S.A. model)
1 DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks
2 Audio component jacks
See pages 17 and 18 for connection information.
3 Video component jacks
See pages 14 to 16 for connection information.
4 RS-232C
These are control expansion terminals for commercial
use. Consult you dealer for details.
5 REMOTE IN/OUT jacks (U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models only)
See page 71 for details.
6 CONTROL OUT (U.S.A., Canada and Australia
models only)
This is a control expansion terminal for commercial use.
7 AC INLET (U.S.A. and Canada models only)
Use this inlet to plug in the supplied power cable (see
page 21).
8 AC OUTLETS
Use these outlets to supply power to your other A/V
components (see page 21).
9 DIGITAL INPUT jacks
0 6CH INPUT jacks
See page 20 for connection information.
q ZONE 2 OUT jacks (U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models only)
See page 71 for details.
w Antenna input terminals
See page 19 for connection information.
e OUTPUT jacks
See page 20 for connection information.
r Speaker terminals
See pages 11 and 12 for connection information.
t IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch
Use this switch to match the amplifier output to your
speaker impedance (see page 13). Set this unit in the
standby mode before you change the setting of this
switch.
< China and General models only >
FREQUENCY STEP switch
See page 19.
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
See page 21.
Rear Panel
0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM9
10
SPEAKER SETUP
Speakers to Be Used
This unit has been designed to provide the best sound-
field quality with a 6-speaker system, using left and right
main speakers, left and right rear speakers, and a center
and rear center speakers. If you use different brands of
speakers (with different tonal qualities) in your system,
the tone of a moving human voice and other types of
sound may not shift smoothly. We recommend that you
use speakers from the same manufacturer or speakers
with the same tonal quality.
The main speakers are used for the main source sound
plus the effect sounds. They will probably be the speakers
from your present stereo system. The rear speakers are
used for the effect and surround sounds, and the center
speaker is for the center sounds (dialog, vocals, etc.). If
for some reason it is not practical to use a center speaker,
you can do without it. Best results, however, are obtained
with the full system.
The main speakers should be high-performance models
and have enough power-handling capacity to accept the
maximum output of your audio system. The other
speakers do not have to be equal to the main speakers. For
precise sound localization, however, it is ideal to use the
models of equivalent performance with the main
speakers.
Use of a subwoofer expands your
sound field
It is also possible to further expand your system with the
addition of a subwoofer. The use of a subwoofer is
effective not only for reinforcing bass frequencies from
any or all channels, but also for reproducing the LFE
(low-frequency effect) channel with high fidelity when
the Dolby Digital signal or the DTS signal is played back.
The YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer
System is ideal for natural and lively bass reproduction.
PREPARATION
Speaker Placement
Refer to the following diagram when you place the
speakers.
Main speakers
Place the left and right main speakers an equal distance
from the ideal listening position. The distance of each
speaker from each side of the video monitor should be the
same.
Center speaker
Align the front face of the center speaker with the front
face of your video monitor. Place the speaker as close to
the monitor as possible, such as directly over or under the
monitor and centrally between the main speakers.
Rear speakers
Place these speakers behind your listening position,
facing slightly inwards, nearly 1.8 m (6 feet) above the
floor.
Rear center speaker
Place the rear center speaker in the center between the left
and right rear speakers at the same height from the floor
as the rear speakers.
Subwoofer
The position of the subwoofer is not so critical, because
low bass sounds are not highly directional. But it is better
to place the subwoofer near the main speakers. Turn it
slightly toward the center of the room to reduce the wall
reflections.
CAUTION
Use magnetically shielded speakers. If this type of
speakers still creates the interference with a monitor,
place the speakers away from the monitor.
Note
If you do not use any effect speakers (rear, center and/or rear
center), change the settings of SPEAKER SET items in the
SET MENU to designate the signals to other terminals you
connect speakers to.
Main
speaker (L)
1.8 m (6 feet)
Rear speaker (L)
Rear center
speaker
Rear speaker (R)
Subwoofer
Main speaker (R)Center speaker
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM10
11
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SPEAKER SETUP
12
Connecting the Speakers
Be sure to connect the left channel (L), right channel (R), + (red) and “–” (black) properly. If the connections are
faulty, no sound will be heard from the speakers, and if the polarity of the speaker connections is incorrect, the sound
will be unnatural and lack bass.
CAUTION
Use speakers with the specified impedance shown on the rear panel of this unit.
Do not let the bare speaker wires touch each other and do not let them touch any metal part of this unit. This could
damage this unit and/or speakers.
If necessary, use the SET MENU to change the speaker mode settings according to the number and size of the speakers
in your configuration after you finish connecting your speakers.
Speaker cables
A speaker cord is actually a pair of insulated cables
running side by side. One of the cables is colored or
shaped differently, perhaps with a stripe, groove or ridge.
1 Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8) of
insulation from each of the speaker cables.
2 Twist the exposed wires of the cable
together to prevent short circuits.
Connecting to the SPEAKERS terminals
1 Unscrew the knob.
2 Insert one bare wire into the hole in the side
of each terminal.
3 Tighten the knob to secure the wire.
y
(For U.S.A., Canada, Australia, China and General models)
Banana plug connections are also possible. First, tighten the
knob and then insert the banana plug connector into the end of
the corresponding terminal.
10 mm (3/8)
MAIN SPEAKERS terminals
One or two speaker systems can be connected to these terminals. If you use only one speaker system, connect it to either
of the MAIN A or B terminals.
REAR SPEAKERS terminals
A rear speaker system can be connected to these terminals.
CENTER SPEAKER terminals
A center speaker can be connected to these terminals.
REAR CENTER SPEAKER terminals
A rear center speaker can be connected to these terminals.
Red: positive (+)
Black: negative ()
Banana plug
3
1
2
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM11
12
SPEAKER SETUP
AC OUTLETS
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
S VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUTPUT
DIGITAL
INPUT
6CH INPUT
GND
AUDIO AUDIO VIDEO
CONTROL
OUT
SPEAKERS
TUNER
REMOTE
IN
75
UNBAL.
OUT
RC-232C
AM
ANT
GND
FM ANT
+12V
15mA
MAX.
COMPONENT VIDEO
S VIDEO
DVD
D-TV
/LD
CBL
/SAT
VIDEO
P
R
/ C
R
DVD
MONITOR
OUT
CBL
/SAT
MAIN
MAIN
ZONE 2 OUT
REAR
REAR
CENTER CENTER
OUTPUT
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR
SELECTEUR D'INPEDANCE
SET BEFORE POWER ON
SUB
WOOFER
CENTER
CENTER
REAR
REAR
P
B
/ C
B
Y
R
R
R
L
L
R
L
L
R
L
R
L
OPTICAL
MD
/
TAPE
IN
(
PLAY
)
IN
(
PLAY
)
OUT
(
REC
)
OUT
(
REC
)
CD-R
CD-R
MD/TAPE
CD-R
DVD
CBL
/SAT
CD
CD
PHONO
IN
OUT
OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
VCR 2
/DVR
VCR 1
IN
MAIN
SURROUND
CD
D-TV
/LD
(SURROUND)
(SURROUND)
COAXIAL
+
L
R
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
MAIN A OR B:
A+B:
CENTER
4MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
:
MAIN A OR B:
CENTER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
:
A
B
2
4567
31
Subwoofer
system
Rear Center
speaker
Main B speaker
Center
speaker
(U.S.A. and Canada
models)
Right
SUBWOOFER jack
When using a subwoofer with built-in amplifier, including the YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System,
connect the input jack of the subwoofer system to this jack. Low bass signals distributed from the main, center and/or
rear channels are directed to this jack if they are assigned to this jack. (The cut-off frequency of this jack is 90 Hz.) The
LFE (low-frequency effect) signals generated when Dolby Digital or DTS is decoded are also directed if they are
assigned to this jack.
Note
Depending on the settings of 1 SPEAKER SET and 10 LFE LEVEL on the SET MENU, some signals may not be output from
the SUBWOOFER jack.
Right Left
Main A speaker
Right Left
Left
2
3
1
4
5
7
6
The diagram above shows the speaker layout in the
listening room.
Rear speaker
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM12
13
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SPEAKER SETUP
AC OUTLETS
ZONE 2 OUT
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR
SELECTEUR D'INPEDANCE
SET BEFORE POWER ON
L
R
+
+
MAIN A OR B:
A+B:
CENTER
4MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
:
MAIN A OR B:
CENTER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
:
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR
SELECTEUR D'INPEDANCE
SET BEFORE POWER ON
MAIN A OR B:
A+B:
CENTER
4MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
:
MAIN A OR B:
CENTER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
:
Switch
position
Left
Right
Speaker
Main
Center
Rear
Center
Rear
Main
Center
Rear
Center
Rear
Impedance level
If you use one set of main speakers, the impedance of
each speaker must be 4 or higher.
If you use two sets of main speakers, the impedance of
each speaker must be 8 or higher.
The impedance must be 6 or higher.
The impedance must be 6 or higher.
The impedance of each speaker must be 6 or higher.
If you use one set of main speakers, the impedance of
each speaker must be 8 or higher.
If you use two sets of main speakers, the impedance of
each speaker must be 16 or higher.
[U.S.A. and Canada models only]
The impedance of each speaker must be 8 or higher.
The impedance must be 8 or higher.
The impedance must be 8 or higher.
The impedance of each speaker must be 8 or higher.
IMPEDANCE
SELECTOR
switch
IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch
WARNING
Do not change the IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch setting while the power of this unit is on, otherwise this unit
may be damaged.
If this unit fails to turn on when STANDBY/ON (or SYSTEM POWER) is pressed, the IMPEDANCE SELECTOR
switch may not be fully slid to either position. If so, slide the switch to either position fully when this unit is in the
standby mode.
Select the left and right position according to the impedance of the speakers in your system. Be sure to move this switch
only when this unit is in the standby mode.
(U.S.A. and Canada models)
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM13
14
y
The COMPONENT VIDEO jacks on this unit are independent
of the S VIDEO and VIDEO jacks.
Connection depends on the availability of input jacks on your
monitor. The signals input through the S VIDEO jacks can be
converted to composite signals inside of this unit and output
through the VIDEO jacks on this unit as well.
(U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only)
The signals input through the VIDEO jack on this unit can be
output through the S VIDEO jack by setting V CONV. in 13
DISPLAY SET on the SET MENU to ON (see page 67).
When signals input through both S VIDEO and VIDEO jacks,
signals input through the S VIDEO jack has priority.
You can designate the input for the COMPONENT VIDEO A
and B jacks according to your component by using 7 I/O
ASSIGNMENT on the SET MENU (see pages 63 and 64 for
details).
Note
When you are using the COMPONENT VIDEO jacks, check
the details in the owners manual that came with the component
being connected.
VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front
panel)
These jacks are used to connect any video input source
such as a game console and a camcorder to this unit.
Before Connecting Components
CAUTION
Never connect this unit and other components to mains
power until all connections between components have
been completed.
Be sure all connections are made correctly, that is to
say L (left) to L, R (right) to R, + to + and “–” to
“–”. Some components require different connection
methods and have different jack names. Refer to the
operation instructions for each component to be
connected to this unit.
Use commercially available video pin cables when
connecting to the S VIDEO and COMPONENT
VIDEO jacks.
Connecting Video Components
About the video jacks
There are three types of video jacks.
VIDEO jacks transmit composite signals.
S VIDEO jacks transmit S-video signals.
S-video signals are separated into
luminance (Y) and color (C) video signals
to achieve high-quality color
reproduction.
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks transmit
component signals.
Component signals are separated into
luminance (Y) and color difference (P
B/
C
B, PR/CR) to provide the best quality in
picture reproduction.
Refer to the owners manuals for your monitor and other
components being connected to reproduce these signals
correctly.
You can connect an S-video output and component video
output of your video components to this unit. Connect an
S-video output to the S VIDEO jack and component video
output to the COMPONENT VIDEO jack on this unit.
CONNECTIONS
VIDEO jack
S VIDEO jack
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks
S VIDEO VIDEO
L AUDIO R OPTICAL
VIDEO AUX
AUDIO OUT R
AUDIO OUT L
VIDEO OUT
OPTICAL OUT
S VIDEO OUT
O
V
L
R
S
COMPONENT VIDEO
PR/ CR PB/ CB Y
VIDEO
VIDEO
S VIDEO
Game
console or
video camera
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM14
15
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
CONNECTIONS
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
S VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUTPUT
DIGITAL
INPUT
6CH INPUT
GND
AUDIO AUDIO VIDEO
TUNER
75
UNBAL.
AM
ANT
GND
FM ANT
COMPONENT VIDEO
S VIDEO
DVD
D-TV
/LD
CBL
/SAT
VIDEO
PR/ CR
DVD
MONITOR
OUT
CBL
/SAT
OUTP
U
SUB
WOOFER
CENTER
CENTER
REAR
PB/ CB Y
R
L
R
L
OPTICAL
MD
/
TAPE
IN
(
PLAY
)
IN
(
PLAY
)
OUT
(
REC
)
OUT
(
REC
)
CD-R
CD-R
MD/TAPE
CD-R
DVD
CBL
/SAT
CD
CD
PHONO
IN
OUT
OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
VCR 2
/DVR
VCR 1
IN
MAIN
SURROUND
CD
D-TV
/LD
(
S
COAXIAL
V
S
L
VVC
S S
L R
O
R
L
S
R
V
C
O
COMPONENT
INPUT
S VIDEO
INPUT
VIDEO
INPUT
S VIDEO
OUTPUT
VIDEO
OUTPUT
AUDIO OUTPUT
COAXIAL OUTPUT
OPTICAL OUTPUT
AUDIO OUTPUT
COMPONENT OUTPUT
VIDEO
OUTPUT
S VIDEO
OUTPUT
V V V
VVV
V
V
V
(U.S.A. and Canada
models)
indicates S-video cables
indicates video cables
indicates coaxial cables
indicates optical cables
indicates right analog cables
indicates left analog cables
indicates signal direction
TV/digital TV or
LD player
DVD player
Video
monitor
indicates component video cables
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 8/19/02, 1:45 PM15
16
CONNECTIONS
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
S VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
VIDEO
DIGITAL OUTPUT
DIGITAL
INPUT
6CH INPUT
GND
AUDIO AUDIO VIDEO
TUNER
75
UNBAL.
AM
ANT
GND
FM ANT
COMPONENT VIDEO
S VIDEO
DVD
D-TV
/LD
CBL
/SAT
VIDEO
PR/ CR
DVD
MONITOR
OUT
CBL
/SAT
S
WO
CE
N
CE
N
R
E
PB/ CB Y
R
L
R
L
OPTICAL
MD
/
TAPE
IN
(
PLAY
)
IN
(
PLAY
)
OUT
(
REC
)
OUT
(
REC
)
CD-R
CD-R
MD/TAPE
CD-R
DVD
CBL
/SAT
CD
CD
PHONO
IN
OUT
OUT
ZONE 2 OUT
VCR 2
/DVR
VCR 1
IN
MAIN
SURROUND
CD
D-TV
/LD
COAXIAL
VVV
V
S
L R
VV
S S S
L R L R
O
S VIDEO OUTPUTVIDEO OUTPUT
AUDIO OUTPUT
OPTICAL OUTPUT
S VIDEO
INPUT
S VIDEO
OUTPUT
S VIDEO INPUT
VIDEO
OUTPUT
V
VIDEO
INPUT
AUDIO INPUT
AUDIO OUTPUT
VIDEO
INPUT
COMPONENT OUTPUT
V V V
L
S
R
V
O
COMPONENT
INPUT
V
V
V
indicates S-video cables
indicates video pin cables
indicates optical cables
indicates right audio pin cables
indicates left audio pin cables
indicates signal direction
Video
monitor
VCR 1 or VCR 2/
DVR (digital
video recorder)
Cable TV or
Satellite tuner
(U.S.A. and Canada
models)
indicates component video cables
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM16
17
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
CONNECTIONS
Connecting Audio Components
Connecting a CD player
y
The COAXIAL CD and OPTICAL CD jacks are available for a
CD player which has coaxial or optical digital output jacks.
When you connect a CD player to both the COAXIAL CD and
OPTICAL CD jacks, priority is given to the input signals from
the COAXIAL CD jack.
Connecting an MD recorder, tape
deck or CD recorder
y
DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks and analog OUT (REC) are
independent. Only digital signals are output from DIGITAL
OUTPUT jacks and analog signals from OUT (REC) jacks.
When you connect your recording component to both the
analog and digital input and output jacks, the priority is given
to the digital signal.
Note
When you connect a recording component to this unit, keep its
power on while using this unit. If the power is off, this unit may
distort the sound from other components.
Connecting to digital jacks
This unit has digital jacks for direct transmission of
digital signals through either coaxial or fiber optic cables.
You can use the digital jacks to input PCM, Dolby Digital
and DTS bitstreams. When you connect components to
both the COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, priority is given
to the input signals from the COAXIAL jack. All digital
input jacks are acceptable for 96-kHz sampling digital
signals.
y
You can designate the input for each digital jacks according to
your component by using 7 I/O ASSIGNMENT on the SET
MENU (see pages 63 and 64 for details).
About the dust protection cap
Pull out the cap from the optical jack before you connect
the fiber optic cable. Do not discard the cap. When you
are not using the optical jack, be sure to put the cap back
in place. This cap protects the jack from dust.
Notes
DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks and analog OUT (REC) jacks are
independent. Only digital signals are output from DIGITAL
OUTPUT jacks and analog signals from OUT (REC) jacks.
The OPTICAL jacks on this unit conform to the EIA standard.
If you use a fiber optic cable that does not conform to this
standard, this unit may not function properly.
Connecting a turntable
PHONO jacks are for connecting a turntable with an MM
or high-output MC cartridge. If you have a turntable with
a low-output MC cartridge, use an in-line boosting
transformer or MC-head amplifier when connecting to
these jacks.
y
Connect your turntable to the GND terminal to reduce noise in
the signal. However you may hear less noise without the
connection to the GND terminal for some record players.
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM17
18
CONNECTIONS
CENTER
SUB
WOOFER
DIGITAL OUTPUT
DIGITAL
INPUT
6CH INPUT
GND
AUDIO
R
L
OPTICAL
MD
/
TAPE
IN
(
PLAY
)
IN
(
PLAY
)
OUT
(
REC
)
OUT
(
REC
)
CD-R
CD-R
MD/TAPE
CD-R
DVD
CBL
/SAT
CD
CD
PHONO
MAIN
SURROUND
CD
D-TV
/LD
COAXIAL
L R L R
L R
C
L R L RL R
O
OPTICAL INPUT
OPTICAL OUTPUT
INPUT
INPUT
OUTPUT
OPTICAL INPUT
OUTPUT
OUTPUT
OUTPUT
GND
MAIN OUTPUT
SURROUND
OUTPUT
SUBWOOFER
OUTPUT
CENTER OUTPUT
O
L
R
O
O
R
L
OPTICAL
OUTPUT
COAXIAL OUTPUT
L
R
C
O
indicates coaxial cables
indicates optical cables
indicates right analog cables
indicates left analog cables
indicates signal direction
CD player
CD recorder
MD recorder or
tape deck
External decoder
See page 20
Turntable
(U.S.A. and Canada
models)
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM18
19
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
CONNECTIONS
TUNER
75
UNBAL.
AM
ANT
GND
FM ANT
COMPONENT VIDEO
P
R
/ C
R
V
D
N
ITOR
U
T
BL
AT
W
C
C
P
B
/ C
B
Y
Connecting the AM loop antenna
1 Set up the AM loop antenna, then connect it.
2 Press and hold the tab to insert the AM loop
antenna lead wires into the AM ANT and
GND terminals.
3 Release the tab to fix the lead wires.
y
The AM loop antenna can be removed from the stand and
attached to a wall, etc.
Orient the AM loop antenna for the best reception.
Notes
The AM loop antenna should be placed away from this unit.
The AM loop antenna should always be connected, even if an
outdoor AM antenna is connected to this unit.
A properly installed outdoor antenna provides clearer
reception than an indoor one. If you experience poor
reception quality, an outdoor antenna may improve the
quality. Consult the nearest authorized YAMAHA
dealer or service center about the outdoor antennas.
Connecting the Antennas
Both AM and FM indoor antennas are included with this unit. In general, these antennas should provide sufficient signal
strength.
Connect each antenna correctly to the designated terminals.
Connecting the indoor FM
antenna
Connect the included indoor FM antenna to the 75
UNBAL. FM ANT terminal.
FREQUENCY STEP switch (For China and
General models)
Because the interstation frequency spacing
differs in different areas, set the
FREQUENCY STEP switch (locating on
the rear panel) according to the frequency
spacing in your area.
North, Central and South America:
100 kHz/10 kHz
Other area: 50 kHz/9 kHz
Before setting this switch, disconnect the
AC power plug of this unit from the AC
outlet.
Ground (GND terminal)
For maximum safety and minimum
interference, connect the antenna GND
terminal to a good earth ground. A good
earth ground is a metal stake driven into
moist earth.
Indoor FM
antenna
(included)
AM loop antenna
(included)
100kHz/10kHz
FREQUENCY
STEP
50kHz/9kHz
FM AM
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM19
20
CONNECTIONS
MAIN
OUTPUT
SUB
WOOFER
CENTER
CENTER
REAR
REAR
R
L
R
L
(SURROUND)
1
2
3
4
5
Connecting to an External
Amplifier
If you want to increase the power output to the speakers,
or want to use another amplifier, connect an external
amplifier to the OUTPUT jacks as follows.
Notes
When RCA pin plugs are connected to the OUTPUT jacks for
output to an external amplifier, it is not necessary to use the
corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. Set the volume of the
amplifier connected to this unit to the maximum.
No signals will be output from any other OUTPUT jacks than
MAIN jacks when SPEAKER A is turned off with ZONE B
selected for 1G SP B SET on the SET MENU.
1 MAIN jacks
Main channel line output jacks.
Note
The signals output through these jacks are affected by the
BASS, TREBLE and BASS EXTENSION settings.
2 REAR (SURROUND) jacks
Rear channel line output jacks.
3 SUBWOOFER jack
When using a subwoofer with built-in amplifier, including
the YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer
System, connect the input jack of the subwoofer system
to this jack. Low bass signals distributed from the main,
center and/or rear channels are directed to this jack if they
are assigned to this jack. (The cut-off frequency of this
jack is 90 Hz.) The LFE (low-frequency effect) signals
generated when Dolby Digital or DTS is decoded are also
directed if they are assigned to this jack.
Notes
Adjust the volume level of the subwoofer with the control on
the subwoofer. It is also possible to adjust the volume level by
using the remote control of this unit (see ADJUSTING THE
LEVEL OF THE EFFECT SPEAKERS on page 69).
Depending on the settings of 1 SPEAKER SET and 10 LFE
LEVEL on the SET MENU, some signals may not be output
from the SUBWOOFER jack.
4 CENTER jack
Center channel line output jack.
5 REAR CENTER jack
Rear center channel line output jack.
Connecting to the 6CH INPUT
Jacks
This unit is equipped with 6 additional input jacks (left
and right MAIN, CENTER, left and right SURROUND
and SUBWOOFER) for discrete multi-channel input from
an external decoder, sound processor or pre-amplifier.
Connect the output jacks on your external decoder to the
6CH INPUT jacks. Be sure to match the left and right
outputs to the left and right input jacks for the main and
surround channels.
Notes
When 6CH INPUT is selected, the signals input to the 6CH
INPUT jacks have priority over any other input source.
When you select 6CH INPUT as the input source, this unit
automatically turns off the digital sound field processor, and
you cannot listen to DSP programs.
When you select 6CH INPUT as the input source, settings of
1 SPEAKER SET (1A to 1E) on the SET MENU do not
apply.
When headphones are used, only main L/R channels are
output.
Setting for 15 6CH INPUT SET on the SET MENU will be
applied when 6CH INPUT is selected.
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM20
21
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
CONNECTIONS
AC OUTLETS
E
DANCE SELECTOR
T
BEFORE POWER ON
A OR B:
A+B:
E
R
4MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
CENTER
:
:
:
A
IN A OR B:
E
NTER
E
AR
E
AR CENTER
:
:
:
AC IN
To AC outlet
AC OUTLETS
PEDANCE SELECTOR
T BEFORE POWER ON
N A OR B:
A+B:
TER
4MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
6MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
16MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
8MIN. /SPEAKER
R
R CENTER
:
:
:
MAIN A OR B:
CENTER
REAR
REAR CENTER
:
:
A+B
:
:
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
MAINS
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
(China and General models)
Connecting the Power Supply Cords
Connecting the AC power cord
[U.S.A. and Canada models]
Plug the power cord into the AC inlet when all
connections are complete, and then plug in this unit to the
wall outlet.
Caution
Do not use other AC power cords than the one provided.
Otherwise it may result in causing fire or an electrical
shock.
[Australia, China and General models]
Plug this unit into the wall outlet.
Plug in the other components connected to this unit to the
wall outlet.
AC OUTLET(S) (SWITCHED)
U.S.A., Canada, China and
General models ............................................ 2 OUTLETS
Australia model .............................................. 1 OUTLET
Use these outlets to connect the power cords from your
components to this unit. The power to the AC
OUTLET(S) is controlled by this units STANDBY/ON
(or SYSTEM POWER and STANDBY). These outlets
will supply power to any connected component whenever
this unit is turned on. The maximum power (total power
consumption of components) that can be connected to the
AC OUTLET(S) is:
U.S.A. and Canada models ...................................... 80 W
China and general models ........................................ 50 W
Australia model ...................................................... 100 W
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
(China and General models only)
The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit
must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE
plugging into the AC main supply. Voltages are 110/120/
220/240 V AC, 50/60 Hz.
(U.S.A. and Canada models)
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM21
22
CONNECTIONS
Turning on the Power
When all connections are completed, turn on the power of
this unit.
1 Press STANDBY/ON (SYSTEM POWER on
the remote control) to turn on the power of
this unit.
2 Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
STANDBY
/
ON
1
1
STANDBY
/ON
SYSTEM
POWER
or
Remote control
Front panel
0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM22
23
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
Selecting the OSD Mode
1 Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.
2 Press ON SCREEN on the remote control
repeatedly to change the display mode.
The OSD mode changes in the following order: full
display, short display, and display off.
Notes
If your video monitor is connected only to the COMPONENT
VIDEO jacks of this unit, the OSD is not shown. Make sure to
connect your video monitor to the COMPONENT VIDEO
jacks and either VIDEO or S VIDEO jacks if you want to see
the OSD.
Playing back video software that has an anti-copy signal or
video signals with a lot of noise may produce unstable images.
P01 CONCERT HALL 1
INIT.DLY…………30ms
ROOM SIZE…………1.O
LIVENESS…………………5
≥ DSP LEVEL…………0dB
P01 CONCERT HALL 1
PARAMETER
SET MENU
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
ON-SCREEN DISPLAY (OSD)
You can display the operation information for this unit on
a video monitor. If you display the SET MENU and DSP
program parameter settings on a monitor, it is much easier
to see the available options and parameters than it is by
reading this information on the front panel display.
y
If a video source is being reproduced, the OSD is
superimposed over the image.
The OSD signal is not output to the REC OUT jack, and will
not be recorded with any video signal.
You can set the OSD to turn on (gray background) or off when
a video source is not being reproduced (or the source
component is turned off) by using 13 DISPLAY SET on the
SET MENU (see page 67).
OSD Modes
You can change the amount of information the OSD
shows.
Full display
This mode always shows the DSP program parameter
settings on the video monitor.
Short display
This mode briefly shows the same contents as the front
panel display at the bottom of the screen and then
disappears.
Display off
This mode briefly shows the DISPLAY OFF message at
the bottom of the screen and then disappears. Afterwards,
no changes to operations appear on the monitor except
those of the ON SCREEN button.
Full display Short display
y
When you choose the full display mode, INPUT, VOLUME
and some other types of operation information are displayed at
the bottom of the screen in the same format as that for the front
panel display.
The SET MENU and test tone display appear regardless of the
OSD mode.
0104V2300_23-26_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM23
24
Item
1A CENTER SP
1B MAIN SP
1C REAR L/R SP
1D REAR CT SP
1E LFE/BASS OUT
1F MAIN LEVEL
1G SP B SET
Description
Selects the output mode according to whether or not a center speaker is
being used and its performance.
Selects the output mode according to the performance of the main
speakers.
Selects the output mode according to whether or not rear L/R speakers
are being used and their performance.
Selects the Rear Center channel output according to the size of the Rear
Center speaker.
Selects the speaker according to use for LFE signal output and low bass
signal.
Selects the main speaker level.
Select the location of the main speakers to be connected to the
SPEAKERS B terminals.
Control value (default
setting indicated in bold)
LRG/SML/NONE
LARGE/SMALL
LRG/SML/NONE
LRG/SML/NONE
SWFR/MAIN/BOTH
Normal/10 dB
MAIN / ZONE B
SPEAKER MODE SETTINGS
This unit has 7 SPEAKER SET items on the SET MENU that you must set according to the number of speakers in your
configuration and their size. The following table summarizes these SPEAKER SET items, and shows the initial settings
as well as other possible settings.
If the initial settings shown in the following table are not appropriate for your speaker configuration, change settings
following the steps described in 1 SPEAKER SET from pages 58 to 61.
Summary of SPEAKER SET Items 1A through 1G
0104V2300_23-26_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM24
25
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
This section explains how to adjust the speaker output
levels by using the test tone generator. When this
adjustment is made, the output level heard at the listening
position will be the same from each speaker. This is
important for the best performance of the digital sound
field processor, and various decoders (Dolby Digital,
Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Pro Logic
, DTS, DTS ES, and
DTS Neo: 6).
Note
Since this unit cannot enter the test mode while headphones are
connected to this unit, be sure to unplug the headphones from
the PHONES jack when using the test tone.
Before You Begin
1 Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.
2 Press SPEAKERS A or B
to select the main
speakers to be used.
If you are using two sets of the
main speakers, press both A
and B.
3 Set the BASS and TREBLE controls on the
front panel to the center position and turn off
BASS EXTENSION and PROCESSOR
DIRECT by pressing the buttons.
BASS EXT. OFF and P. DIRECT OFF appear
on the front panel display.
TEST
BASS
TREBLE
+
+
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
PARAMETER
SET MENU
EFFECT
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
TV MUTE
A/B/C/D/E
3
42, 5
1
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
SPEAKERS
AB
ADJUSTING THE SPEAKER OUTPUT LEVELS
Set to OFF.
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
2
33
PARAMETER
SET MENU
VOLUME
Using the Test Tone (TEST DOLBY
SUR.)
Use the test tone to balance the output levels of the 6
speakers required for a surround sound system. The
adjustment of each speaker output level should be made at
your listening position with the remote control.
1 Set PARAMETER/SET
MENU on the remote
control to PARAMETER.
2 Press TEST to output the
test tone.
3 Adjust the volume so you can hear the test
tone.
0104V2300_23-26_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM25
26
ADJUSTING THE SPEAKER OUTPUT LEVELS
Notes
If 1A CENTER SP on the SET MENU is set to NONE, the
center channel sound is automatically output from the left and
right main speakers.
If 1C REAR L/R SP on the SET MENU is set to NONE, the
output level of the rear right, left and center speakers cannot be
adjusted in step 4. The test tone will be circulated in the order
of LEFTCENTERRIGHTSUBWOOFERLEFT...,
skipping the rear right and left speakers and the rear center
speaker.
If 1D REAR CT SP on the SET MENU is set to NONE, the
output level of the rear center speaker cannot be adjusted in
step 4. The test tone will be circulated in the order of
LEFTCENTERRIGHTRIGHT SURROUNDLEFT
SURROUNDSUBWOOFERLEFT ..., skipping the rear
center speaker.
If 1E LFE/BASS OUT on the SET MENU is set to MAIN,
the output level of the subwoofer cannot be adjusted. The test
tone will be circulated in the order of LEFTCENTER
RIGHTRIGHT SURROUNDREAR CENTERLEFT
SURROUNDLEFT, skipping the subwoofer.
y
It is not necessary to readjust the speaker level once it is set as
long as you do not change the speakers. You can enjoy listening
to or watching the input source with the desired volume by
adjusting the volume key.
You can increase the output levels of the effect speakers
(center, left rear and right rear and rear center) to +10 dB. If the
output level of these speakers is lower than that of the main
speakers even after you have increased the output level of these
speakers up to +10 dB, set 1F MAIN LEVEL on the SET
MENU to 10 dB (see page 61). This setting decreases the
main speaker output level to about one-third of the normal
level. After you have set 1F MAIN LEVEL on the SET
MENU to 10 dB, adjust the levels for the center and rear
speakers again.
The test tone is heard from the left main speaker,
center speaker, right main speaker, right rear speaker,
rear center speaker, left rear speaker and subwoofer
in order. The tone is produced for 2.5 seconds each
time.
The state of the test tone output is also shown on the
monitor by an image of the audio listening room.
This is convenient for adjusting each speaker level.
Front panel display also indicates from which
speaker the test tone is output in the order of
TEST LEFTTEST CENTERTEST RIGHT
TEST R SUR.TEST REAR CNTRTEST L SUR.
TEST SUBWOOFER
Note
If the test tone cannot be heard, turn down the volume, set this
unit in the standby mode and check the speaker connections.
4 Press /+ repeatedly to
adjust the output level of
the effect speakers so that
the output level coming
from each speaker is the
same.
While adjusting, the test tone is heard from the
selected speaker.
Note
Main L/R speaker level cannot be adjusted by itself. Use
VOLUME to adjust the main volume.
5 When the adjustment is
complete, press TEST to
stop the test tone.
LEFT
TEST DOLBY SUR.
LEFT SURROUND
SUBWOOFER
RIGHT SURROUND
CENTER
REAR CENTER
RIGHT
LEFT
TEST
0104V2300_23-26_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM26
27
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
BASIC PLAYBACK
1 Press STANDBY/ON (SYSTEM POWER on
the remote control) to turn on the power.
2 Turn on the video monitor connected to this
unit.
3 Press SPEAKERS A or B
to select the main
speakers to be used.
If you are using two sets of
main speakers, press both A
and B. The speaker indicator(s)
for the selected set(s) lights up
on the front panel display.
4 Rotate INPUT (or press one of the input
selector buttons on the remote control) to
select the input source.
The current input source name and input mode
appear on the front panel display and on the video
monitor for a few seconds.
Note
The input source names correspond to the jack names on the
rear panel of this unit, not the names of the component
connected to this unit.
To select a source connected to the 6CH INPUT
jacks
Press 6CH INPUT until 6CH INPUT appears on the
front panel display and on the video monitor.
Notes
If 6CH INPUT is shown on the front panel display and on
the video monitor, no other source can be played. To select
another input source with INPUT (one of the input selector
buttons), press 6CH (INPUT) to turn off 6CH INPUT from
the front panel display and the video monitor.
If you want to enjoy an audio source connected to the 6CH
INPUT jacks together with a video source, first select the video
source and then press 6CH (INPUT).
INPUT
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
DSP
10KEY
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AU X
POWER
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
++
1
7
4
6
PHONO
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
VOLUME
D
A
DVD AUTO
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
1
6
64 4
3
6
7
STANDBY
/ON
SYSTEM
POWER
SPEAKERS
AB
or
or
Remote control
Remote control
Front panel
Front panel
Selected input source
6CH
6CH INPUT
Remote controlFront panel
or
0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM27
28
BASIC PLAYBACK
BGV (background video) function
The BGV function allows you to combine a video image
from a video source with a sound from an audio source.
For example, you can enjoy listening to classical music
while having beautiful scenery from the video source on
the video monitor.
Select a source from the video group and then select a
source from the audio group with the input selector
buttons on the remote control. This selection for BGV
cannot be made with INPUT on the front panel.
To mute the sound
Press MUTE on the
remote control.
To resume the audio output,
press MUTE again.
y
You can also cancel mute to press any operation buttons such as
VOLUME +/.
During muting, the MUTE indicator flashes on the front
panel display.
When this unit enters the standby mode, the mute function will
be cancelled.
When you have finished using
this unit
Press STANDBY/ON (STANDBY on the
remote control) to set this unit in the
standby mode.
5 Start playback or select a broadcast station
on the source component.
Refer to the operation instructions for the
component.
Note
If you playback a video source that uses scrambled or encoded
signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the picture itself may
be disturbed due to those signals.
6 Adjust the volume to the desired output
level.
If desired, use BASS, TREBLE and BASS
EXTENSION. These controls are only effective for
sound from the main speakers.
Notes
If the component connected to the VCR 1 OUT, VCR 2/DVR
OUT, CD-R OUT and MD/TAPE OUT jacks is turned off, the
reproduced sound may be distorted or the volume may be
lowered for the characteristics of AV receivers. In this case,
turn on the component.
BASS EXTENSION may not be effective if 1B MAIN SP on
the SET MENU is set to SMALL and 1E LFE/BASS OUT is
set to SWFR.
7 Select a DSP program if desired.
Use PROGRAM l / h (DSP program buttons on
the remote control) to select a DSP program. See
pages 33 to 36 for details about the DSP program.
PHONO
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
VOLUME
VOLUME
BASS
TREBLE
+
+
BASS
EXTENSION
Front panel
or
Remote control
STANDBY
/ON
or
STANDBY
Front panel
Remote control
MUTE
PROGRAM
or
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
Front panel Remote control
0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:36 AM28
29
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
BASIC PLAYBACK
Input Modes and Indications
This unit comes with various input jacks. You can set the
priority of the input signal among different types of input
signals.
When you turn on the power of this unit, the input mode
is set according to 8 INPUT MODE on the SET MENU
(see page 64 for details).
Press INPUT MODE (the input selector
button that you have pressed to select the
input source on the remote control)
repeatedly until the desired input mode is
shown on the front panel display and on the
video monitor.
AUTO: In this mode, the input signal is
automatically selected in the following
order:
1) Digital signal
2) Analog signal
DTS: In this mode, only the digital input signal
encoded with DTS is selected even if
another signal is input at the same time.
ANALOG: In this mode, only the analog input signal is
selected even if a digital signal is input at
the same time.
Notes
If digital signals are input from both the COAXIAL and
OPTICAL jacks, the digital signal from the COAXIAL jack
has precedence over the OPTICAL jack.
In playing the disc encoded with Dolby Digital or DTS on
some LD or DVD players, the sound output delays for a
moment when playback resumes after a search because the
digital signal is selected again.
When playing the LD source that has not been digitally
recorded, the sound may not be output for some LD players. In
this case, set the input mode to ANALOG.
y
When AUTO is selected, this unit automatically determines the
type of signal. If this unit detects a Dolby Digital or DTS
signal, the decoder automatically switches to the appropriate
setting.
When you turn on the power of this unit, the input mode is set
according to 8 INPUT MODE on the SET MENU (see page
64 for details).
MODE
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
VOLUME
D
A
DVD AUTO
PHONO
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
Remote controlFront panel
or
Input mode
Notes on the digital signal
The digital input jacks of this unit can handle up to a
96 kHz sampling digital signal. However when inputting
a higher digital signal than 48 kHz, be aware of the
following points.
DSP programs cannot be selected. Sound will be output as
normal 2-channel stereo sound from only the left and right
main speakers.
Use the coaxial input (COAXIAL IN) jack to input over
96 kHz digital signals. The signals may not be correctly played
back if the optical input (OPTICAL IN) jack is used.
Level adjustment for effect speakers other than a subwoofer is
not possible.
Notes on playing DTS-CD/LDs
If the digital output data of the player has been
processed in any way, you may not be able to perform
DTS decoding even if you make a digital connection
between this unit and the player.
If you play a source encoded with a DTS signal and
set the input mode to ANALOG, this unit reproduces
the noise of an unprocessed DTS signal. When you
want to play a DTS source, be sure to connect the
source to a digital input jack and set the input mode to
AUTO or DTS.
If you switch the input mode to ANALOG while
playing a source encoded with a DTS signal, this unit
reproduces no sound.
If you play a source encoded with a DTS signal with
the input mode set to AUTO;
This unit automatically switches to the DTS-
decoding mode (The t indicator lights up.)
after having detected the DTS signal. When playback
of the DTS source is completed, the t indicator
may flash. While this indicator is flashing, only DTS
source can be played. If you want to play a normal
PCM source soon, set the input mode back to AUTO.
The t indicator may flash when a search or
skip operation is performed while the DTS source is
playing back with the input mode set to AUTO. If
this status continues for longer than 30 seconds, this
unit will automatically switch from DTS-decoding
mode to PCM digital signal input mode. The t
indicator will turn off.
0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM29
30
BASIC PLAYBACK
Selecting a Sound Field Program
You can enhance your listening experience by selecting a
DSP program. There are 11 programs with sub-programs
available with this unit. However the selection depends on
the input signal format and not all the sub-programs are
possible for all input signal formats. For details about
each program, see pages 33 to 37.
1 Set 10KEY/DSP to DSP on
the remote control.
2 Press PROGRAM l / h (one of the DSP
program buttons on the remote control) to
select the desired program.
The name of the selected program appears on the
front panel display and on the video monitor.
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
2
HALL 1
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
++
EX/ES
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
2,31
3 After selecting the desired program, press
the same button repeatedly to select the
desired sub-program if available.
For example, to select the sub-program 70 mm
Sci-Fi, press MOVIE THEATER 1 repeatedly.
Notes
When you select an input source, this unit automatically selects
the last DSP program used with that source.
When you set this unit in the standby mode, the current source
and DSP program are memorized and are automatically
selected when you turn on the power again.
If a Dolby Digital or DTS signal is input when the input mode
is set to AUTO, the DSP program (No. 911) automatically
switches to the appropriate decoding program.
When a monaural source is being played with PRO LOGIC/
Normal or PRO LOGIC/Enhanced, PRO LOGIC Movie, or
Neo: 6 Cinema, no sound will be heard from the main speakers
and the rear speakers. Sound can only be heard from the center
speaker. However, if 1A CENTER SP on the SET MENU is
set to NONE, the center channel sound is output from the main
speakers.
When a source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks of this unit
is selected, the digital sound field processor cannot be used.
When 48-kHz sampling digital signals are input to this unit, the
DSP program cannot be selected. In this case, the sound is
reproduced as normal 2-channel stereo.
y
Choose a DSP program based on your listening preference, and
not on the name of the program. The acoustics of your listening
room affect the DSP program. Minimize the sound reflections
in your room to maximize the effect created by the program.
LR
MOVIE THEATER
1
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX
DSP
1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
VOLUME
D
PRO LOGIC
/
A
70mm Sci-Fi
PROGRAM
Sub-program name
Program name
Front panel
or
Remote control
LR
MOVIE THEATER
1
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX
DSP
1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
VOLUME
D
96
K
Hz
/
24Bit
PRO LOGIC
/
A
70mm Spectacle
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
Program name
Sub-program name
DSP
10KEY
0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM30
31
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
BASIC PLAYBACK
Selecting PRO LOGIC,
PRO LOGIC or Neo: 6
You can enjoy the 2-channel sources decoded into five or
six discrete channels by selecting PRO LOGIC, PRO
LOGIC
or Neo: 6 in the program No. 11.
1 Select a 2-channel source and start playback
on the source component.
2 (Operating using the front panel)
Select a decoder and subprogram.
Press PROGRAM l / h on the front panel
repeatedly to select PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC
, or Neo: 6.
(Operating using the remote control)
Press V/DTS SUR. on the remote control.
The previously selected sub program appears on the
front panel display.
3 Select a decoder.
Press SELECT to select PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC
or Neo: 6.
4 Select a subprogram suitable for the source.
The selection switches as follows each time V/DTS
SUR. is pressed.
When PRO LOGIC is selected
Normal Enhanced
When PRO LOGIC
is selected
Movie Music
When Neo: 6 is selected
Cinema Music
Note
PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC and Neo: 6 decoders can decode
only 2-channel sources.
Playing the Dolby Digital EX or
DTS ES software
Press EX/ES to turn on the Dolby Digital EX or DTS ES
decoder to listen to the Dolby Digital EX and DTS ES
software with a rear center speaker.
Press EX/ES to select the mode. (The modes that can be
selected vary depending on the format of the software to
play.)
AUTO: This mode automatically switches Dolby
Digital EX/DTS ES Matrix 6.1/DTS ES
Discrete 6.1 depending on the signal in the
input source that this unit can detect. Rear
center speaker does not work for 5.1 channel
sources.
Discrete 6.1: This mode can be selected only when the
source with DTS ES Discrete format has
been detected. (The DISCRETE indicator
lights up.)
Matrix 6.1: This mode makes 6-channel playback of the
input source with Matrix or Matrix
compatible format through the Matrix 6.1
decoder. (Either
EX
or MATRIX
indicator lights up.)
OFF: Rear center speaker does not work in this
mode.
LR
PRO
LOGIC
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX
DSP
1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
VOLUME
D
PRO LOGIC
/
A
PRO LOGIC
DOLBY
II
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
Remote control
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
2
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
++
2,3,4
PROGRAM
Front panel
EX/ES
CHP/INDEX
RL
LCR
RC RR
LFE
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX
DSP
1
SP
DIGITAL
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
VOLUME
D
A
Matrix 6.1
EX
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
(Example: when playing the Dolby Digital EX software)
0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM31
32
BASIC PLAYBACK
Normal Stereo Reproduction
Press STEREO/EFFECT to turn off the sound
effect for normal stereo reproduction.
Press STEREO/EFFECT again to turn the sound
effect back on.
Notes
If 1B MAIN SP on the SET MENU is set to SMALL and
1E LFE/BASS OUT is set to SWFR, or 1E LFE/BASS
OUT is set to BOTH, the LFE signals will be output from
the subwoofer.
If you turn off the sound effect while a Dolby Digital or DTS
signal is being output, the dynamic range of the signal is
automatically compressed and the sounds of the center and rear
speaker channels are mixed and output from the main speakers.
The volume may be greatly reduced when you turn off the
sound effect or if you set 11 D-RANGE on the SET MENU
to MIN. In this case turn on the sound effect.
Displaying the information about
the input source
You can display the information such as the type, format
and sampling frequency of the signal input from the
component connected to this unit.
1 Select the input source you want to obtain
the information about by pressing an input
selector button.
2 Press STEREO/EFFECT to
light STEREO.
3 Press k/n to display the information about
the input signal.
Notes
Some 6.1-channel compatible discs do not have a signal (flag)
which this unit can automatically detect. When playing these
kinds of discs with 6.1-channel, select Matrix 6.1.
6.1-channel playback is not possible even if EX/ES is pressed
in the following cases:
When 1C REAR L/R SPis set to NONE.
When the sound effect is turned off.
When the source connected to the 6CH INPUT jack is
being played.
When the source being played does not contain rear L/R
channel signals.
When Dolby Digital KARAOKE source is being played.
When headphones are connected.
When 6ch Stereo is selected.
When the power of this unit is turned off, the input mode
will be reset to AUTO.
Virtual CINEMA DSP
With the Virtual CINEMA DSP, you can enjoy all the
DSP programs without rear speakers. It creates the virtual
speakers to reproduce the natural sound field.
The sound field processing is changed to the Virtual
CINEMA DSP mode according to the selected DSP
program by setting 1C REAR L/R SP on the SET
MENU to NONE.
Note
This unit is not set in the virtual CINEMA DSP mode even if
1C REAR L/R SP is set to NONE in the following cases:
when the 6ch Stereo, DOLBY DIGITAL Normal, Pro Logic
, DTS Normal or Neo: 6 program is selected;
when the sound effect is turned off;
when 6CH INPUT is selected as the input source;
when 96-kHz sampling digital signals are input to this unit;
when using the test tone; or
when connecting the headphones.
SILENT CINEMA DSP
You can enjoy the powerful sound field as if there were
actual speakers with the SILENT CINEMA DSP. You can
listen to SILENT CINEMA DSP by connecting your
headphones to the PHONES jack while the digital sound
field processor is on. Enjoy all the DSP program using the
headphones. The SILENT indicator lights up on the
front panel display. (If the sound effect is off, you listen to
the source with normal stereo reproduction.)
Note
This unit is not set in the SILENT CINEMA DSP mode even if
the sound effect is on in the following cases:
when 6CH INPUT is selected as the input source
when over 48-kHz sampling digital signals are being input
STEREO
EFFECT
STEREO
EFFECT
Front panel
or
Remote control
PHONO
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
STEREO
EFFECT
PARAMETER
SET MENU
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM32
BASIC
OPERATION
33
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP)
Understanding Sound Fields
A sound field is defined as the characteristic sound reflections of a
particular space. In concert halls and other music venues, we hear
early reflections and reverberations as well as the direct sound
produced by the artist(s). The variations in the early reflections and
other reverberations among the different music venues is what gives
each venue its special and recognizable sound quality.
YAMAHA sent teams of sound engineers all around the world to
measure the sound reflections of famous concert halls and music
venues, and collect detailed sound field information such as the
direction, strength, range, and delay time of those reflections. Then
we stored this enormous amount of data in the ROM chips of this
unit.
Hi-Fi DSP Programs
Recreating the sound field of a concert hall or an opera house requires localizing the virtual sound sources in your
listening room. The traditional stereo system that uses only two speakers is not capable of recreating a realistic sound
field. YAMAHAs DSP requires four effect speakers to recreate sound fields based on the measured sound field data.
The processor controls the strength and delay time of the signals output from the four effect speakers to localize the
virtual sound sources in a full circle around the listener.
CINEMA-DSP
Filmmakers intend the dialog to be located right on the screen, the effect sound a little farther back, the music spread
even farther back, and the surround sound around the listener. Of course, all of these sounds must be synchronized with
the images on the screen.
CINEMA-DSP is an upgraded version of YAMAHA DSP specially designed for movie soundtracks. CINEMA-DSP
integrates the DTS, Dolby Digital, and Dolby Pro Logic surround sound technologies with YAMAHA DSP sound field
programs to provide the surround sound field. It recreates the most complete movie sound design in your audio room. In
CINEMA-DSP sound field programs, YAMAHAs exclusive DSP processing is added to the right and left Main and
Center channels, so the listener can enjoy realistic dialogue, depth of sound, smooth transition between sound sources,
and a surround sound field that goes beyond the screen.
When a DTS or Dolby Digital signal is detected, the CINEMA-DSP sound field processor automatically chooses the
most suitable sound field program for that signal.
L SURROUND SOUND FIELD
R SURROUND SOUND FIELD
PRESENCE SOUND FIELD
DIALOG
EFFECT MUSIC
0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM33
34
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP)
Sound Field Effect
The 6-channel soundtracks found on 70-mm film produce precise sound field localization and rich, deep sound without
using matrix processing. This units MOVIE THEATER programs provide the same quality of sound and sound
localization that 6-channel soundtracks do. The built-in Dolby Digital or DTS decoder brings the professional-quality
sound designed for movie theaters into your home. With this units MOVIE THEATER programs, you can recreate a
dynamic sound that gives you the feeling of being at a public theater in your listening room by using Dolby Digital or
DTS technology.
Dolby Digital/DTS + DSP sound field effect
These programs use YAMAHAs tri-field DSP processing
on each of the Dolby Digital or DTS signals for the front,
left surround and right surround channels. This processing
enables this unit to reproduce the immense sound field
and surround expression of a Dolby Digital- or DTS-
equipped movie theater without sacrificing the clear
separation of all channels.
Dolby Digital EX/DTS ES + DSP sound field effect
These programs provide you with the maximum experience of the spacious surround effects since an extra rear center
DSP sound field created from the rear center channel is added.
Dolby Pro Logic + DSP sound field effect
Most movie software has 4-channel (left, center, right and
surround) sound information encoded by Dolby Surround
matrix processing and stored on the left and right tracks.
These signals are processed by the Dolby Pro Logic
decoder. The MOVIE THEATER programs for 2-channel
sources are designed to recreate the spaciousness and
delicate nuances of sound that tend to be lost in the
encoding and decoding processes.
Dolby Pro Logic /DTS Neo: 6
Dolby Pro Logic and DTS Neo: 6 equipped on this unit decode the 2-channel Dolby Surround software into five or
six full range channels. They also provide two modes; MOVIE/CINEMA for movies and MUSIC for 2-channel sources.
Surround DSP
sound field
Right surround DSP
sound field
Presence DSP
sound field
Left surround DSP
sound field
Presence DSP
sound field
Straight Decode
This unit is equipped with various precise decoders;
Dolby Digital/DTS decoder for multi-channel reproduction of the original sound
Dolby Digital EX/DTS ES decoder for an additional rear center channel
Dolby Pro Logic/Pro Logic /DTS Neo:6 decoder for multi-channel reproduction of 2-channel sources
Select any of the STRAIGHT DECODE modes in Program 11 (except for the sub-program Enhanced.) to use any of
these decoders for reproducing the original sound without any sound effects added. In this case, no DSP effect is applied
and the DSP indicator turns off.
0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM34
35
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP)
Features of DSP Programs
The following list gives you a brief description of the sound fields produced by each of the DSP programs. Keep in
mind that most of these are precise digital recreations of actual acoustic environments.
No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
6
7
8
Program
CONCERT HALL 1
CONCERT HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
ROCK CONCERT
ENTERTAINMENT
ENTERTAINMENT
MUSIC VIDEO
TV THEATER
Features
This is a large fan-shaped concert hall which has
approximately 2500 seats. Almost the whole interior
is made of wood. There is relatively little reflection
from the walls, and sound spreads finely and
beautifully.
A large round concert hall with a rich surround
effect. Pronounced reflections from all directions
emphasize the extension of sounds. The sound field
has a great deal of presence, and your virtual seat is
near the center, close to the stage.
This program recreates the acoustic environment of
a big church with a high dome and columns along
each side. The reverberation delay is very long while
the early reflections are smaller than with other
sound field programs.
This is the sound field at stage front in The Bottom
Line, a famous New York jazz club. The floor can
seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field
offering a real and vibrant sound.
The ideal program for lively, dynamic rock music.
The data for this program was recorded at LAs
hottest rock club. The listeners virtual seat is at
the center-left of the hall.
This program recreates the acoustic environment of
a lively disco in the heart of a big city. The sound is
dense and highly concentrated. It is also
characterized by a high-energy, immediate sound.
Using this program increases the listening position
range. This is a sound field suitable for background
music at parties.
This program adds a deep and spatial feeling to
video game sounds.
This program produces an enthusiastic atmosphere
and lets you feel as if you are at an actual jazz or
rock concert.
This program is provided for reproducing monaural
video sources (such as old movies). The program
produces the optimum reverberation to create sound
depth using only the presence sound field.
Though the presence sound field is relatively
narrow, the surround sound field employs the sound
environment of a large concert hall. With this
program, you can enjoy watching various TV
programs such as news, variety shows, music
programs or sports programs.
Type of
sources
For music
sources
For audio-
video
sources
Sub program
Disco
6ch Stereo
Game
Mono Movie
Variety/Sports
Mode
Hi-Fi DSP
CINEMA DSP
0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM35
36
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP)
No.
9
10
11
11
Program
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
DOLBY DIGITAL
DTS DIGITAL
SUR
PRO LOGIC
DOLBY DIGITAL
DTS DIGITAL
SUR
PRO LOGIC
PRO LOGIC
DTS Neo:6
Features
This program creates the extremely wide sound field of a
70-mm movie theater. It precisely reproduces the source
sound in detail, making both the video and the sound field
incredibly real. This is ideal for any kind of video source
encoded with Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital or DTS
(especially large-scale movie productions).
This program clearly reproduces dialog and sound
effects in the latest sound form of science fiction
films, thus creating a broad and expansive cinematic
space amid the silence. You can enjoy science fiction
films in a virtual-space sound field that includes
Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital and DTS-encoded
software employing the most advanced techniques.
This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound
design of the newest 70-mm and multichannel soundtrack
films. The sound field is made to be similar to that of the
newest movie theaters, so the reverberations of the sound
field itself are restrained as much as possible.
This program is for reproducing sounds from 70-mm
and multichannel soundtrack films, and is
characterized by a soft and extensive sound field. The
presence sound field is relatively narrow. It spatially
spreads all around and toward the screen, restraining
the echo effect of conversations without losing
clarity.
This program ideally simulates the multi-surround
speaker systems of the 35-mm film theaters. Dolby
Pro Logic decoding, Dolby Digital decoding or DTS
decoding and digital sound field processing create
precise effects without altering the original sound
orientation.
The surround effects produced by this sound field
wrap around the viewer naturally from the back to the
left and right, and toward the screen.
The built-in decoder precisely reproduces sounds and
sound effects from sources. The highly efficient
decoding process improves crosstalk and channel
separation and makes sound positioning smoother
and more precise.
In this program, no DSP effect is applied.
To reproduce 2 channel sources decoding into
multichannels in each decoding mode.
Type of
sources
For movie
programs
Sub program
Spectacle
Sci-Fi
Adventure
General
Enhanced
Enhanced
Enhanced
Normal
Normal
Normal
Movie
Music
Cinema
Music
Mode
CINEMA DSP
STRAIGHT DECODE
0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM36
37
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP)
Table of Program Names for Each Input Format
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
DOLBY
DIGITAL
DTS DGTL
SUR
PRO LOGIC
PRO LOGIC
DTS Neo: 6
2 channel
Stereo
70 mm Spectacle
70 mm Sci-Fi
70 mm Adventure
70 mm General
Normal
Enhanced
Movie
Music
Cinema
Music
DOLBY DIGITAL
EX decoder:
inactive (off)
DGTL Spectacle
DGTL Sci-Fi
DGTL Adventure
DGTL General
Normal
Enhanced
DOLBY DIGITAL
EX decoder:
active (on)
Spectacle EX
Sci-Fi EX
Adventure EX
General EX
Dolby D EX
EX Enhanced
DTS ES
decoder:
active (on)
Spectacle ES
Sci-Fi ES
Adventure ES
General ES
ES
Matrix
6.1
*
1
ES Dscrt 6.1
*
2
Enhanced ES
DTS ES
decoder:
inactive (off)
DTS Spectacle
DTS Sci-Fi
DTS Adventure
DTS General
Normal
Enhanced
*1 means the DTS ES Matrix decoder is active.
*2 means the DTS ES Discrete decoder is active.
y
If a Dolby Digital signal or DTS signal is input when the input mode is set to AUTO, the DSP program will be automatically
switched to the Dolby Digital playback sound field or DTS playback sound field.
If Dolby Digital Surround EX software or DTS ES software is played when AUTO is selected by pressing the EX/ES button on the
remote control, the Dolby Digital EX or DTS ES decoder will automatically turn on and the corresponding DSP program will be
selected.
EX/ES on the remote control can be used to play Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1 channel sources with rear center speaker. In this case the
program name changes to the corresponding name for 6.1 channel.
When playing 6.1 channel source with EX/ES on the remote control off, the program name changes to the corresponding name for
5.1 channel.
Note
The indicator does not light up when selecting the program No. 11 except for the Enhanced mode.
DOLBY DIGITAL DTSInput
Program
No.
9
10
11
0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM37
38
4 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h once to begin
automatic tuning.
Press h to tune in to a higher frequency, or press l
to tune in to a lower frequency. Press the same button
again if the tuning search does not stop at the desired
station.
When tuned in to a station, the TUNED indicator
lights up and the frequency of the received station is
shown on the front panel display.
y
Use the manual tuning method if the tuning search does not
stop at the desired station because the signal is weak.
Manual tuning
If the signal from the station you want to select is weak,
you must tune in to it manually.
1 Select TUNER and the reception band
following steps 1 and 2 described in
Automatic tuning on left.
2 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MANL MONO)
so that the AUTO indicator goes off from
the front panel display.
If the colon (:) appears on the front panel display
next to the band indication, press PRESET/TUNING
(EDIT) to turn it off.
3 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h to tune in to
the desired station manually.
Hold down the button to
continue the tuning search.
Note
Manually tuning in to an FM station will automatically change
the reception mode to monaural to increase the signal quality.
Automatic and Manual Tuning
There are 2 ways of tuning; automatic and manual.
Automatic tuning is effective when station signals are
strong and there is no interference.
Automatic tuning
1 Rotate INPUT (press TUNER on the remote
control) to select TUNER as the input source.
2 Press FM/AM to select the reception band.
FM or AM appears on the front panel display.
3 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MANL MONO)
so that the AUTO indicator lights up on the
front panel display.
If the colon (:) appears on the front panel display
next to the band indication, press PRESET/TUNING
(EDIT) to turn it off.
INPUT
PRESET/
TUNING
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
4
3
32
1
FM/AM
or
TUNING
MODE
AUTO/MAN'L MONO
AUTO
PRESET
/TUNING
EDIT
PHONO
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
or
Front panel Remote control
TUNING
MODE
AUTO/MAN'L MONO
AUTO
Goes off
PRESET
/TUNING
EDIT
PRESET/
TUNING
V
CR DVD TUNER CDCD R1
SP
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
AUTO
D
A
A~~AM~1404
~
V
CR DVD TUNER CDCD R1
SP
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
AUTO
D
A
A~~AM~1404
~
V
CR DVD TUNER CDCD R1
SP
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
D
A
A~~AM~1404
~
TUNING
Lights up
0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM38
39
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
TUNING
Presetting Stations
Automatically presetting stations
(for FM stations)
You can use the automatic preset tuning feature to store
FM stations. This function enables this unit to
automatically tune in to FM stations with strong signals,
and to store up to 40 (8 stations x 5 groups) of those
stations in order. This feature enables you to easily tune in
to any preset station by selecting the preset station
number (see page 41).
1 Press FM/AM to select the FM band.
2 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MANL MONO)
so that the AUTO indicator lights up on the
front panel display.
3 Press and hold MEMORY (MANL/AUTO FM)
for more than 3 seconds.
The preset number, the MEMORY and AUTO
indicators flash. Then, after about 5 seconds,
automatic preset tuning begins from the frequency
currently displayed toward the higher frequencies.
When automatic preset tuning is completed, the front
panel display shows the frequency of the last preset
station.
TUNING
MODE
AUTO/MAN'L MONO
MEMORY
MAN'L/AUTO FM
AUTO
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
MEMORY
MUTE VOLUME
SLEEP
AUTO
D
A
A1:FM 87.5 MHz
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
1
23
Lights up
y
When a station data is stored under a preset number, the
frequency and reception band are also stored.
You can manually replace a preset station with another FM or
AM station by simply following the procedure in the section
Exchanging Preset Stations on page 41.
If the number of the received stations does not reach E8,
automatic preset tuning has automatically stopped after
searching all stations.
Notes
Any stored station data existing under a preset number is
cleared when you store a new station under that preset number.
Only FM stations with sufficient signal strength are stored
automatically by automatic preset tuning. If the station you
want to store is weak in signal strength, tune in to it manually
in the monaural mode, and store it by following the procedure
in Manually presetting stations on page 40.
Automatic preset tuning options
You can select the preset number from which this unit
will store FM stations and/or begin tuning toward lower
frequencies.
1. Repeat steps 1 and 2 in Automatically presetting
stations on left.
2. After pressing MEMORY (MANL/AUTO FM) for
about 3 seconds, press A/B/C/D/E, then PRESET/
TUNING l / h to select the preset number under
which the first station will be stored.
Automatic preset tuning will stop when stations have
all been stored up to E8.
3. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn off the colon
(:) and then press PRESET/TUNING l to begin
tuning toward lower frequencies.
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is set in the standby
mode, the power cord is disconnected from the AC
outlet, or the power supply is temporarily cut due to
power failure. However, if the power is cut for more
than one week, the preset stations may be cleared. If
so, store the stations again by using the presetting
station methods.
FM/AM
0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM39
40
TUNING
Manually presetting stations
You can also store up to 40 stations (8 stations x 5
groups) manually.
1 Tune in to a station.
See page 38 for tuning instructions.
When tuned in to a station, the front panel display
shows the frequency of received station.
2 Press MEMORY (MANL/AUTO FM).
The MEMORY indicator flashes for about
5 seconds.
3 Press A/B/C/D/E repeatedly to select a preset
station group (A to E) while the MEMORY
indicator is flashing.
The group letter appears and make sure that the
colon (:) appears on the front panel display next to
the band indication.
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
43 2,5
Shows the displayed station has been stored as C3.
4 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h to select a
preset station number (1 to 8) while the
MEMORY indicator is flashing.
Press h to select a higher preset station number.
Press l to select a lower preset station number.
5 Press MEMORY (MANL/AUTO FM) on the
front panel while the MEMORY indicator is
flashing.
The station band and frequency
appear on the front panel
display with the preset group
and number you have selected.
6 Repeat steps 1 to 5 to store other stations.
Notes
Any stored station data existing under a preset number is
cleared when you store a new station under that preset number.
The reception mode (stereo or monaural) is stored along with
the station frequency.
MEMORY
MAN'L/AUTO FM
MEMORY
A/B/C/D/E
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
MEMORY
MUTE VOLUME
SLEEP
D
A
C :AM 630 kHz
Flashes
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
MUTE VOLUME
SLEEP
D
A
A :AM 630 kHz
PRESET/
TUNING
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
MEMORY
VOLUME
D
A
C3:AM 630 kHz
MEMORY
MAN'L/AUTO FM
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
MEMORY
VOLUME
D
A
C3:AM 630 kHz
0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM40
41
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERATION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
Exchanging Preset Stations
You can exchange the assignment of two preset stations
with each other. The example below describes the
procedure for exchanging preset station E1 with A5.
1 Tune in to preset station E1 by using the
A/B/C/D/E and PRESET/TUNING l / h.
See Tuning in to a Preset Station on left.
2 Press and hold PRESET/TUNING EDIT for
more than 3 seconds.
E1 and the MEMORY indicator flash on the
front panel display.
3 Tune in to preset station A5 by using the
A/B/C/D/E and PRESET/TUNING.
A5 and the MEMORY indicator flash on the
front panel display.
4 Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) again.
The stations stored at the two preset assignments are
exchanged.
Tuning in to a Preset Station
You can tune any desired station simply by selecting the
preset station number under which it was stored.
*1 These buttons can be used to directly select the preset group
(A to E from left to right).
*2 These buttons can be used to directly select the preset station
number 1 to 8.
1 Press A/B/C/D/E (A/B/C/D/E on the remote
control) to select the preset station group.
The preset group letter appears on the front panel
display and changes each time you press A/B/C/D/E.
Note
Make sure that TUNER mode is selected if operating using
the remote control.
2 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h (PRESET /+
on the remote control) to select a preset
station number (1 to 8).
The preset group and number appear on the front
panel display along with the station band, frequency
and the TUNED indicator lights up.
PRESET
/TUNING
EDIT
CH
PRESET
DISC
PRESET/
TUNING
A/B/C/D/E
TV INPUT
A/B/C/D/E
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
MEMORY
MUTE VOLUME
SLEEP
D
A
A5:FM 90.6 MHz
VCR DVD TUNER CDCD RV AUX 1
SP
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
MEMORY
D
A
EDIT E1-A5
Shows the exchange of stations has
been completed.
Front panel
Remote control
or
Front panel
Remote control
or
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
2
1
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
++
1
2
*1
*2
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
2,41,31,3
PRESET
/TUNING
EDIT
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD R1
SP
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
MEMORY
D
A
E1:FM 87.5 MHz
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD R1
SP
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
TUNED
D
A
E1:FM 87.5 MHz
TUNING
0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM41
42
BASIC RECORDING
REC OUT/ZONE 2 or REC OUT allows you to record
one source while watching and/or listening to another
source.
Recording adjustments and other operations are
performed from the recording components. Refer to the
operation instructions for these components.
1 Turn on the power to this unit and all
connected components.
2 Select the source component you want to
record from by using REC OUT/ZONE 2 or
REC OUT.
To record the current input source that you are
watching or listening to, set REC OUT/ZONE 2
or REC OUT to SOURCE/REMOTE.
To record a source other than the one that you are
watching or listening to, set REC OUT/ZONE 2
or REC OUT to the source you want to record.
Note
At this setting, you can change the source to listen to or watch
during recording by rotating INPUT (one of the input selector
buttons on the remote control).
3 Start playback (or select a broadcast station)
on the source component.
4 Start recording on the recording component.
y
Setting REC OUT/ZONE 2 or REC OUT to SOURCE/
REMOTE and using the BGV function (see page 28) allows the
recording of audio and video from a different source.
Notes
Do a test recording before you start an actual recording.
When this unit is set in the standby mode, you cannot record
between other components connected to this unit.
The setting of BASS, TREBLE, BASS EXTENSION,
VOLUME, 3 L/R BALANCE on the SET MENU and DSP
programs does not affect the recorded material.
A source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks of this unit
cannot be recorded.
S-video and composite video signals pass independently
through this units video circuits. Therefore, when recording or
dubbing video signals, if your video source component is
connected to provide only an S-video (or only a composite
video) signal, you can record only an S-video (or only a
composite video) signal by your VCR.
A given input source is not output on the same REC OUT
channel. (For example, the signal input from VCR 1 IN is not
output on VCR 1 OUT.)
Check the copyright laws in your country to record from
records, CDs, radio, etc. Recording of copyrighted material
may infringe copyright laws.
If you playback a video source that uses scrambled or
encoded signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the
picture itself may be disturbed due to those signals.
Special considerations when
recording DTS software
The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Attempting to
digitally record the DTS bitstream will result in noise
being recorded. Therefore, if you want to use this unit to
record sources that have DTS signals recorded on them,
the following considerations and adjustments need to be
made.
For LDs, DVDs and CDs encoded with DTS, when your
player is compatible with the DTS format, follow its
operation instruction to make a setting so that the analog
signal will be output from the player.
Timer playback/recording
This unit can perform playback or recording with an
external timer (not supplied). Refer to the operation
instruction for the component and the timer to be used.
Notes
The stored data such as input source will be reflected in the
playback or recording with the timer.
If you do not want any sound output during the recording with
a timer, turn the volume down.
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
(input source, volume level, set menu settings and so
on) from being lost even if this unit is in the standby
mode (disconnected from the AC outlet). However if
the timer is turned off for more than one week, the
stored data will be lost.
BASS
VOLUME
VIDEO AUXSILENT
PROGRAM
STEREO
REC OUT
/ZONE 2
SPEAKERS
6CH INPUT MODE
BASS
EXTENSION
PROCESSOR
DIRECT
PRESET
/
TUNING
PHONES
EFFECT
SOURCE
/REMOTE
MD/TAPE
CDR
TUNER
CD
PHONO
DVD
DTV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VAUX
VCR2
/DVR
A/B/C/D/E
S VIDEO
MEMORY
FM/AM
EDIT
PRESET
/TUNING
MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO
TUNING
MODE
VIDEO AUDIO OPTICALLR
STANDBY
/
ON
NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300
TREBLE
+
+
AB
DIGITAL
2
VCR2
/DVR
V-AUX
VCR 1
CBL/SAT
D-TV/LD
DVD
SOURCE
/REMOTE
REC OUT/ZONE 2
MD/TAPE
CD-R
TUNER
CD
PHONO
VCR2
/DVR
V-AUX
VCR 1
CBL/SAT
D-TV/LD
DVD
SOURCE
/REMOTE
REC OUT/ZONE 2
MD/TAPE
CD-R
TUNER
CD
PHONO
(U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models)
0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM42
43
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
The remote control can operate other A/V components of YAMAHA and other manufacturers as well as this unit. To
control those components, you must set up remote control with the manufacturer codes.
This remote control also has two sophisticated features: Learn and Macro. The Learn feature allows it to acquire
functions from the remote controls of other components in your system (or other household appliances) equipped with
an infrared remote control receiver. The Macro feature allows you to program a series of operations in sequence for
operation by a single button, or to use the factory-set macros to operate other YAMAHA components. These features
make it possible for you to reduce the number of remote control in your entertainment room.
Notes
For the operating distance of the remote control and notes about batteries, see pages 3 and 7.
For the name and function of each part and button, see pages 6 and 7.
Control Area
Control area of this unit
The control area of this unit is the shaded area shown
below. You can use the functions within this area no
matter which component control area is selected.
Control area for each component
The component control area is the shaded area shown
below. Each component has different functions for the
operation buttons in the component control area. The
component which has been chosen by pressing an input
selector button or SOURCE SELECT k/n can be
controlled and the display window shows the
corresponding name of the component to be operated.
Å/ı buttons and input
selector buttons switch the
control area for each
component.
* Å/ı buttons is to operate
the other components that are
not connected to this unit.
Factory setting:
Å ........... LD player
ı ..... Satellite tuner
Component control area
There are 13 component control areas. You can set up the
manufacturer code and program other remote control functions in
each area. See pages 52 to 56.
Input selector
buttons, and Å/ı
buttons
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
PARAMETER
SET MENU
EFFECT
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
6.1/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
TV
SPORTS
MONO
MOVIE
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
SOUND
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
DISPLAY
SEARCH
PLAY
+
ENTER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
DSP is selected
10 key is selected
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM43
44
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
Note
You may not be able to operate your Yamaha component even
if Yamaha manufacture code is initially set as listed above. In
this case, try to set other Yamaha manufacture code(s).
1 Press an input selector button, Å or ı to
select the source component you want to set
up.
2 Press and hold LEARN for about 3 seconds
by using a ballpoint pen or similar object.
SETUP and the selected component name appear
alternately in the display window.
Notes
Press LEARN for at least 3 seconds, otherwise the learning
process is started.
Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise,
the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case,
press LEARN again.
3 Press k / n to select the name of your
components manufacturer.
You will find the names of most worldwide audio-
video manufacturers in alphabetical order in the
display window.
If you want to change a library (component
category), press l / h. You can set a
different component from the input selector
name.
Library choices: L:DVD, L:LD, L:CD, L:CDR,
L:MD, L:TAP, L:TUN, L:AMP*, L:TV, L:CAB,
L:DBS, L:SAT, L:VCR
Amplifier Library (L:AMP)
The code to operate this unit has been preset in the
supplied remote control. However you can change the
code in Amplifier Library if necessary.
Amplifier Library has the following three codes:
YPC: Code to operate this unit.
Zone 2: Code to use the Zone 2 function.
DSP: Code to operate other Yamaha DSP amplifiers that
cannot be operated with the YPC code.
NO: Code to operate other manufacturers amplifiers
using this units remote control.
4 Press one of the buttons shaded below to
check if it works for the component being
set. If it does, the manufacturer code setting
has been correctly made.
Note
If the manufacturer of your component has more than one
codes, try each of them until you find the correct one.
y
If you continuously want to set up another code for another
component, press ENTER and repeat steps 1, 3 and 4.
Setting the Manufacturer Code
You can control other components by setting a
manufacturer code. A code can be set up in each input
area.
The following table shows factory-set component
(Library: component category) and the manufacturer code
for each area. If you are to make a setting for different
component from the factory setting, change the library as
described in step 3 on right.
LEARN
Input area
A
B
PHONO
V-AUX
TUNER
Component category
(Library)
LD
SAT
TV
VCR
TUNER
Manufacturer
Yamaha
Yamaha-1
ENTER
6CH INPUT
SOUND
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
Yamaha-1
Yamaha
Yamaha-1
MD/TAPE
CD-R
D-TV/LD
VCR 1
VCR 2/DVR
DVD
MD
CD-R
TV
VCR
VCR
DVD
CD
CBL/SAT
CD
CABLE
Yamaha-1
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:37 AM44
45
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
LEARN
5 Press LEARN again to exit from the setup
mode.
Notes
Supplied remote control does not store all the manufacturer
codes for commercially availabvle AV components (including
Yamaha AV components). Therefore it may not work to operate
your AV component. If operation is not possible with any of the
manfacturer codes, program the new remote control function
with the Learn feature (see page 45) or use the remote control
for the component.
If you have already programmed a remote control function for a
button, the function by learning programming takes priority
over the setup manufacturer codes function.
•“ERROR appears in the display window when pressing
buttons other than indicated in each step, or more than one
button at once.
Learn Feature
If you want to program functions not included in the basic
operations covered by the manufacturer code, or a
manufacturer code is not available, the following
procedure needs to be performed. The possible
programming area is the same as a component control
area, so the buttons are programmable independently for
each source component area.
Note
This remote control transmits infrared rays. If the other remote
control also uses infrared rays, this remote control can learn
most of the other remote controls functions. However, you
may not be able to program some special signals or extremely
long transmissions. (Refer to the operation instructions for the
other remote control.)
Programming a new remote
control function
1 Set 10KEY/DSP to 10KEY.
Notes
It is also possible to program in the control area of this unit
with 10KEY/DSP set to DSP. However, if you program
functions in this area, you cannot control this unit and select a
DSP program.
2 Press an input selector button, Å or ı to
select a source component.
5 to 10 cm (2 to 4 inch)
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
SOURCE
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AU X
POWER
LEARN
DSP
10KEY
Flashes alternately
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
3 Place this remote control and the other
remote control about 5 to 10 cm apart on a
flat surface so that their infrared transmitters
are aimed at each other.
4 Press LEARN by using a ballpoint pen or
similar object.
Do not press and hold LEARN longer than three
seconds. Otherwise this unit enters the manufacturer
code setting mode.
Notes
Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise,
the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case,
press LEARN again.
Do not press and hold LEARN longer than 3 seconds.
Otherwise this unit enters the manufacturer code setting mode.
5 Press the button for which you want to
program the new function.
LEARN is displayed.
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
SOURCE
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AU X
POWER
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM45
46
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
LEARN
Changing the Source Name in the
Display Window
You can change the name that appears in the display
window on the remote control if you want to use the
different name from the original input selector button
names. This is useful when different component is set in
the input selector button.
1 Press an input selector button, Å or ı to
select the source component you want to
rename.
The selected component name appears in the display
window.
2 Press RE-NAME by using
a ballpoint pen or similar
object.
3 Press k / n to select a character.
Choices are A to Z, a to z, 0 to 9, space, -(hyphen),
and /(slash).
4 Press l / h to move the cursor to the next
position.
y
If you continuously want to rename another source component,
press ENTER and repeat steps 1, 3 and 4.
5 Press RE-NAME again to exit from the
renaming mode.
Note
•“ERROR appears in the display window when pressing butons
other than indicated in each step, or more than one button at
once.
RE-NAME
ENTER
ENTER
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
RE-NAME
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
SOURCE
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AU X
POWER
6 Press and hold the button on the other
remote control that has the function you
want to program into this remote control
until OK appears in the display window.
Notes
•“NG appears in the display window when programming has
not been done correctly. In this case, start over from step 5.
This remote control can learn approximately 120 functions.
However depending on the signals learned, FULL may
appear in the display window much earlier than this number. In
this case, clear unnecessary programmed functions to make
further learning on the remote control.
7 Repeat steps 5 and 6 to program additional
functions.
8 Press LEARN again to exit from the learning
mode.
Notes
Learning may not be possibe in the following cases:
when the batteries in the remote control for this unit or other
components are weak
when the distance between the two remote controls is too
much or too little
when the remote control infrared windows are not facing at
the appropriate angle
when the remote control is exposed to the direct sunlight
when the function to be programmed is continuous or
uncommon
•“ERROR appears in the display window when pressing more
than one button at once.
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM46
47
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
Using the Macro Feature
The Macro feature makes it possible to perform a series of operations by pressing just one button. For example, when
you want to play a CD, normally you would turn on the components, select the CD input, and press the play button to
start playback. The Macro feature lets you perform all those operations by simply pressing the CD macro button. The
macro buttons (the input selector buttons, Å and ı buttons, SYSTEM POWER and STANDBY) are factory set with
macro programs. You can also program your own macros (see page 48).
*1 In order to turn on some components (including YAMAHA components) connected to this unit, connect those
components to the AC OUTLET(S) on the rear panel. (Power control may not be synchronized with this unit
depending on the component. For details, please refer to the operation instruction for the connected component.)
*2 If the macro you select includes power control functions, the component may be turned off if it is already on when
you press the macro button. For example, if your TV is on and you press the SYSTEM POWER macro button, the
TV is turned off.
*3 Playback can be started with any YAMAHA remote control-compatible MD recorders, CD players, CD recorders,
DVD players, and LD players. When using macros to operate other components, it is either necessary to program the
PLAY button on the control area of that component (see pages 45 and 46) or to set up a manufacturer code (see
page 44).
*4 When TUNER is selected as the input source, this unit receives the last station when this unit is set in the standby
mode.
(DVD area) (*3)
Press one of the macro buttons
Automatically transmits signals of each button sequentially
CD
SYSTEM
POWER
CD
PLAY
(CD area)
Macro buttons
PHONO
V-AUX
TUNER
MD/TAPE
CD-R
CD
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VCR2/DVR
DVD
A
B
STANDBY
SYSTEM
POWER
First Second
Third
PHONO
V-AUX
TUNER
MD/TAPE
CD-R
CD
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
VCR 1
VCR2/DVR
DVD
POWER
PLAY
(*1)
(D-TV/LD area) (*2)
PLAY
PLAY
PLAY
PLAY
PLAY
(MD/TAPE area) (*3)
(CD-R area) (*3)
(CD area) (*3)
(VCR 1 area) (*3)
(VCR 2/DVR area) (*3)
(*4)
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 8/21/02, 11:15 AM47
48
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
2 Press a macro button for which you want to
program the macro operation.
The button you chose for programming the macro
operation and the selected component name appear
alternately in the display window.
Notes
•“AGAIN appears in the display window when a button other
than the macro buttons is pressed.
If you want to change the source component, use SOURCE
SELECT k / n. When you use the input selector buttons,
selecting the input is programmed as a macro step, whereas
SOURCE SELECT k / n only changes the component.
3 Press the buttons of the functions that you
want to include in the macro operation
sequence in order.
y
You can set up to 10 steps (10 functions). After you have set 10
steps, FULL appears and the remote control automatically
exits from the macro mode.
Note
•“NG appears in the display window when programming has
not been done correctly. In this case, start over from step 2.
Operating the macro
1 Set MACRO ON/OFF to ON.
2 Press a macro button.
Notes
When you have finished using the Macro feature, set MACRO
ON/OFF to OFF.
While this unit is carrying out a macro program, this unit does
not receive any other buttons function until the macro
operation has been completed (the TRANSMIT indicator stops
flashing).
Continue to aim the remote control at the component the macro
is operating until the macro operation has been completed.
Programming a macro
You can program your own macros and use the Macro
feature to transmit many remote control commands by
pressing a single button.
Notes
The factory-set macro is not cleared when a new macro is
programmed for a button. The factory-set macro can be used
again when the programmed macro is cleared.
It is not possible to add a new signal (macro step) to the
factory-set macro. Programming a macro changes all macro
contents.
A macro programming is used to transmit learning or setup (or
YAMAHA preset) button signals of this remote control to a
macro button. If necessary, set up the manufacturer code or
program a function with the remote control for your
component.
This remote control handles button signals that operate
continuously, such as volume control, as short time interval
codes. Macro programming that include these types of macro
steps are therefore not recommended.
1 Press MACRO by using a ballpoint pen or
similar object.
MCR ? appears in the display window.
Note
Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise,
the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case,
press MACRO again.
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
POWER
Macro buttons
MACRO
MACRO ON/OFF
MACRO
indicate the number
of macro steps you
entered
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
POWER
1
2
MCR 2 : DVD p
MCR 1 : DVD a
appear alternately so that you can
set up the next step
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM48
49
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
4 Press MACRO again when
the operation sequence
you want to program is
complete.
Note
•“ERROR appears in the display when pressing butons other
than indicated in each step, or more than one button at once.
Memory back-up
If the remote control is without batteries for more than
3 minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the
remote control, the contents of the memory may be
cleared. When the memory is cleared, insert new
batteries, set up the manufacturer code and program
any acquired functions that may have been cleared.
MACRO
Clearing Learned Functions,
Macros, Renamed Source Names,
and Setup Manufacturer Codes
1 Press CLEAR by using a ballpoint pen or
similar object.
Note
Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise,
the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case,
press CLEAR again.
CLEAR
3 Press and hold CLEAR again for about 3
seconds.
C:OK appears in the display window.
Note
•“C:NG appears in the display window if the operation is
unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 2.
4 Press CLEAR to exit from the clearing mode.
Once you have cleared a learned function or macro
for a button, the button reverts to the factory setting.
Note
•“ERROR appears in the display window under the following
circumstances:
when pressing a button other than the cursor and ENTER;
when pressing more than one button at once; or
when MACRO ON/OFF, 10KEY/DSP or PARAMETER/SET
MENU is switched to another position.
CLEAR
CLEAR
Clears all programmed functions
including setup manufacturer
codes. This returns to the
factory settings.
(L: name of a component) Clears
all learned functions for the
component area. Press the input
selector button, Å or ı to select
the component.
Clears all learned functions for
this unit control area.
Clears all learned functions.
Clears all programmed macros.
Clears all renamed source
names in the display window.
2 Press k / n to select the clear mode.
The mode is shown in the display window in the
following order:
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM49
50
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
MACRO
MACRO
LEARN
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
LEARN
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
Clearing a macro function
1 Press MACRO to clear a programmed macro
by using a ballpoint pen or similar object.
Note
Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise
the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case,
press MACRO again.
2 Press and hold CLEAR by using a ballpoint
pen or similar object, then press the button
for which you want to clear the macro for
about 3 seconds.
C:OK appears in the display window.
y
You can clear other learned functions and macros at this time
by holding down CLEAR again and pressing the other buttons
for which those learned functions or macros have been
programmed.
Note
•“C:NG appears in the display window if the operation is
unsuccessful. In this case, try step 2 again.
3 Press MACRO again to exit from the clearing
mode.
Once you have cleared macro for a button, the button
reverts to the factory setting.
TRANSMIT
RE-NAME
STANDBY
SYSTEM
CLEAR LEARN MACRO
OFF ON
MACRO
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
Clearing a Learned Function
You can clear the function learned in a certain
programmable button in each area.
1 Press an input selector button, Å or ı to
select the source component you want to
clear the function.
The selected component name appears in the display
window.
2 Press LEARN by using a ballpoint pen or
similar object.
LEARN and the selected component name appear
alternately in the display window.
Note
Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise
the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case,
press LEARN again.
3 Press and hold CLEAR by using a ballpoint
pen or similar object, then press the button
for which you want to clear the function for
about 3 seconds.
C:OK appears in the display window.
4 Press LEARN again to
exit.
Once you have cleared a learned function for a
button, the button reverts to the factory setting.
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM50
51
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
Pressing n always selects OPTN first
SELECT
SOURCE
Pressing k selects Zone2 first
6CH INPUT
SOUND
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
6CH INPUT
SOUND
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
SOURCE SELECT k / n
You can control another component independently from
the input you have selected by pressing an input selector
button.
Press SOURCE SELECT k / n to choose the
component and set the remote control to be
used for it.
The display window will show one of the following:
(when pressing n) OPTN (option), Å, ı, PHONO,
V-AUX, TUNER, MD, CD-R, CD, TV/LD (TV or
digital TV/LD), CBSAT (cable TV/satellite tuner),
VCR 1, VCR 2, DVD.
y
Pressing k shows the same in the reverse order, but you cannot
select OPTN.
OPTN (option) area
OPTN is an extra component control area that can be
programmed with other remote control functions.
Note
You cannot set up the manufacturer code in this area. See
pages 45, 46 for the programming procedure.
Zone 2 (U.S.A., Canada and
Australia models only)
When you make up a second audio-video room with this
units Zone 2 feature, you must set Zone2 as the
amplifier library in the remote control first. Selecting
Zone2 by pressing k sets the remote control to the
Zone 2 mode. See pages 71 and 72 for details.
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM51
52
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
Each Component Control Area
The general operational buttons are shown for each area. Some of them may not function depending on the component
you have. After setting the manufacturer code, press an input selector button, Å / ı, or SELECT k / n to select a
component you want to control.
Operating a DVD player (DVD area)
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
* TV VOL +/, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the
manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both D-
TV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area.
Operating a VCR (VCR 1 and VCR 2/DVR areas)
* TV VOL +/, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the
manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both D-
TV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area.
DISPLAY
DISC +/ (disc skip)
STOP
*
Title/Index
TITLE
MENU
Return
POWER
SEARCH
Menu cursor/ENTER
Audio
Skip search
PLAY
PAUSE
Numeric buttons
Clear
CH +/ (channel)
SEARCH
POWER
Record
(Press twice to start recording)
TV/Video input
*
STOP
PLAY
PAUSE
Numeric buttons
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM52
53
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
Operating a TV/digital TV (D-TV/LD area) or a cable TV/satellite TV (CBL/
SAT area)
Set the manufacture code for your LD player following the setting procedure described on page 44 because TV is
factory-set for this input selector button.
* TV VOL +/, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the
manufacturer code is set in PHONO.
* SEARCH, REC, STOP, PAUSE and PLAY function to operate your VCR without switching the input to VCR 1 if the
manufacturer code is set in VCR 1.
Operating an LD player (D-TV/LD area)
CH +/ (channel)
DISPLAY
POWER
Enter
TV INPUT
TV VOL +/
TV MUTE
*
Numeric buttons
Clear
DISPLAY
SEARCH
POWER
STOP
Chapter/Time
*
SOUND
CHAPTER /+ (chapter search)
PLAY
PAUSE
Numeric buttons
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM53
54
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
Operating a CD player (CD area)
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
* TV VOL +/, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the
manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both D-
TV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area.
Operating a CD recorder (CD-R area) or an MD recorder (MD/TAPE area)
* TV VOL +/, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the
manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both D-
TV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area.
DISC +/ (disc skip)
DISPLAY
SEARCH
POWER
STOP
INDEX
*
Skip search
PLAY
PAUSE
Numeric buttons
Clear
DISPLAY
SEARCH
POWER
STOP
INDEX
(CD-R only)
*
Skip search
PLAY
PAUSE
Numeric buttons
Clear
(CD-R only)
Record
(MD only)
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM54
55
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
Operating a tape deck (MD/TAPE area)
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
* TV VOL +/, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the
manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both D-
TV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area.
Operating a tuner (TUNER area)
SEARCH backward/forward
Record
STOP
INDEX
A/B
Direction A/B
PLAY
PAUSE
Numeric buttons
PRESET +/
POWER
Preset group A
Preset group B
Preset group C
Preset group A/B/C/D/E
Preset number 1 to 8
Preset group E
Preset group D
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM55
56
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES
STANDBY
6CH INPUT
SOUND
SYSTEM
PHONO
A
B
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-AUX
POWER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
Operating the component set in
Å or ı
These buttons are not input selector buttons but simply provide the space for an extra component to control with this
units remote control without making connection to this unit. The white area shown below can be used for the
component set in Å and ı, and the function for each button differs depending on the component.
YAMAHA LD player is factory-set in Å and sattellite tuner in ı. However if you want to set other component, set the
manufacturer code for the component you want to set in the Å / ı button following the manufacturer code setting
procedure described on page 44.
The functions of these buttons in the
component control area differ for the
component you set in Å or ı.
0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM56
57
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
Adjusting the Items on the SET
MENU
Adjustment should be made with the remote control.
Adjustment procedures are explained using SET MENU 2
LOW FRQ TEST as an example.
1 Set PARAMETER/SET
MENU to SET MENU.
2 Press k / n repeatedly to select the item (1 to
16) you want to adjust.
Note
If k is pressed when SET MENU 1 is selected, and if n is
pressed when SET MENU 16 is selected, SET MENU will be
closed. Press k / n to open SET MENU again.
3 Press /+ once to enter the setup mode of
the selected item.
The last setting you adjusted appears on the video
monitor or on the front panel display.
Depending on the item, press k / n to select a sub
item.
2 LOW FRQ TEST
≥ OUTPUT…MAIN L/R
FRQ……………………88Hz
TEST TONE………OFF
PARAMETER
SET MENU
SET MENU
ADVANCED OPERATION
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
PARAMETER
SET MENU
EFFECT
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
++
1
2, 3, 5
3, 4
5
The SET MENU consists of 16 items including the
speaker mode setting, center graphic equalizer and
parameter initialization features. Choose the appropriate
item and adjust or select the values as necessary.
y
You can adjust the items on the SET MENU while playing a
source.
We recommend that you adjust the items on the SET MENU
while using a video monitor. It is easier to see the video
monitor than it is to see the front panel display on this unit
while adjusting the items.
Note
The indication on the front panel display is the abbreviation of
the OSD.
1 SPEAKER SET
1A CENTER SP
1B MAIN SP
1C REAR L/R SP
1D REAR CT SP
1E LFE/BASS OUT
1F MAIN LEVEL
1G SP B SET
2 LOW FRQ TEST
3 L/R BALANCE
4 HP TONE CTRL
5 CENTER GEQ
6 INPUT RENAME
7 I/O ASSIGNMENT
7A CMPNT-V INPUT
7B OPTICAL OUT
7C OPTICAL IN
7D COAXIAL IN
8 INPUT MODE
9 PARAM. INI
10 LFE LEVEL
11 D-RANGE
12 SP DELAY
13 DISPLAY SET
14 MEMORY GUARD
15 6CH INPUT SET
16 ZONE 2 SET (U.S.A., Canada and Australia
models)
2 LOW FRQ TEST
OUTPUT…MAIN L/R
FRQ……………………88Hz
≥ TEST TONE………OFF
SET MENU 1/4
≥ 2 LOW FRQ TEST
3 L/R BALANCE
4 HP TONE CTRL
/ : Up/Down
-/+ : Enter
1 SPEAKER SET
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM57
58
SET MENU
LRG SML NONE
1A CENTER SP
4 Press /+ repeatedly to change the setting of
the item.
5 Press k / n repeatedly until the current DSP
program appears or simply press one of the
DSP program group buttons to exit from the
SET MENU.
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is in the standby
mode. However if the power cord is disconnected from
the AC outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than
one week, the stored data will be lost. If so, adjust the
items again.
2 LOW FRQ TEST
OUTPUT…MAIN L/R
FRQ……………………88Hz
≥ TEST TONE…………ON
LRG SML NONE
1A CENTER SP
LRG SML NONE
1A CENTER SP
HALL 1
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
1 SPEAKER SET (speaker mode
settings)
Use this feature to select suitable output modes for your
speaker configuration.
Notes
When 96-kHz sampling digital signals are input to this unit,
level adjustments in items 1B,1E and 1F are possible, but those
in items 1A,1C and 1D are not affected.
When 6CH INPUT is selected as the input source, level
adjustments in items 1A through 1E are not affected.
y
Select SML if the woofer diameter of you speaker is smaller
than 16 cm. If it is larger than 16 cm, select LRG.
1A CENTER SP (center speaker
mode)
By adding a center speaker to your speaker configuration,
this unit can provide good dialog localization for many
listeners and superior synchronization of sound and
images. The OSD shows a large, small or no center
speaker depending on how you set this item.
Choices: LRG (large), SML (small), NONE
Initial setting: LRG
LRG
Select this if you have a large center speaker. The entire
range of the center channel signal is directed to the center
speaker.
SML
Select this if you have a small center speaker. The low-
frequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the center
channel are directed to the speakers selected with 1E
LFE/BASS OUT.
NONE
Select this if you do not have a center speaker. All of the
center channel signal are directed to the left and right
main speakers.
or
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM58
59
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SET MENU
1C REAR L/R SP (rear speaker
mode)
The OSD shows large, small or no rear speakers
depending on how you set this item.
Choices: LRG (large), SML (small), NONE
Initial setting: LRG
LRG
Select this if you have large left and right rear speakers or
if a rear subwoofer is connected to the rear speakers. The
entire range of the rear channel signal is directed to the
left and right rear speakers.
SML
Select this if you have small left and right rear speakers.
The low-frequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the rear
channel are directed to the speakers selected with 1E
LFE/BASS OUT.
NONE
Select this if you do not have rear speakers.
Note
If 1C REAR L/R SP is set to NONE, 1D REAR CT SP
will be skipped.
y
This unit is set in the virtual CINEMA DSP mode by selecting
NONE for 1C REAR L/R SP (see page 32).
LARGE SMALL
1B MAIN SP
LRG SML NONE
1C REAR L/R SP
LRG SML NONE
1C REAR L/R SP
LRG SML NONE
1C REAR L/R SP
LARGE SMALL
1B MAIN SP
1B MAIN SP (main speaker mode)
The OSD shows large or small main speakers depending
on how you set this item.
Choices: LARGE, SMALL
Initial setting: LARGE
LARGE
Select this if you have large main speakers. The entire
range of the left and right main channel signal is directed
to the left and right main speakers.
SMALL
Select this if you have small main speakers. The low-
frequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the main channel
are directed to the speakers selected with 1E LFE/BASS
OUT.
Note
When you select MAIN for 1E LFE/BASS OUT, the low-
frequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the main channel are
directed to the main speakers even if you select SMALL for the
main speaker mode.
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM59
60
SET MENU
1D REAR CT SP (rear center
speaker mode)
By adding a rear center speaker to your speaker
configuration, this unit can provide more realistic front-
to-back and transitions. The initial setting is LRG.
Note
If 1C REAR L/R SP is set to NONE, 1D REAR CT SP
will be skipped.
Choices: LRG (large), SML (small), NONE
Initial setting: LRG
LRG
Select this if you have a large rear center speaker. The
entire range of the rear center channel signal is directed to
the rear center speaker.
SML
Select this if you have a small rear center speaker. The
low-frequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the rear
center channel are directed to the speakers selected with
1E LFE/BASS OUT.
NONE
Select this if you do not have a rear center speaker. All of
the rear center channel signal are directed to the left and
right rear speakers.
SWFR MAIN BOTH
1E LFE/BASS OUT
SWFR MAIN BOTH
1E LFE/BASS OUT
SWFR MAIN BOTH
1E LFE/BASS OUT
LRG SML NONE
1D REAR CT SP
LRG SML NONE
1D REAR CT SP
LRG SML NONE
1D REAR CT SP
1E LFE/BASS OUT (bass out
mode)
LFE signals carry low-frequency effects when this unit
decodes a Dolby Digital or DTS signal. Low-frequency
signals are defined as 90 Hz and below. The Low-
frequency signals are directed to both main right and left
speakers, and the subwoofer (subwoofer can be used for
both stereo reproduction and the DSP program).
Choices: SWFR (subwoofer), MAIN, BOTH
Initial setting: BOTH
SWFR
Select this if you use a subwoofer. The LFE signals are
directed to the subwoofer.
MAIN
Select this if you do not use a subwoofer. The LFE signals
are directed to the main speakers.
BOTH
Select this if you use a subwoofer and you want to mix
the main channel low-frequency signals with the LFE
signals. LFE signals for the main L/R speakers are output
from both L/R speakers and subwoofer.
Note
The low-frequency signals (90 Hz and below) from all main,
center, rear and rear center channels are directed to the LFE
channel when you select the small speaker setting in items 1A,
1B, 1C and 1D.
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM60
61
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SET MENU
Normal -10dB
1F MAIN LEVEL
Normal -10dB
1F MAIN LEVEL
2 LOW FRQ TEST
Use this feature to adjust the output level of the
subwoofer so it matches that of the other speakers in your
configuration. Change the setting with the remote control
while sitting in the listening position.
1 Press /+ to set TEST TONE to ON, and
adjust the volume with VOLUME +/ so you
can hear the tone.
Notes
Do not turn up the volume too high.
If no test tone is heard, turn down the volume, set this unit in
the standby mode and make sure all the necessary connections
are correct.
2 Press n to go to OUTPUT and press /+ to
select the speaker you want to compare with
the subwoofer.
If SWFR is selected, the test tone above 90 Hz will
not be output from the subwoofer. The test tone will
not necessarily be output from the selected speakers.
The output mode of the test tone depends on the
settings of 1 SPEAKER SET on the SET MENU.
2 LOW FRQ TEST
OUTPUT…MAIN L/R
FRQ……………………88Hz
≥ TEST TONE…………ON
2 LOW FRQ TEST
≥ OUTPUT…MAIN L/R
FRQ……………………88Hz
TEST TONE………OFF
1G SP B SET (speaker B set)
Use this feature to select the location of the main speakers
to be connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals.
Choices: MAIN, ZONE B
Initial setting: MAIN
MAIN
Select this to turn on/off SPEAKERS A and B when the
speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals are set
in the main room.
1G SP B SET
-/+ : Select
/ : Exit
“MAIN ZONE B
ZONE B
Select this if the speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B
terminals are set in the second room. If SPEAKERS A is
turned OFF and SPEAKERS B is turned ON, all the
effect speakers in the main room are muted and the sound
is output only from SPEAKERS B.
y
When a DSP program is selected, this unit automatically enters
the Virtual CINEMA DSP mode. If the headphones are
connected to PHONES jack on this unit in the Virtual
CINEMA DSP mode, this unit enters the SILENT CINEMA
DSP mode and the sound is output from both headphones and
SPEAKERS B.
1G SP B SET
-/+ : Select
/ : Exit
MAIN “ZONE B
1F MAIN LEVEL (main level
mode)
Change this setting if you cannot match the output level
of the center, rear (L/R) and rear center speakers with the
main speakers because of the unusually high-efficiency
performance of the main speakers.
Choices: Normal, 10 dB
Initial setting: Normal
Normal
Select this if you can match the output level of your effect
speakers with that of your main speakers when using the
test tone.
10 dB
Select this if you cannot match the output level of your
effect speakers with that of your main speakers when
using the test tone.
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM61
62
SET MENU
5 CENTER GEQ
≥ 300Hz
1kHz
3kHz
10kHz
-+
+3dB
100Hz
4 HP TONE CTRL (headphone tone
control)
Use this feature to adjust the level of the bass and treble
when you use your headphones.
Control range (dB): 6 to +3 for both BASS and TRBL
(treble)
Initial setting: 0 dB for both BASS and TRBL (treble)
5 CENTER GEQ (center graphic
equalizer)
Use this feature to adjust the built-in 5-band graphic
equalizer so that the center speaker tonal quality matches
that of the left and right main speakers. You can select the
100 Hz, 300 Hz, 1 kHz, 3 kHz, or 10 kHz frequencies.
Control range (dB): 6 to +6
Initial setting: 0 dB for 5-band
1 Press n to select a higher frequency and k
to select a lower frequency.
2 Press /+ to adjust the level of that
frequency.
y
You can monitor the center speaker sound while adjusting this
item by using the test tone. Press TEST before starting the
foregoing procedure. TEST DOLBY SUR. appears on the
video monitor, and the test tone starts alternating among the
speakers. Once you begin this procedure, the test tone remains
at the center speaker and you can hear how the sound changes
as you adjust the various frequency levels. To stop the test tone,
press TEST (see pages 25 and 26).
3 L/R BALANCE
0
-/+ : Adjust
/ : Exit
L
…………………… ……………………
R
4 HP TONE CTRL
TRBL
-
+
0dB
≥ BASS
5 CENTER GEQ
300Hz
1kHz
3kHz
10kHz
-+
0dB
≥ 100Hz
3 Press n to go to FRQ and press /+ to
select the frequency you want to use.
4 Adjust the volume of the subwoofer with the
controls on the subwoofer so it matches that
of the speaker you are comparing it to.
About the test tone
The test tone is produced by the tone generator.
The tone generator produces a narrow-band noise
centered on a specified frequency by the band pass filter
besides a wide-band noise.
You can change this center frequency from 35 Hz through
250 Hz in one-sixth octave steps.
You can use the test tone not only for adjusting the
subwoofer level, but also for checking the low-frequency
characteristics of your listening room. Low-frequency
sounds are especially affected by the listeners position,
speaker placement, subwoofer polarity and other
conditions.
3 L/R BALANCE (balance of the
left and right main speakers)
Use this feature to adjust the balance of the output level
from the left and right main speakers.
Control range: 10 steps for L/R
Initial setting: 0 dB for L/R
Press + to decrease the output level for the
left main speaker. Press for the right main
speaker.
2 LOW FRQ TEST
OUTPUT…MAIN L/R
≥ FRQ……………………88Hz
TEST TONE………OFF
Digital generator (wide band noise produced)
Band pass filter
35 Hz 250 HzCenter freq.
Freq.
Noise
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM62
63
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SET MENU
6 INPUT RENAME
Use this feature to change the name of the input which
appears on the OSD or the front panel display.
1 Press an input selector button to select the
input you want to change the name of.
2 Press /+ to place the _ (under-bar) under
the space or the character you want to edit.
3 Press k / n to select the character you want
to use and /+ to move to the next one.
Press n to change the character in the following
order, or press k to go in the reverse order.
A to Z, a space, 0 to 9, a space, a to z, a space, #,
*, +, and so on.
Follow the foregoing procedure to rename other
inputs.
Note
You can use up to 8 characters to rename the inputs.
4 Press + repeatedly to exit from INPUT
RENAME.
6 INPUT RENAME
-/+ : Position
/ : Character
DVD ≥ DVD
6 INPUT RENAME
-/+ : Position
/ : Character
DVD ≥ DVD1
6 INPUT RENAME
-/+ : Position
/ : Character
DVD ≥ DVD
7A CMPNT-V INPUT
[B]……………CBL/SAT
≥ [A]…………… DVD
7B OPTICAL OUT
(2)…………… CD-R
≥ (1)……………MD/TAPE
7 I/O ASSIGNMENT
It is possible to assign jacks according to the component
to be used if this units COMPONENT VIDEO input jack
or DIGITAL INPUT/OUTPUT jack settings (component
names for jacks) differ from that component. This makes
it possible to change the jack assignment and effectively
connect more component.
Once you assign, you can select that component with
INPUT (the input selector buttons on the remote control).
7A CMPNT-V INPUT for
COMPONENT VIDEO INPUT jacks
[A] and [B]
Choices: [A] DVD, V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1,
CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD
[B] CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, V-AUX,
VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1
Initial settings: [A] DVD
[B] CBL/SAT
7B OPTICAL OUT for OPTICAL
OUTPUT jacks (1) and (2)
Choices: (1) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO,
V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/
SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD
(2) CD-R, CD, PHONO, V-AUX, VCR 2/
DVR, VCR 1, CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD,
DVD, MD/TAPE
Initial settings: (1) MD/TAPE
(2) CD-R
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM63
64
SET MENU
8 INPUT MODE (initial input
mode)
Use this feature to designate the input mode for sources
connected to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn
on this unit (see page 29 for details about the input
mode).
Choices: AUTO, LAST
Initial setting: AUTO
AUTO
Select this to allow this unit to automatically detect the
type of input signal and select the appropriate input mode.
LAST
Select this to set this unit to automatically select the last
input mode used for that source.
Note
Even if LAST is selected, the last setting for the EX/ES button
will not be recalled.
7C OPTICAL IN for OPTICAL
INPUT jacks (3) to (6)
Choices: (3) CD, PHONO, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1,
CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/
TAPE, CD-R
(4) CD-R, CD, PHONO, VCR 2/DVR,
VCR 1, CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD,
MD/TAPE
(5) DVD, MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD,
PHONO, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/
SAT, D-TV/LD
(6) CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/
TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, VCR 2/
DVR, VCR 1
Initial settings: (3) CD
(4) CD-R
(5) DVD
(6) CBL/SAT
7D COAXIAL IN for COAXIAL
INPUT jacks (7) and (8)
Choices: (7) CD, PHONO, V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR,
VCR 1, CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD,
MD/TAPE, CD-R
(8) D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/TAPE, CD-R,
CD, PHONO, V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR,
VCR 1, CBL/SAT
Initial settings: (7) CD
(8) D-TV/LD
Note
You cannot select an item more than once for the same type of
jack.
7D COAXIAL IN
≥ (8)……………D-TV/LD
(7)…………… CD
8 INPUT MODE
-/+ : Select
/ : Exit
AUTO LAST
7C OPTICAL IN
(4)…………… CD-R
≥ (5)…………… DVD
(6)……………CBL/SAT
(3)…………… CD
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM64
65
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SET MENU
11 D-RANGE (dynamic range)
Use this feature to adjust the dynamic range. This setting
is effective only when this unit decodes Dolby Digital
signals.
Choices: MAX, STD, MIN
Initial setting: MAX (for both speakers and headphones)
MAX
Select the MAX setting for feature films.
STD
Select the STD (Standard) setting for general use.
MIN
Select the MIN setting for listening to sources at
extremely low volume levels.
11 D-RANGE
HP: MAX STD MIN
≥ SP: MAX STD MIN
9 PARAM. INI (parameter
initialization)
Use this feature to initialize the parameters for each DSP
program within a DSP program group. When you
initialize a DSP program group, all of the parameter
values within that group revert to their initial settings.
Press the corresponding numeric button for
the DSP program that you want to initialize.
The asterisk (*) next to the program number means
that the parameter values have been changed.
Notes
You cannot initialize the individual DSP programs within a
group separately.
When 14 MEMORY GUARD is set to ON (see page 67),
you cannot initialize any program groups.
Once you initialize a DSP program group, you cannot
automatically revert to the previous parameter settings.
9 PARAM. INI
* 5 678
9 *10 11
Press No. Key
1 23*4
10 LFE LEVEL
HEADPHONE…………0dB
≥ SPEAKER………………0dB
10 LFE LEVEL
HEADPHONE…………0dB
≥ SPEAKER…………-11dB
10 LFE LEVEL
This setting is effective only when this unit decodes
Dolby Digital or DTS signals.
Use this feature to adjust the output level of the LFE
(low-frequency effect) channel when playing back a
Dolby Digital or DTS signal. The LFE signal carries the
low-frequency special effect sound which is only added to
certain scenes.
Control range (dB): 20 to 0 for both SPEAKER and
HEADPHONE
Initial setting: 0 dB for both SPEAKER and
HEADPHONE
1 Press k / n to select the item to be adjusted.
2 Press /+ to adjust the LFE level.
Note
Adjust the LFE level according to the capacity of your
subwoofer or headphones.
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM65
66
SET MENU
12 SP DELAY
Use this feature to adjust the delay of the Center and the
Rear Center channel sounds. This feature works when
there is sound output from the center speakers with a
source like Dolby Digital or DTS, etc. Ideally, the Center
speaker and the Rear Center speaker should be the same
distance from the main listening position as the left and
right Main speakers. However, in most home situations,
the Center speaker or the Rear Center speaker is placed in
line with the Main speakers or the Rear speakers. By
delaying the sound from the Center speaker and the Rear
Center speaker, the apparent distance from the Center
speaker and the Rear Center speaker to the main listening
position can be adjusted to make it seem the same as the
distance between the left and right Main speaker, and the
left and right Rear speakers to the listening position.
Adjusting the delay time for the Center speaker is
especially important for giving depth to the dialogue.
1 Press k / n to select UNIT.
2 Press /+ to select the unit to be used for
setting.
Select one from msec, meters, and feet.
Notes
Setting items change depending on the unit chosen.
When meters or feet is selected, enter the distance from
your listening position to each speaker.
3 Press k / n to select the speaker for which
the delay is adjusted.
4 Press /+ to set the delay.
Press + for higher value and for lower value.
L
C
C
RC
R
RL
RR
RC
Center speaker image
Setting by msec
Control range: 0 to 5.0 ms (for center), 0 to 30.0 ms
(for rear center)
Initial settings: 0 ms (for center), 3.0 ms (for rear
center)
Setting by meters
Control range: 0.15 to 30.00 m (for main L/R,
center, rear L/R, rear center)
Initial settings: 3.00 m (for main L/R, center, rear L/
R), 2.10 m (for rear center)
Setting by feet
Control range: 0.5 to 100 ft (for main L/R, center,
rear L/R, rear center)
Initial settings: 10.0 ft (for main L/R, center, rear L/
R), 7.0 ft (for rear center)
Note
No delay will be set if the same distance is set for the main L/R
and center, or the rear L/R and rear center with meters or
feet selected.
12 SP DELAY
CENTER……………0.0ms
REAR CT…………3.0ms
≥ UNIT……………………msec
12 SP DELAY
MAIN L/R………3.00m
CENTER……………3.00m
REAR L/R………3.00m
≥ UNIT………………meters
REAR CT…………2.10m
12 SP DELAY
MAIN L/R……10.0ft
CENTER…………10.0ft
REAR L/R……10.0ft
≥ UNIT……………………feet
REAR CT…………7.0ft
12 SP DELAY
CENTER……………0.0ms
REAR CT…………3.0ms
≥ UNIT……………………msec
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM66
67
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SET MENU
13 DISPLAY SET
DIMMER
You can adjust the brightness of the front panel display.
Control range: 4 to 0
Initial setting: 0
OSD SHIFT (OSD off-set position)
This setting is used to adjust the vertical position of the
OSD.
Control range: +5 (downward) to 5 (upward)
Initial setting: 0
Press + to lower the position of the OSD.
Press to raise the position of the OSD.
GRAY BACK
Selecting AUTO for the on-screen display setting displays
a gray background when theres no video signal input.
Nothing is displayed on the screen including the on-
screen display if OFF is selected.
Choices: AUTO, OFF
Initial setting: AUTO
Note
If GRAY BACK is set to OFF, no information will be
displayed on the screen when video signals are not being input.
V CONV. (Video conversion)
Use this feature to turn on/off the function to convert
composite signals to S-video signals to output through the
S-video jack when no S-video signals are input.
Choices: ON, OFF
Initial setting: OFF
OFF
Select this not to convert composite signals to S-video
signals.
ON
Select this to convert composite signals to S-video
signals.
14 MEMORY GUARD
Use this feature to prevent accidental changes to DSP
program parameter values and other settings on this unit.
Choices: ON, OFF
Initial setting: OFF
Select ON to protect the following features:
DSP program parameters
All SET MENU items
Center, rear speakers, rear center, and subwoofer levels
The on-screen display (OSD) mode
Notes
When 14 MEMORY GUARD is set to ON, you cannot use
the test tone.
When 14 MEMORY GUARD is set to ON, you cannot select
any other SET MENU items.
13 DISPLAY SET
OSD SHIFT………………0
≥ DIMMER………………………0
GRAY BACK………AUTO
V CONV.………………OFF
14 MEMORY GUARD
-/+ : Select
/ : Exit
OFF ON
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM67
68
SET MENU
15 6CH INPUT SET
Use this feature to set the direction of the signals input
into the center and subwoofer channels when the source
component is connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks.
15A CENTER to (direction of the
center channel signals)
This item sets the direction of the signals input into the
CENTER jack.
Choices: CENTER, MAIN
Initial setting: CENTER
CENTER
The input signals are output from the center speaker.
MAIN
The input signals are directed to the main L/R speakers
with same level.
15B SWFR to (direction of the
signals input into the subwoofer)
This item sets the direction of the signals input into the
SUBWOOFER jack.
Choices: SWFR, MAIN
Initial setting: SWFR
SWFR
The input signals are output from the subwoofer.
MAIN
The input signals are directed to the main L/R speakers
with same level.
CENTER MAIN
15A CENTER to
SWFR MAIN
15B SWFR to
16 ZONE2 SET
(U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only)
Use this feature to make a setting for audio output to
ZONE 2 OUT.
OUTPUT VOL (output volume)
This item changes the volume control setting for audio
output to ZONE 2 OUT.
Choices: VAR., FIX
Initial setting: VAR.
VAR.
To adjust the ZONE 2 OUT volume with VOL +/ on the
remote control.
FIX
To fix the ZONE 2 OUT volume to the volume level of
this unit.
SP OUT
Use this feature to switch assignment of the center and
rear center speakers ouput destination.
Choices: OFF, ON
Initial setting: OFF
ON
To assign the amplifier outputs for the center and rear
center channels to the ZONE 2 OUT SPEAKERS
terminals.
OFF
To assign the amplifier outputs for the center and rear
center channels to CENTER and REAR
CENTER speaker terminals as normal operation.
y
When SP OUT is set to ON, 1A CENTER SP and 1D REAR
CT SP will be automatically set to NONE. When it is switched
to OFF, 1A CENTER SP and 1D REAR CT SP will be set to
the previous setting.
Note
When SP OUT is set to ON, it is not necessary to connect
ZONE 2 OUT jacks.
16 ZONE2 SET
ZONE2 SP OUT…OFF
≥ ZONE2 OUT…………VAR
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM68
69
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
3 Press /+ to adjust the speaker output level.
The control range for the center, left and right rear
or rear center speakers is from +10 dB to 10 dB.
The control range for the subwoofer is from 0 dB
to 20 dB.
Notes
When you adjust the output level with LEVEL, the settings you
made with the test tone will be changed.
When PARAMETER/SET MENU is set to SET MENU, you
cannot adjust the output level by using LEVEL. However, each
time you press LEVEL, the current level of each speaker
appears on the front panel display and you can check the
speaker level.
When the speaker output modes for 1A CENTER SP and
1C REAR L/R SP are set to NONE, and 1E LFE/BASS
OUT to MAIN, the output level of those speakers cannot be
adjusted because there is no sound coming from these speakers.
During playback of the source input through the 6CH INPUT
jacks, the level can be adjusted independently for the center,
right and left rear, and subwoofer.
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is in the standby
mode. However if the power cord is disconnected from
the AC outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than
one week, the stored data will be lost. If so, set the
output level again.
You can adjust the output level of each effect speaker
(center, left and right rear, rear center and subwoofer)
while listening to a music source.
Adjustment should be made with the remote control.
1 Set PARAMETER/SET
MENU to PARAMETER.
2 Press LEVEL repeatedly to select the
speaker(s) you want to adjust.
Each time you press LEVEL, the selected speaker
changes and appears on the front panel display and
on the video monitor as follows: center, right rear,
rear center left rear and subwoofer.
LEVEL
PARAMETER
SET MENU
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
PARAMETER
SET MENU
EFFECT
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
TV MUTE
A/B/C/D/E
1
2
3
ADJUSTING THE LEVEL OF THE EFFECT SPEAKERS
y
Once you press LEVEL, you can also select the speaker(s) to
be adjusted by pressing n/k.
Center speaker output level
Subwoofer output level
Left rear speaker output
level
Rear center speaker output
level
Right rear speaker output
level
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM69
70
Use this feature to automatically set this unit in the
standby mode after the amount of time you have set. The
sleep timer is useful when you are going to sleep while
this unit is playing or recording a source. The sleep timer
also automatically turns off the external components
connected to AC OUTLET(S).
The sleep timer can only be set with the remote control.
y
By connecting a commercially available timer to this unit, you
can also set a wake-up timer. Refer to the operation instructions
of the timer.
Setting the Sleep Timer
1 Select a source and start playback on the
source component.
2 Press SLEEP repeatedly
to set the amount of time.
Each time you press SLEEP,
the front panel display changes
as shown below. The SLEEP
indicator flashes while
switching the amount of time
for sleep timer.
The SLEEP indicator soon lights up on the front
panel display after the sleep timer has been set.
The display then returns to the previous indication.
SLEEP TIMER
Canceling the Sleep Timer
Press SLEEP repeatedly until SLEEP OFF
appears on the front panel display.
After a few seconds, SLEEP OFF disappears, the
SLEEP indicator goes off and the display returns
to the previous indication.
y
The sleep timer setting can also be canceled by setting this unit
in the standby mode by using STANDBY on the remote control
(or STANDBY/ON on the front panel) or by disconnecting the
AC power cord from the AC outlet.
SLEEP
SLEEP
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX
DSP
1
SP
DIGITAL
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
VOLUME
SLEEP
D
A
SLEEP 120min
SLEEP 120 min. SLEEP 90 min.
SLEEP 60 min.SLEEP 30 min.SLEEP OFF
LR
VCR DVD TUNER CD
PHONO
CD RV AUX
DSP
1
SP
DIGITAL
VCR2/DVR
CBL
/
SAT
MD
/
TAPE
TV
/
LD
VOLUME
SLEEP
D
A
CONCERT HALL1
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
PARAMETER
SET MENU
EFFECT
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
++
2
0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM70
71
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
Example of a system configuration and connections
Notes
When not using the main room, turn down the volume of this unit in the main room. Adjust the Zone 2 volume with the control on
the amplifier in the second room.
DO NOT USE the Zone 2 feature for CDs encoded with DTS to avoid unexpected noise.
ZONE 2 (for U.S.A., Canada and Australia models)
You can make up a multi-room audio-video system with this unit. This feature enables you to set this unit to reproduce
separate input sources in the main room and second room (Zone 2) with the supplied remote control in the second room.
Only analog signals are sent to the second room. For any source you want to listen to in the second room, you must
connect the analog output jack from the source to the corresponding analog input jack on this unit.
Zone 2 Connections
To use the multi-room functions of this unit, you need the following additional equipment:
An infrared signal receiver in the second room
An infrared emitter in the main room
This emitter transmits the infrared signals from the remote control in the second room to the main room
(for example, to a CD player or LD player).
An amplifier and speakers for the second room
A video monitor for the second room
REMOTE CONTROL OUT
DVD INPUT
REMOTE CONTROL IN
ZONE 2 VIDEO OUT
ZONE 2 AUDIO OUT
OUT
IN
OUT
IN
REMOTE
CONTROL OUT
Main room
Infrared signal
receiver
Remote control
Second room
Amplifier
Infrared emitter
This unit
DVD player
(or other component)
This unit
y
Since there are so many ways to connect and use this unit in a
multi-room installation, we recommend that you consult with
the nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center for
the Zone 2 connections which will best meet your
requirements.
Some YAMAHA models are able to connect directly to the
REMOTE CONTROL OUT jack of this unit. If you own these
products, you may not need to use an infrared emitter. Up to 6
YAMAHA components can be connected as shown.
Video
monitor
0110V2300_71-72_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM71
72
ZONE 2
Special considerations when
using DTS software
The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Therefore, if you
attempt to send the DTS signal to the second room, you
will only be able to hear the digital noise sound that could
damage your speakers.
Due to this characteristic of DTS encoded discs, the
following considerations and adjustments need to be
made.
For LDs or DVDs encoded with DTS
Only 2-channel analog audio signals may be sent to the
second room, as follows:
LDs
Set your LD players left and right outputs to the
analog soundtrack.
DVDs
Use the disc menu to set the DVD players mixed 2-
channel left and right audio outputs to the PCM or
Dolby Digital soundtrack.
For CDs encoded with DTS
DO NOT USE the Zone 2 feature for CDs encoded with
DTS to avoid unexpected noise.
Remote Control in Zone 2
In the second room (Zone 2), the supplied remote control
can be used for the Zone 2 remote control. You can select
the input source and control the component which is
located in the main room directly from the second room
regardless of the listening condition in the main room.
Before starting the following procedure, set REC OUT/
ZONE 2 on the front panel to SOURCE/REMOTE.
1 Repeat steps 1 and 2 of the procedure in
Setting the Manufacturer Code on page 44.
2 Press l / h to select L:AMP.
3 Press k / n to select Zone2.
4 Press LEARN to complete the Zone 2 setup.
5 Press SOURCE SELECT k to display
Zone2 in the display window.
6 Press an input selector button to select the
input source you want to listen to in the
second room.
The display window shows 2: name of selected
input if the remote control is in the Zone 2 mode.
7 You can control the component by using the
component control area buttons.
Note
Adjust the Zone 2 volume with the control on the amplifier in
the second room.
8 Press SOURCE SELECT k / n to exit from
the Zone 2 mode.
ENTER
ENTER
LEARN
SELECT
SOURCE
SELECT
SOURCE
6CH INPUT
SOUND
TITLE
MENU
CHAPTER
PAUSESTOPPOWER
REC
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
EFFECT
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
SELECT
DISPLAY
SEARCH
SOURCE
PLAY
+
ENTER
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
PHONO
CD
DVD
VCR2/DVR
VCR 1
D-TV/LD
CBL/SAT
CD-R
MD/TAPE
TUNER
V-A UX
0110V2300_71-72_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM72
73
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM PARAMETER EDITING
What Is a Sound Field?
What really creates the rich, full tones of a live instrument
are the multiple reflections from the walls of the room. In
addition to making the sound live, these reflections
enable us to tell where the player is situated, and the size
and shape of the room in which we are sitting.
Elements of a sound field
In any environment, in addition to the direct sound
coming straight to our ears from the players instrument,
there are two distinct types of sound reflections that
combine to make up the sound field:
Early reflections
Reflected sounds reach our ears extremely rapidly
(50 ms 100 ms after the direct sound), after reflecting
from one surface only for example, from the ceiling or
a wall. Early reflections actually add clarity to the direct
sound.
Reverberations
These are caused by reflections from more than one
surface walls, ceiling, the back of the room so
numerous that they merge together to form a continuous
sonic afterglow. They are non-directional, and lessen
the clarity of the direct sound.
Direct sound, early reflections and subsequent
reverberation taken together help us to determine the
subjective size and shape of the room, and it is this
information that the digital sound field processor
reproduces in order to create sound fields.
If you could create the appropriate early reflections and
subsequent reverberations in your listening room, you
would be able to create your own listening environment.
The acoustics in your room could be changed to those of
a concert hall, a dance floor, or virtually any size room at
all. This ability to create sound fields at will is exactly
what YAMAHA has done with the digital sound field
processor.
Sound Field Program Parameters
DSP programs consist of some parameters to determine
the apparent room size, reverberation time, distance from
you to the performer, etc. In each program, these
parameters are set with values precisely calculated by
YAMAHA to create a sound field unique to the program.
It is recommended to use DSP programs without
changing the values of parameters; however, this unit also
allows you to create your own sound fields. Starting with
one of the built-in programs, you can adjust those
parameters.
Each DSP program has a set of parameters that allow you
to change the characteristics of the acoustic environment
to precisely create the effect you want. These parameters
correspond to the many natural acoustic factors that create
the sound field you experience in an actual concert hall or
other listening environment. The size of the room, for
example, affects the length of time between the early
reflections. The ROOM SIZE parameter provided in
many of the DSP programs alters the timing between
these reflections, thus changing the shape of the room
you are listening. In addition to room size, the shape of
the room and the characteristics of its surfaces have a
significant effect on the final sound. Surfaces that absorb
sound, for example, cause the reflections and
reverberations to die out more quickly, while highly
reflective surfaces allow the reflections to carry on for a
longer period of time. The digital sound field parameters
allow you to control these and many other factors that
contribute to your personal sound field, allowing you to
essentially redesign the concert halls, theaters, etc.
provided to create custom-tailored listening environments
that ideally match your mood and music.
See DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER
DESCRIPTIONS on pages 75 to 78.
0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM73
74
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM PARAMETER EDITING
4 Press k / n to select the
parameter.
5 Press /+ to change the
parameter value.
When you set the parameter to
a value other than the factory-
set value, an asterisk mark (*)
appears by the parameter name
on the video monitor.
6 Repeat steps 3 to 5 above as necessary to
change other program parameters.
Notes
The available parameters may be displayed on more than one
OSD page for some of the programs. To scroll through pages,
press k / n.
You cannot change parameter values when 14 MEMORY
GUARD on the SET MENU is set to ON. If you want to
change the parameter values, set 14 MEMORY GUARD to
OFF (see page 67).
Memory back-up
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data
from being lost even if this unit is set in the standby
mode, the power cord is disconnected from the AC
outlet, or the power supply is temporarily cut due to
power failure. However, if the power is cut for more
than one week, the parameter value you edited will
return to the factory setting. If so, edit the parameter
value again.
Resetting a Parameter to the
Factory-set Value
To reset some of the parameters
to the factory-set values
Select the parameter you want to reset. Then press and
hold /+ until the value temporarily stops at the factory-
set value. The asterisk mark (*) by the parameter name
disappears on the video monitor.
To reset all of the parameters to
the factory-set values
Use 9 PARAM. INI on the SET MENU to reset all of
the parameter values of all DSP programs within the
selected group to the factory-set values (see page 65).
This operation resets all of the parameter values of all
DSP programs within that group to the factory-set values.
Changing Parameter Settings
You can enjoy good quality sound with the factory-set
parameters. Although you do not have to change the
initial settings, you can change some of the parameters to
better suit the input source or your listening room.
1 Set PARAMETER/SET
MENU to PARAMETER.
2 Turn on the video monitor
and press ON SCREEN
repeatedly to select the
full display mode.
3 Select a DSP program you want to adjust.
PARAMETER
SET MENU
P05 ROCK CONCERT
ROOM SIZE…………1.0
LIVENESS…………………5
REV.TIME…………1.6s
REV.DELAY……120ms
DSP LEVEL…………0dB
≥ INIT.DLY…………15ms
HALL 1
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
+
+
ON SCREEN
Program No.
Example of the parameter setting display
Parameters
Cursor
Program name
HALL 1
EX/ES
DSP
10KEY
ROCK
CONCERT
MOVIE
THEATER 1
MOVIE
THEATER 2
MUTE
VOLUME
STEREO
TV INPUT
TV VOL
CH
PRESET
DISC
PARAMETER
SET MENU
EFFECT
LEVEL
ON SCREEN
TESTSLEEP
TV MUTE
MUSIC
VIDEO
TV
THEATER
ENTER-
TAINMENT
HALL 2
CHURCH
JAZZ CLUB
SELECT
/DTS
SUR.
CHP/INDEX
A/B/C/D/E
1
5
9
6
10
0
10
100
11 12
78
234
++
1
3
4
2
5
Parameter valves
0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM74
75
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
Large value = 2.0Small value = 0.1
Sound Source
TimeTimeTime
Early
Reflections
Source Sound
Level
Level
Level
ROOM SIZE
[P. ROOM SIZE for the presence sound field] Control Range 0.1 2.0
Function: This parameter adjusts the apparent size of the surround sound field. The larger the value, the larger the
surround sound field becomes.
Description: As the sound is repeatedly reflected around a room, the larger the hall is, the longer the time between
the original reflected sound and the subsequent reflections. By controlling the time between the
reflected sounds, you can change the apparent size of the virtual venue. Changing this parameter from
one to two, doubles the apparent length of the room.
Large value = 99 msSmall value = 1 ms
Reflection Face
Sound Source
TimeTime Time
INIT.DLYINIT.DLYINIT.DLY
Early
Reflections
Source Sound
Level
Level
Level
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
You can adjust the values of certain digital sound field parameters so the sound fields are recreated accurately in your
listening room. Not all of the following parameters are found in every program.
DSP LEVEL Control Range 6 dB +3 dB
Function: This parameter adjusts the level of all the DSP effect sounds within a narrow range.
Description: Depending on the acoustics of you listening room, you may want to increase or decrease the DSP effect
level relative to the direct sound.
INIT. DLY (Initial Delay)
[P. INT. DLY for the presence sound field] Control Range 1 99 msec
Function: This parameter changes the apparent distance from the source sound by adjusting the delay between the
direct sound and the first reflection heard by the listener.
Description: The smaller the value, the closer the sound source seems to the listener. The larger the value, the farther
the apparent distance seems. For a small room, this parameter would be set to a small value, and for a
large room, it would be set to a large value.
0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM75
76
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
S. DELAY (Surround Delay) Control Range 0 49 msec (The range
depends on the signal format.)
Function: This parameter adjusts the delay for surround signals and surround sound field.
S. INIT. DLY (Surround Initial Delay) Control Range 1 49 msec
Function: This parameter adjusts the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection on the surround side
of the sound field. You can only adjust this parameter when at least two front channels and two rear
channels are used.
S. ROOM SIZE (Surround Room Size) Control Range 0.1 2.0
Function: This parameter adjusts the apparent size of the surround sound field.
S. LIVENESS (Surround Liveness) Control Range 0 10
Function: This parameter adjusts the apparent reflectivity of the virtual walls in the surround sound field.
RC INIT. DLY (Rear Center Initial Delay) Control Range 1 49 msec
Function: This parameter adjusts the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection in the rear center
sound field.
RC ROOM SIZE (Rear Center Room Size) Control Range 0.1 2.0
Function: This parameter adjusts the apparent size of the rear center sound field.
RC LIVENESS (Rear Center Liveness) Control Range 0 10
Function: This parameter adjusts the apparent reflectivity of the virtual wall in the rear center sound field.
Large value = 10Small value = 0
Large
Reflected Sound
Small Reflected
Sound
Sound Source
Live
TimeTimeTime
Dead
Source Sound
Level
Level
Level
LIVENESS Control Range 0 10
Function: This parameter adjusts the reflectivity of the virtual walls in the hall by changing the rate at which the
early reflections decay.
Description: The early reflections of a sound source decay much faster in a room with acoustically absorbent wall
surfaces than in one which has highly reflective surfaces. A room with acoustically absorbent surfaces
is referred to as dead, while a room with highly reflective surfaces is referred to as live. The
LIVENESS parameter lets you adjust the early reflection decay rate, and thus the liveness of the
room.
0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM76
77
English
INTRODUCTION
PREPARATION
BASIC OPERA-
TION
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM PARAMETER EDITINGDIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
60 dB 60 dB 60 dB
(dB)
60 dB
Level
Time
REV. LEVEL
Source Sound
REV. LEVEL (Reverberation Level) Control Range 0 100 %
Function: This parameter adjusts the volume of the reverberation sound.
Description: The larger the value, the stronger the reverberation becomes.
Time
REV. TIMEREV.
DELAY
Reverberation
Source Sound
Level
REV. DELAY (Reverberation Delay) Control Range 0 250 msec
Function: This parameter adjusts the time difference between the beginning of the direct sound and the beginning
of the reverberation sound.
Description: The larger the value, the later the reverberation sound begins. A later reverberation sound makes you
feel like you are in a larger acoustic environment.
Large value = 5.0 sSmall value = 1.0 s
Long
Reverberation
Short
Reverberation
Sound Source
REV. TIMEREV. TIMEREV. TIME
Early Reflections
ReverberationSource SoundReverberation
REV. TIME (Reverberation Time) Control Range 1.0 5.0 sec
Function: This parameter adjusts the amount of time it takes for the dense, subsequent reverberation sound to
decay by 60 dB (at 1 kHz). This changes the apparent size of the acoustic environment over an
extremely wide range.
Description: Set a longer reverberation time for dead sources and listening room environments, and a shorter time
for live sources and listening room environments.
0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM77
78
DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS
For 6ch Stereo
CT LEVEL (Center Level) Control Range 0 100 %
Function: These parameters adjust the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode.
RL LEVEL (Rear Left Level) Control Range 0 100 %
Function: These parameters adjust the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode.
RR LEVEL (Rear Right Level) Control Range 0 100 %
Function: These parameters adjust the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode.
RC LEVEL (Rear Center Level) Control Range 0 100 %
Function: These parameters adjust the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode.
For PRO LOGIC Music
PANORAMA Control Range OFF/ON
Function: Extends the front stereo image to include the surround speakers for wraparound effect.
DIMENSION Control Range 3 STD +3
Function: Gradually adjusts the soundfield either towards the front or towards the rear.
CT WIDTH (Center Width) Control Range 0 7
Function: Adjusts the center image from all three front speakers to varying degrees.
For DTS Neo: 6 Music
C. IMAGE (Center Image) Control Range 0 0.5
Function: This parameter adjusts the center image from all three front speakers to varying degrees.
0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:38 AM78
79
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
TROUBLESHOOTING
Refer to the chart below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed
below or if the instruction below does not help, set this unit in the standby mode, disconnect the power cord, and contact
the nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center.
General
Problem
This unit fails to turn
on when STANDBY/
ON (or SYSTEM
POWER) is pressed,
or enters in the
standby mode soon
after the power has
been turned on.
On-screen display
does not appear.
No sound and/or no
picture.
Cause
The power cord is not connected or the
plug is not completely inserted.
The IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch
on the rear panel is not fully set to the
left or right position.
The protection circuitry has been
activated.
This unit has been exposed to a strong
external electric shock (such as lightning
and strong static electricity).
The setting for the on-screen display is
set to DISPLAY OFF.
The GRAY BACK setting under 13
DISPLAY SET on the SET MENU is
set to OFF, and no video signal is input
to this unit.
Incorrect input or output cable
connections.
An appropriate input source has not been
selected.
The speaker connections are not secure.
The main speakers to be used have not
been selected properly.
The volume is turned down.
The sound is muted.
The signals that this unit cannot
reproduce such as a CD-ROM are being
input.
The output and input for the picture are
connected to different types of video
jacks.
Remedy
Firmly connect the power cord.
Set the switch fully to the left or right position when this unit is in
the standby mode.
Make sure all speaker wire connections on this unit and on all
speakers are secure and that the wire for each connection does not
touch anything other than its respective connection.
Set this unit in the standby mode, disconnect the power cord, plug
it back in after 30 seconds, and start operating.
Select the full display or short display mode (see page 23).
Set GRAY BACK to AUTO to always show the OSD (see page
67).
Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables
may be defective.
Select an appropriate input source with INPUT or 6CH (INPUT)
(or the input selector buttons) (see page 27).
Secure the connections (see page 11).
Select the main speakers with SPEAKERS A and/or B (see page
27).
Turn up the volume.
Press MUTE or any operation buttons of this unit to cancel a
mute and adjust the volume (see page 28).
Play a source whose signals this unit can reproduce.
Make connections using the same type of jack (between
S VIDEO, VIDEO (composite), or COMPONENT VIDEO jacks)
for both the input and output.
0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:39 AM79
80
TROUBLESHOOTING
Problem
The sound suddenly
goes off.
Only the speaker on
one side can be
heard.
No sound from the
effect speakers.
No sound from the
center speaker.
No sound from the
rear speakers.
No sound from the
rear center speaker.
No sound from the
subwoofer.
Cause
The protection circuit has been activated
because of a short circuit, etc.
The sleep timer has functioned.
The sound is muted.
Incorrect cable connections.
Incorrect setting of 3 L/R BALANCE
on the SET MENU.
The sound effect is off.
The source encoded with a Dolby Digital
or DTS signal does not have a center,
rear L/R or rear center channel signals.
A 96-kHz sampling digital signal is
being input to this unit.
The output level of the center speaker is
set to minimum.
1A CENTER SP on the SET MENU is
set to NONE.
One of the Hi-Fi DSP programs (1 to 6
except for Game and 6ch Stereo) has
been selected.
The output level of the rear speakers is
set to minimum.
1C REAR L/R SP on the SET MENU
is set to NONE.
A monaural source is being played with
the program 10.
1C REAR L/R SP on the SET MENU
is set to NONE.
1D REAR CT SP on the SET MENU
is set to NONE.
1E LFE/BASS OUT on the SET
MENU is set to MAIN when a Dolby
Digital or DTS signal is being played.
1E LFE/BASS OUT on the SET
MENU is set to SWFR or MAIN when a
2-channel source is being played.
The source does not contain low bass
signals (90 Hz and below).
Remedy
Check the IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch is set to the
appropriate position and then turn this unit back on.
Check the speaker wires are not touching each other and then turn
this unit back on.
Turn on the power, and play the source again.
Press MUTE or any operation buttons of this unit to cancel a
mute and adjust the volume (see page 28).
Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables
may be defective.
Adjust it to the appropriate position.
Press STEREO/EFFECT to turn it on (see page 32).
Raise the level of the center speaker (see pages 25, 26).
Select the appropriate mode for your center speaker (see page
58).
Select another DSP program.
Raise the output level of the rear speakers (see pages 25, 26).
Select the appropriate speaker mode for the rear L/R speakers
(see page 59).
Select another DSP program.
If the speaker mode for the rear L/R speakers is set to NONE, the
speaker mode for the rear center speaker is automatically set to
NONE. Select the appropriate speaker mode for the rear L/R
speaker mode (see page 59).
Select LRG or SML (see page 60).
Select SWFR or BOTH (see page 60).
Select BOTH (see page 60).
0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:39 AM80
81
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
TROUBLESHOOTING
Problem
Dolby Digital or DTS
sources cannot be
played. (Dolby Digital or
DTS indicator on the
front panel display
does not light up.)
Poor bass
reproduction.
A humming sound
can be heard.
The volume level is low
while playing a record.
The volume level
cannot be increased, or
the sound is distorted.
The sound effect
cannot be recorded.
A source cannot be
recorded.
The sound field
parameters and some
other settings on this
unit cannot be
changed.
This unit does not
operate properly.
CHECK SP WIRES
appears on the front
panel display.
Cause
Digital output and Dolby Digital or
DTS are not selected on the connected
components.
1E LFE/BASS OUT on the SET
MENU is set to SWFR or BOTH and
your system does not include a
subwoofer.
The output mode for each speaker (main,
center, rear, or rear center) on the SET
MENU does not match your speaker
configuration.
Incorrect cable connections.
No connection from the turntable to the
GND terminal.
The record is being played on a turntable
with an MC cartridge.
The component connected to the
OUT(REC) jacks of this unit is turned
off.
It is not possible to record the sound
effect by a recording component.
A source component is connected to the
analog input jacks of this unit for digital
recording.
Digital connections are not made between
this unit and other components for
playback or recording.
A source component is connected to the
digital input jacks of this unit for analog
recording.
Analog connections are not made
between this unit and other components
for playback or recording.
Some recording components cannot
record the Dolby Digital or DTS sources.
14 MEMORY GUARD on the SET
MENU is set to ON.
The internal microcomputer has been
frozen by an external electric shock (such
as lightning or excessive static electricity)
or by a power supply with low voltage.
Speaker cables are short circuited.
Remedy
Make an appropriate setting following the operation
instructions for your component.
Select MAIN (see page 60).
Select the appropriate output mode for each speaker based on
the size of the speakers in your configuration (see pages 58
61).
Firmly connect the audio plugs. If the problem persists, the
cables may be defective.
Connect the grounding cord of your turntable to the GND
terminal of this unit (see page 18).
The turntable should be connected to this unit through an
MC-head amplifier (see page 17).
Turn on the power to the component.
Connect the source component to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks.
Make digital connections.
Connect a source component to the analog input jacks.
Make analog connections.
Select OFF (see page 67).
Disconnect the AC power cord from the outlet and then plug
it in again after about 30 seconds.
Make sure all speaker cables are connected correctly.
0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:39 AM81
82
TROUBLESHOOTING
Tuner
Previously preset
stations can no longer
be tuned in.
FM stereo reception is
noisy.
There is distortion, and
clear reception cannot
be obtained even with a
good FM antenna.
The desired station
cannot be tuned in with
the automatic tuning
method.
The desired station
cannot be tuned in with
the automatic tuning
method.
There are continuous
crackling and hissing
noises.
There are buzzing and
whining noises
(especially in the
evening).
Problem
FM/
AM
FM
AM
Cause
This unit has been disconnected for a
long period.
The characteristics of FM stereo
broadcasts may cause this problem
when the transmitter is too far away or
the antenna input is poor.
There is multipath interference.
The station is too weak.
The signal is weak or the antenna
connections are loose.
Noises result from lightning,
fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats
and other electrical equipment.
A TV set is being used nearby.
Remedy
Re-store the stations.
Check the antenna connections.
Try using a high-quality directional FM antenna.
Use the manual tuning method.
Adjust the antenna position to eliminate multipath
interference.
Use the manual tuning method.
Use a high-quality directional FM antenna.
Tighten the AM loop antenna connections and orient it for
best reception.
Use the manual tuning method.
Use an outdoor antenna and a ground wire. This will help
somewhat, but it is difficult to eliminate all noise.
Move this unit away from the TV.
Problem
The sound is degraded
when listening with
headphones connected
to a tape deck or CD
player that is connected
to this unit.
There is noise
interference from digital
or high-frequency
equipment, or this unit.
This unit suddenly
turns into the standby
mode.
Cause
This unit is in the standby mode.
This unit is too close to the digital or high-
frequency equipment.
The internal temperature becomes too high
and the overheat protection circuitry has
been activated.
Remedy
Turn on the power of this unit.
Move this unit further away from such equipment.
Wait until this unit cools down and then turn it back on.
0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:39 AM82
83
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
TROUBLESHOOTING
Remote control
Problem
The remote control
does not work nor
function properly.
The remote control
does not learn new
functions.
Cause
Wrong distance or angle.
Direct sunlight or lighting (from an
inverter type of fluorescent lamp, etc.) is
striking the remote control sensor of this
unit.
The batteries are weak.
The manufacturer code has not been
correctly set.
Even if the maufacturer code is correctly
set, there are some models that do not
respond to the remote control.
The batteries of this remote control and/
or the other remote control are too weak.
The distance between the two remote
controls is too much or too little.
The signal coding or modulation of the
other remote control is not compatible
with this remote control.
Memory capacity is full.
Remedy
The remote control will function within a maximum range of 6
m (20 feet) and no more than 30 degrees off-axis from the
front panel (see page 7).
Reposition this unit.
Replace the batteries.
Set the manufacturer code correctly (see pages 44, 45).
Try to set the other codes of the same maufacturer (see pages
44, 45).
Program the necessary functions independently into the
programmable buttons on this units remote control using the
Learn feature.
Replace the batteries (see page 3).
Place the remote controls at the proper distance (see page 45).
Learning is not possible.
Further learning is not possible without deleting unnecessary
functions (see page 46).
0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:39 AM83
84
GLOSSARY
Dolby Surround
Dolby Surround uses a four analog channel recording
system to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects:
two left and right main channels (stereo), a center channel
for dialog (monaural), and a rear channel for special
sound effects (monaural). The rear channel reproduces
sound within a narrow frequency range.
Dolby Surround is widely used with nearly all video tapes
and laser discs, and in many TV and cable broadcasts as
well. The Dolby Pro Logic decoder built into this unit
employs a digital signal processing system that
automatically stabilizes the volume on each channel to
enhance moving sound effects and directionality.
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that
gives you completely independent multi-channel audio.
With three front channels (left, center and right), and two
rear stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides five full-
range audio channels. With an additional channel
especially for bass effects, called LFE (low frequency
effect), the system has a total of 5.1 channels (LFE is
counted as 0.1 channel).
Using two-channel stereo for the rear speakers, more
accurate moving sound effects and surround sound
environment are possible than with Dolby Surround. The
wide dynamic range (from maximum to minimum
volume) reproduced by the five full-range channels and
the precise sound orientation generated using digital
sound processing provide listeners with previously
unheard of excitement and realism.
With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up
to a 5.1-channel configuration can be freely selected for
your enjoyment.
Dolby Digital Surround EX
This unit is equipped with the Dolby Digital decoder that
can reproduce 5.1-channel sources adding a rear center
channel. (The sound to be output from a rear center
speaker is created by mixing the content of rear L/R
channels.) This decoder is the most suitable to reproduce
the soundtrack for the movies recorded by Dolby Digital
Surround EX. You can enjoy dynamic and realistic sounds
by adding another channel.
Dolby Pro Logic
Dolby Pro Logic is the improved technique to decode
vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround programs. This
new technology enables a discrete 5-channel playback
with two left and right main channels, a center channel,
and two left and right rear channels compared with one
limited rear channel for the conventional Pro Logic
technology. Also the music mode is available for 2-
channel sources in addition to the movie mode.
DTS (Digital Theater Systems)
Digital Surround
DTS digital surround was developed to replace the analog
soundtracks of movies with a six-channel digital sound
track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie
theaters around the world. Digital Theater Systems Inc.
has developed a home theater system so that you can
enjoy the depth of sound and natural spatial
representation of DTS digital surround in your home.
This system is practically distortion-free, clear 6-channel
sound (technically, a left, right and center channels, two
rear channels, plus an LFE 0.1 channel as a subwoofer,
for a total of 5.1 channels).
Neo: 6
Neo: 6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6
channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables
playback with the full-range channels with higher
separation just like digital discrete signal playback. Two
modes are available; Music mode for playing music
sources and Cinema mode for movies.
LFE 0.1 channel
This channel is for the reproduction of low bass signals.
The frequency range for this channel is 20 Hz to 120 Hz.
This channel is counted as 0.1 because it only enforces a
low frequency range compared to the full-range
reproduced by the other 5 channels in a Dolby Digital or
DTS 5.1 channel systems.
CINEMA DSP
DIGITAL
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were
originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect
is best felt in a theater having many speakers and
designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions,
such as room size, wall material, number of speakers, and
so on, can differ so widely, its inevitable that there are
differences in the sound heard as well. Based on a wealth
of actually measured data, YAMAHA CINEMA DSP uses
YAMAHA original sound field technology to combine
Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital and DTS systems to
provide the visual and audio experience of movie theater
in the listening room of your own home.
SILENT CINEMA
YAMAHA has developed a natural, realistic sound effect
DSP algorithm for headphones.
Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound
field so that accurate representations of all the sound field
programs can be enjoyed on headphones.
0113V2300_84-86_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:39 AM84
85
English
INTRODUCTION PREPARATION
BASIC
OPERAIONT
ADVANCED
OPERATION
ADDITIONAL
INFORMATION
APPENDIX
GLOSSARY
Virtual CINEMA DSP
YAMAHA has developed a virtual CINEMA DSP
algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP sound field
surround effects even without any rear speakers by using
virtual rear speakers.
It is even possible to enjoy virtual CINEMA DSP in a
minimum two-speaker system that does not include a
center speaker.
S VIDEO signal
With S VIDEO signal system, the video signal normally
transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted
as the Y signal for the luminance and the C signal for the
chrominance through the S VIDEO cable. Using the S
VIDEO jack eliminates video signal transmission loss and
allows recording and playback of even more beautiful
images.
Component video signal
With the component video signal system, the video signal
is separated into the Y signal for the luminance and the
P
B
/C
B
and P
R
/C
R
signals for the chrominance. Color can
be reproduced more faithfully with this system because
each of these signals is independent. The component
signal is also called the color difference signal because
the luminance signal is subtracted from the color signal.
A monitor with component input jacks is required in
order to use the component signal for output.
PCM (Linear PCM)
Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog
audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without
using any compression. This is used as a method of
recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a
technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per
very small unit of time. Standing for pulse code
modulation, the analog signal is encoded as pulses and
then modulated for recording.
Sampling frequency and number
of quantized bits
When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of
times the signal is sampled per second is called the
sampling frequency, while the degree of fineness when
converting the sound level into a numeric value is called
the number of quantized bits.
The range of rates that can be played back is determined
based on the sampling rate, while the dynamic range
representing the sound level difference is determined by
the number of quantized bits. In principle, the higher the
sampling frequency, the wider the range of frequencies
that can be played back, and the higher the number of
quantized bits, the more finely the sound level can be
reproduced.
I/O assignment (SET MENU)
Although component is normally connected according to
jack names shown on the rear panel, this unit includes a
function that assigns jacks according to the component
being connected. If the component being used differs
from the component name shown for this units
component video input jacks or digital input/output jacks,
it is possible to assign jacks according to the component
being connected. This makes it possible to change the
jack assignment and effectively connect more component.
0113V2300_84-86_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:39 AM85
86
SPECIFICATIONS
AUDIO SECTION
Minimum RMS Output Power for Main, Center, Rear, R. Center
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.04% THD, 8 Ω ..................................... 110 W
Maximum Power (EIAJ) [China and General models]
1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 ......................................................... 165 W
Dynamic Power (IHF)
8/6/4/2 ........................................................ 155/195/240/275 W
Damping Factor (IHF)
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 ................................................... 80 or more
Frequency Response
CD to Main L/R ...................................... 10 Hz to 100 kHz, 3 dB
Total Harmonic Distortion
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 55 W, 8 , Main L/R ................................ 0.04%
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)
Phono MM (5 mV) to Main L/R .......................................... 86 dB
CD (250 mV, shorted) to Main L/R, Effect Off .................. 100 dB
Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)
Main L/R ................................................................ 150 µV or less
Channel Separation (1kHz/10 kHz)
CD (5.1 k terminated) to Main L/R ........................ 60 dB/45 dB
Tone Control (Main L/R)
BASS Boost/Cut ...................................................... ±10 dB/50 Hz
TREBLE Boost/Cut ............................................... ±10 dB/20 kHz
BASS EXTENSION .................................................. +6 dB/60 Hz
Phones Output ........................................................... 150 mV/100
Input Sensitivity
PHONO ................................................................... 2.5 mV/47 k
CD, etc .................................................................... 150 mV/47 k
6CH INPUT ............................................................ 150 mV/47 k
Output Level
REC OUT .............................................................. 150 mV/1.2 k
PRE OUT .................................................................. 1.0 V/1.2 k
SUBWOOFER .......................................................... 4.0 V/1.2 k
ΖΟΝΕ 2 [U.S.A., Canada and Australia models] .. 150 mV/1.5 k
VIDEO SECTION
Video Signal Type .......................................................... NTSC/PAL
Signal to Noise Ratio ............................................................... 50 dB
Frequency Response (MONITOR OUT)
Composite, S-Video ................................. 5 Hz to 10 MHz, 3 dB
Component ................................................. DC to 60 MHz, 3 dB
FM SECTION
Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................ 87.5 to 107.9 MHz
[Other models] .............................................. 87.50 to 108.00 MHz
Usable Sensitivity (IHF) ....................................... 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf)
Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)
Mono/Stereo .............................................................. 76 dB/70 dB
Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz)
Mono/Stereo ................................................................. 0.2%/0.3%
Stereo Separation (1 kHz) ....................................................... 45 dB
Frequency Response ........................... 20 Hz to 15 kHz +0.5, 2 dB
AM SECTION
Tuning Range
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................... 530 to 1710 kHz
[Australia model] ................................................. 531 to 1611 kHz
[Other models] ..................................... 530/531 to 1710/1611 kHz
Usable Sensitivity ............................................................. 300 µV/m
GENERAL
Power Supply
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................... AC 120 V/60 Hz
[Australia model] ................................................. AC 240 V/50 Hz
[China model] ...................................................... AC 220 V/50 Hz
[General model] ........................ AC 110/120/220/240 V, 50/60 Hz
Power Consumption
[U.S.A. and Canada models] .................................. 440 W/550 VA
[Other models] ..................................................................... 450 W
Standby mode ............................................................ 1.2 W or less
AC Outlets
[U.S.A. and Canada models] ...... 2 (Total 80 W /0.8 A maximum)
[Australia model] ................................. 1 (Total 100 W maximum)
[China and General models] .................. 2 (Total 50 W maximum)
Dimension (W x H x D) ................................... 435 x 171 x 434 mm
(17-1/8" x 6-3/4" x 17-1/16")
Weight ......................................................................... 15 kg (33 lbs)
0113V2300_84-86_EN(U) 02.8.9, 10:39 AM86
OWNER’S MANUAL
RX-V2300
U
AV Receiver
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, USA 6660 ORANGETHORPE AVE., BUENA PARK, CALIF. 90620, U.S.A.
YAMAHA CANADA MUSIC LTD. 135 MILNER AVE., SCARBOROUGH, ONTARIO M1S 3R1, CANADA
YAMAHA ELECTRONIK EUROPA G.m.b.H. SIEMENSSTR. 22-34, 25462 RELLINGEN BEI HAMBURG, F.R. OF GERMANY
YAMAHA ELECTRONIQUE FRANCE S.A. RUE AMBROISE CROIZAT BP70 CROISSY-BEAUBOURG 77312 MARNE-LA-VALLEE CEDEX02, FRANCE
YAMAHA ELECTRONICS (UK) LTD. YAMAHA HOUSE, 200 RICKMANSWORTH ROAD WATFORD, HERTS WD1 7JS, ENGLAND
YAMAHA SCANDINAVIA A.B. J A WETTERGRENS GATA 1, BOX 30053, 400 43 VÄSTRA FRÖLUNDA, SWEDEN
YAMAHA MUSIC AUSTRALIA PTY, LTD. 17-33 MARKET ST., SOUTH MELBOURNE, 3205 VIC., AUSTRALIA
Printed in Malaysia
V958390-2
0100V2300(U)-cv1/4 2002.10.17, 12:001

Documenttranscriptie

U RX-V2300 AV Receiver YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, USA 6660 ORANGETHORPE AVE., BUENA PARK, CALIF. 90620, U.S.A. CANADA MUSIC LTD. 135 MILNER AVE., SCARBOROUGH, ONTARIO M1S 3R1, CANADA ELECTRONIK EUROPA G.m.b.H. SIEMENSSTR. 22-34, 25462 RELLINGEN BEI HAMBURG, F.R. OF GERMANY ELECTRONIQUE FRANCE S.A. RUE AMBROISE CROIZAT BP70 CROISSY-BEAUBOURG 77312 MARNE-LA-VALLEE CEDEX02, FRANCE ELECTRONICS (UK) LTD. YAMAHA HOUSE, 200 RICKMANSWORTH ROAD WATFORD, HERTS WD1 7JS, ENGLAND SCANDINAVIA A.B. J A WETTERGRENS GATA 1, BOX 30053, 400 43 VÄSTRA FRÖLUNDA, SWEDEN Printed MUSIC AUSTRALIA PTY, LTD. 17-33 MARKET ST., SOUTH MELBOURNE, 3205 VIC., AUSTRALIA 0100V2300(U)-cv1/4 1 OWNER’S MANUAL in Malaysia V958390-1 02.8.9, 4:45 PM IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS 10 CAUTION RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. • Explanation of Graphical Symbols The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert you to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert you to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 11 Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions should be read before the product is operated. Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions should be retained for future reference. Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product and in the operating instructions should be adhered to. Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions should be followed. Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners. Use a damp cloth for cleaning. Attachments – Do not use attachments not recommended by the product manufacturer as they may cause hazards. Water and Moisture – Do not use this product near water – for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or laundry tub; in a wet basement; or near a swimming pool; and the like. Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table. The product may fall, causing serious injury to a child or adult, and serious damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold with the product. Any mounting of the product should follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should use a mounting accessory recommended by the manufacturer. A product and cart combination should be moved with care. Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven surfaces may cause the product and cart combination to overturn. 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 Ventilation – Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for ventilation and to ensure reliable operation of the product and to protect it from overheating, and these openings must not be blocked or covered. The openings should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed, sofa, rug, or other similar surface. This product should not be placed in a built-in installation such as a bookcase or rack unless proper ventilation is provided or the manufacturer’s instructions have been adhered to. Power Sources – This product should be operated only from the type of power source indicated on the marking label. If you are not sure of the type of power supply to your home, consult your product dealer or local power company. For products intended to operate from battery power, or other sources, refer to the operating instructions. Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped with a polarized alternating current line plug (a plug having one blade wider than the other). This plug will fit into the power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try reversing the plug. If the plug should still fail to fit, contact your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug. Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched by items placed upon or against them, paying particular attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they exit from the product. Lightning – For added protection for this product during a lightning storm, or when it is left unattended and unused for long periods of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will prevent damage to the product due to lightning and power-line surges. Power Lines – An outside antenna system should not be located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits, or where it can fall into such power lines or circuits. When installing an outside antenna system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching such power lines or circuits as contact with them might be fatal. Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets, extension cords, or integral convenience receptacles as this can result in a risk of fire or electric shock. Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects of any kind into this product through openings as they may touch dangerous voltage points or short-out parts that could result in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind on the product. Servicing – Do not attempt to service this product yourself as opening or removing covers may expose you to dangerous voltage or other hazards. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel under the following conditions: a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged, b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into the product, c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water, I CAUTION 0101V2300_Cau_EN(U) 2 02.8.9, 10:36 AM IMPORTANT SAFETY SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS INSTRUCTIONS d) 20 21 22 23 If the product does not operate normally by following the operating instructions. Adjust only those controls that are covered by the operating instructions as an improper adjustment of other controls may result in damage and will often require extensive work by a qualified technician to restore the product to its normal operation, e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any way, and f) When the product exhibits a distinct change in performance - this indicates a need for service. Replacement Parts – When replacement parts are required, be sure the service technician has used replacement parts specified by the manufacturer or have the same characteristics as the original part. Unauthorized substitutions may result in fire, electric shock, or other hazards. Safety Check – Upon completion of any service or repairs to this product, ask the service technician to perform safety checks to determine that the product is in proper operating condition. Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The unit should be mounted to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the manufacturer. Heat – The product should be situated away from heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other products (including amplifiers) that produce heat. 24 Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside antenna or cable system is connected to the product, be sure the antenna or cable system is grounded so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70, provides information with regard to proper grounding of the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding conductors, location of antenna discharge unit, connection to grounding electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode. EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING MAST ANTENNA LEAD IN WIRE GROUND CLAMP ANTENNA DISCHARGE UNIT (NEC SECTION 810–20) ELECTRIC SERVICE EQUIPMENT GROUNDING CONDUCTORS (NEC SECTION 810–21) GROUND CLAMPS Note to CATV system installer: This reminder is provided to call the CATV system installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC that provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of cable entry as practical. POWER SERVICE GROUNDING ELECTRODE SYSTEM (NEC ART 250. PART H) NEC – NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE FCC INFORMATION (for US customers) 1. 2. 3. IMPORTANT NOTICE : DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT! This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product. IMPORTANT : When connecting this product to accessories and/or another product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to use this product in the USA. NOTE : This product has been tested and found to comply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential environment will not result in harmful interference with other electronic devices. This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used according to the instructions found in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the operation of other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference will not occur in all installations. If this product is found to be the source of interference, which can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the following measures: Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the interference. Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s. In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead, change the lead-in to coaxial type cable. If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results, please contact the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Electronics Corp., U.S.A. 6660 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA 90620. The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its subsidiaries. CAUTION II 0101V2300_Cau_EN(U) 3 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 To assure the finest performance, please read this manual carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference. Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean place — away from direct sunlight, heat sources, vibration, dust, moisture, and/or cold. Allow ventilation space of at least 30 cm on the top, 20 cm on the left and right, and 20 cm on the back of this unit. Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances, motors, or transformers to avoid humming sounds. Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in a environment with high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent condensation inside this unit, which may cause an electrical shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. Avoid installing this unit where foreign object may fall onto this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to liquid dripping or splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place: – Other components, as they may cause damage and/or discoloration on the surface of this unit. – Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. – Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and liquid may cause electrical shock to the user and/or damage to this unit. Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain, etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If the temperature inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections are complete. Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat, possibly causing damage. Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords. When disconnecting the power cord from the wall outlet, grasp the plug; do not pull the cord. Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth. Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this unit with a higher voltage than specified is dangerous and may cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury. YAMAHA will not be held responsible for any damage resulting from use of this unit with a voltage other than specified. To prevent damage by lightning, disconnect the power cord from the wall outlet during an electrical storm. Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified YAMAHA service personnel when any service is needed. The cabinet should never be opened for any reasons. When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time (i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power plug from the wall outlet. 16 Be sure to read the “TROUBLESHOOTING” section on common operating errors before concluding that this unit is faulty. 17 Before moving this unit, press STANDBY/ON to set this unit in the standby mode, and disconnect the AC power plug from the wall outlet. 18 VOLTAGE SELECTOR (For China and General models only) The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE plugging into the AC main supply. Voltages are 110/120/220/240 V AC, 50/60 Hz. WARNING TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE. This unit is not disconnected from the AC power source as long as it is connected to the wall outlet, even if this unit itself is turned off. This state is called the standby mode. In this state, this unit is designed to consume a very small quantity of power. FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS To prevent electric shock, match wide blade of plug to wide slot and fully insert. This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003. IMPORTANT Please record the serial number of this unit in the space below. MODEL: Serial No.: The serial number is located on the rear of the unit. Retain this Owner’s Manual in a safe place for future reference. We Want You Listening For A Lifetime YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer Electronics Group want you to get the most out of your equipment by playing it at a safe level. One that lets the sound come through loud and clear without annoying blaring or distortion – and, most importantly, without affecting your sensitive hearing. Since hearing damage from loud sounds is often undetectable until it is too late, YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer Electronics Group recommend you to avoid prolonged exposure from excessive volume levels. III CAUTION 0101V2300_Cau_EN(U) 4 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONTENTS INTRODUCTION CONTENTS ............................................................ 1 FEATURES ............................................................. 2 GETTING STARTED ............................................ 3 Checking the Package Contents ................................ 3 Installing Batteries in the Remote Control ................ 3 CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS ......................... 4 REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ................... 43 Control Area ............................................................ 43 Setting the Manufacturer Code ............................... 44 Learn Feature .......................................................... 45 Changing the Source Name in the Display Window ............................................................... 46 Using the Macro Feature ......................................... 47 Clearing Learned Functions, Macros, Renamed Source Names, and Setup Manufacturer Codes .. 49 Clearing a Learned Function ................................... 50 Each Component Control Area ............................... 52 PREPARATION Front Panel ................................................................ 4 Remote Control ......................................................... 6 Using the Remote Control ......................................... 7 Front Panel Display ................................................... 8 Rear Panel ................................................................. 9 INTRODUCTION ADVANCED OPERATION SET MENU ........................................................... 57 PREPARATION SPEAKER SETUP ............................................... 10 CONNECTIONS .................................................. 14 Before Connecting Components ............................. 14 Connecting Video Components ............................... 14 Connecting Audio Components .............................. 17 Connecting the Antennas ......................................... 19 Connecting to an External Amplifier ...................... 20 Connecting to the 6CH INPUT Jacks ..................... 20 Connecting the Power Supply Cords ...................... 21 Turning on the Power .............................................. 22 OSD Modes ............................................................. 23 Selecting the OSD Mode ......................................... 23 SPEAKER MODE SETTINGS .......................... 24 Summary of SPEAKER SET Items 1A through 1G ........................................................................ 24 ADJUSTING THE SPEAKER OUTPUT LEVELS ............................................................ 25 ADJUSTING THE LEVEL OF THE EFFECT SPEAKERS ....................................................... 69 SLEEP TIMER ..................................................... 70 Setting the Sleep Timer ........................................... 70 Canceling the Sleep Timer ...................................... 70 ZONE 2 (FOR U.S.A., CANADA AND AUSTRALIA MODELS) ................................ 71 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Before You Begin .................................................... 25 Using the Test Tone (TEST DOLBY SUR.) ........... 25 ADVANCED OPERATION ON-SCREEN DISPLAY (OSD) .......................... 23 BASIC OPERATION Speakers to Be Used ................................................ 10 Speaker Placement .................................................. 10 Connecting the Speakers ......................................... 11 Adjusting the Items on the SET MENU ................. 57 1 SPEAKER SET (speaker mode settings) ............ 58 2 LOW FRQ TEST ................................................ 61 3 L/R BALANCE (balance of the left and right main speakers) ..................................................... 62 4 HP TONE CTRL (headphone tone control) ........ 62 5 CENTER GEQ (center graphic equalizer) .......... 62 6 INPUT RENAME ............................................... 63 7 I/O ASSIGNMENT ............................................. 63 8 INPUT MODE (initial input mode) .................... 64 9 PARAM. INI (parameter initialization) .............. 65 10LFE LEVEL ........................................................ 65 11D-RANGE (dynamic range) ............................... 65 12SP DELAY .......................................................... 66 13DISPLAY SET .................................................... 67 14MEMORY GUARD ............................................ 67 156CH INPUT SET ................................................ 68 16ZONE2 SET ........................................................ 68 ZONE 2 Connections .............................................. 71 Remote Control in ZONE 2 .................................... 72 BASIC OPERATION BASIC PLAYBACK ............................................. 27 Input Modes and Indications ................................... 29 Selecting a Sound Field Program ............................ 30 Selecting PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC or Neo: 6 .................................................................. 31 DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP) ................................................................. 33 Understanding Sound Fields ................................... 33 Hi-Fi DSP Programs ............................................... 33 CINEMA-DSP ........................................................ 33 Straight Decode ....................................................... 34 Sound Field Effect ................................................... 34 Features of DSP Programs ...................................... 35 Table of Program Names for Each Input Format .... 37 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION SOUND FIELD PROGRAM PARAMETER EDITING .......................................................... 73 What Is a Sound field? ............................................ 73 Sound Field Program Parameters ............................ 73 Changing Parameter Settings .................................. 74 Resetting a Parameter to the Factory-set Value ....... 74 DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS .............................................. 75 TROUBLESHOOTING ....................................... 79 GLOSSARY .......................................................... 84 SPECIFICATIONS .............................................. 86 English TUNING ................................................................ 38 Automatic and Manual Tuning ................................ 38 Presetting Stations ................................................... 39 Tuning in to a Preset Station ................................... 41 Exchanging Preset Stations ..................................... 41 BASIC RECORDING .......................................... 42 1 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 1 02.8.9, 10:36 AM FEATURES Built-in 6-Channel Power Amplifier Other Features ◆ Minimum RMS Output Power (0.04% THD, 20 Hz – 20 kHz, 8Ω) Main: 110 W + 110 W Center: 110 W Rear: 110 W + 110 W Rear center: 110 W ◆ 192-kHz/24-bit D/A Converter ◆ “SET MENU” which Provides You with 14 Items for Optimizing This Unit for Your Audio/Video System ◆ Test Tone Generator for Easier Speaker Balance Adjustment ◆ 6-Channel External Decoder Input for Other Future Formats ◆ BASS EXTENSION Button for Reinforcing Bass Response ◆ On Screen Display Function Helpful in Controlling This Unit ◆ S Video Signal Input/Output Capability ◆ Component Video Input/Output Capability ◆ Video Signal Conversion (S Video ↔ Composite Video) Capability for Monitor Out ◆ Optical and Coaxial Digital Audio Signal Jacks ◆ Sleep Timer ◆ Remote Control with Preset Manufacturer Codes and “Learning” Macro Capability ◆ PROCESSOR DIRECT for no alteration of the original signal ◆ Custom Installation Facility (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) Multi-Mode Digital Sound Field Processing ◆ Dolby Pro Logic/Dolby Pro Logic Decoder ◆ Dolby Digital/Dolby Digital EX Decoder ◆ DTS/DTS ES Matrix 6.1, Discrete 6.1, DTS Neo: 6 Decoder ◆ CINEMA DSP: Combination of YAMAHA DSP Technology and Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital or DTS ◆ Virtual CINEMA DSP ◆ SILENT CINEMA DSP Sophisticated AM/FM Tuner ◆ 40-Station Random Access Preset Tuning ◆ Automatic Preset Tuning ◆ Preset Station Shifting Capability (Preset Editing) • y indicates a tip for your operation. • Some operations can be performed by using either the buttons on the main unit or on the remote control. In cases when the button names differ between the main unit and the remote control, the button name on the remote control is given in parentheses in this manual. • This manual is printed prior to production. Design and specifications are subject to change in part for the purpose of the improvement in operativity and others. In this case the product has priority. Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “DTS”, “DTS-ES Extended Surround” and “Neo: 6” are trademarks of Digital Theater System, Inc. “Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. 2 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 2 2002.10.16, 11:42 GETTING STARTED INTRODUCTION Checking the Package Contents Check your package to make sure it has the following items. Remote control Batteries (3) (R6) AM loop antenna MACRO TRANSMIT RE-NAME CLEAR LEARN SYSTEM MACRO OFF ON STANDBY A V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD POWER B Power Cord (U.S.A., and Canada models only) PHONO PREPARATION 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE – SEARCH POWER REC 10KEY DSP EX/ES SOUND MENU DISPLAY SELECT HALL 1 CHAPTER + STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E 8 SELECT PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL /DTS SUR. MUTE VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC Indoor FM antenna (U.S.A., Canada, China and General models only) Indoor FM antenna (Australia model only) EFFECT PARAMETER ON SCREEN LEVEL SLEEP TEST BASIC OPERAIONT SET MENU 3 After new batteries are correctly inserted, press the RESET button in the battery compartment using a ball point pen or similar object. (This does not clear the contents of the memory.) Insert three supplied batteries (R6) in the correct direction by aligning the + and – marks on the batteries with the polarity markings (+ and –) on the inside of the battery compartment. • Change all of the batteries if you notice the condition like; the operating range of the remote control decreases, the indicator does not flash or its light becomes dim. • Do not use old batteries together with new ones. • Do not use different types of batteries (such as alkaline and manganese batteries) together. Read the packaging carefully as these different types of batteries may have the same shape and color. • If the batteries have leaked, dispose of them immediately. Avoid touching the leaked material or letting it come into contact with clothing, etc. Clean the battery compartment thoroughly before installing new batteries. If the remote control is without batteries for more than 3 minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the remote control, the contents of the memory may be cleared. When the memory is cleared, insert new batteries, set up the manufacturer code and program any acquired functions that may have been cleared. English Open the battery compartment cover. ■ Notes on batteries APPENDIX 1 2 Replace the cover as pressing until it snaps into place. 3 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 3 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION RESET button 4 ADVANCED OPERATION Installing Batteries in the Remote Control 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Front Panel 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I T A L STANDBY /ON 6CH INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING TUNER VCR 1 PRESET /TUNING CD VCR2 /DVR PHONO FM/AM MEMORY PHONES STEREO TUNING MODE BASS TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL PROGRAM V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 EFFECT SILENT VIDEO AUX PRESET /TUNING EDIT 8 9 0 q w e r t yu i – FM/AM MEMORY MAN'L/AUTO FM o + – + TUNING MODE AUTO/MAN'L MONO pa s d (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models) 1 STANDBY/ON 6 Front panel display Turns on and sets this unit in the standby mode. When you turn on this unit, you will hear a click and there will be a 4 to 5-second delay before this unit can reproduce sound. Standby mode In this mode, this unit consumes a small amount of power to receive infrared-signals from the remote control. Shows information about the operational status of this unit. 2 6CH (INPUT) Selects the source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks. The source selected by pressing 6CH (INPUT) takes priority over the source selected with INPUT (or the input selector buttons on the remote control). 3 INPUT selector Selects the input source you want to listen to or watch. 4 (INPUT) MODE Sets the priority for the types of input signals (AUTO, DTS, ANALOG) to receive when one component is connected to two or more input jacks of this unit (see page 31). Priority cannot be set when 6CH INPUT is selected as the input source. 7 VOLUME Controls the output level of all audio channels. This does not affect the REC OUT level. 8 SPEAKERS A/B Turn on or off the set of main speakers connected to the A and/or B terminals on the rear panel at each time its corresponding button is pressed. 9 BASS EXTENSION Turns on or off the BASS EXTENSION function at each time the button is pressed, this feature boosts the bass frequency of the left and right main channels by +6 dB (60 Hz) while maintaining overall tonal balance. This boost is useful if you do not use a subwoofer. 0 PROCESSOR DIRECT Turns on or off the PROCESSOR DIRECT function at each time the button is pressed. When this is on, BASS, TREBLE, and BASS EXTENSION are bypassed, eliminating any alteration of the original signal. 5 Remote control sensor Receives signals from the remote control. 4 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 4 8/21/02, 12:15 PM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS q REC OUT/ZONE 2 (U.S.A., Canada and w STEREO/EFFECT Switches the normal stereo or DSP effect reproduction. When STEREO is selected, 2-channel input signals are directed to the main left and right speakers without effect sounds. All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals except for the LFE channel are mixed down to the main left and right speakers. Selects one of the 5 preset station groups (A to E). r PROGRAM l / h Selects the DSP program. t PRESET/TUNING l / h Note • If you increase or decrease the high-frequency or the lowfrequency sound to an extreme level, the tonal quality from the center and rear speakers may not match that of the left and right main speakers. ■ Opening and closing the front panel door When you want to use the controls behind the front panel door, open the door gently pressing on the lower part of the panel. When you are not using them, close the door. y PHONES jack NAT URA L SOU ND AV REC EIVE R RXV13 00 D I G I T A L ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Outputs audio signals for private listening with headphones. When you connect headphones, no signals are output to the OUTPUT jacks or to the speakers. (There is an exception depending on the “1G SP B SET” setting on the SET MENU.) u VIDEO AUX jacks Inputs audio and video signals from a portable external source such as a game console. To reproduce source signals from these jacks, select V-AUX as the input source. ADVANCED OPERATION Selects preset station number 1 to 8 when the colon (:) appears next to the band indication on the front panel display, and selects the tuning frequency when the colon (:) does not appear. d TREBLE Adjusts the high-frequency response for the left and right main channels. Turn the control to the right to increase or to the left to decrease the high-frequency response. BASIC OPERAIONT e A/B/C/D/E s BASS Adjusts the low-frequency response for the left and right main channels. Turn the control to the right to increase or to the left to decrease the low-frequency response. PREPARATION REC OUT Selects the source you want to direct to the audio/video recorder independent of the source you are listening to or watching. When set to the SOURCE/REMOTE position, the input source is directed to all outputs. a TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO) Switches the tuning mode between automatic and manual. To select the automatic tuning mode, press this button so that the “AUTO” indicator lights up on the front panel display. To select the manual tuning mode, press this button so that the “AUTO” indicator does not light up. INTRODUCTION Australia models) Selects the source you want to direct to the audio/video recorder and ZONE 2 outputs independent of the source you are listening to or watching in the main room. When set to the SOURCE/REMOTE position, the input source is directed to all outputs. To open, press gently on the lower part of the panel. i PRESET/TUNING EDIT APPENDIX Switches the function of PRESET/TUNING l / h (the colon (:) turns on or off) between selecting a preset station number and tuning. This button is also used to exchange the assignment of two preset stations with each other. o FM/AM Switches the reception band between FM and AM. English p MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM) Stores a station in the memory. Hold down this button for more than 3 seconds to start automatic preset tuning. 5 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 5 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Remote Control This section describes the controls and their functions of the remote control. See “REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES” on pages 43 to 56 for operating other components with this remote control. 1 2 3 TRANSMIT indicator Flashes while the remote control is sending signals. 4 STANDBY Sets this unit in the standby mode. 5 SYSTEM POWER 3 MACRO TRANSMIT 4 5 RE-NAME CLEAR LEARN SYSTEM MACRO OFF ON POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD t y u i o p 6CH INPUT a TITLE 6 Turns on the power of this unit. 6 Display window Shows the selected source component that you are controlling. 7 SOURCE SELECT k/n Selects the another component to control independently from the input that has been selected by pressing an input selector button. 8 10KEY/DSP Selects the numeric button (10KEY) mode or DSP mode. ENTER SOURCE 7 SELECT 8 REC 10KEY DSP HALL 1 EX/ES + STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 7 8 5 6 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E /DTS SUR. MUTE VOLUME CH TV VOL STEREO TV MUTE DISC Provides functions such as play, stop, skip, etc. for operating your other components selected by the input selector buttons. 0 EX/ES s SELECT PRESET TV INPUT q w CHAPTER ROCK CONCERT 9 0 – SEARCH POWER 9 Operation buttons SOUND MENU DISPLAY d f LEVEL SLEEP TEST h SET MENU j e q LEVEL Selects the effect speaker channel to be adjusted and sets the level. w ON SCREEN g EFFECT PARAMETER ON SCREEN Turns on or off the Dolby Digital EX or DTS ES decoder with 10 KEY/DSP set to the DSP position. Selects the on-screen display (OSD) mode for your video monitor. e SLEEP Sets the sleep timer. r TEST r Outputs the test tone to adjust the speaker levels. k t CLEAR Used for clearing functions acquired when using the learn and rename features, and set manufacturer codes (see page 49). y LEARN Used for setting up the manufacturer code or for programming the functions of other remote controls (see pages 44 – 46). 1 Infrared window Outputs infrared control signals. Aim this window at the component you want to operate. 2 RE-NAME Used for changing the input source name in the display window (see page 46). 6 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 6 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS u MACRO Used to program a series of operations for control by a single button (see page 47). Using the Remote Control Turns the macro function on and off. INTRODUCTION i MACRO ON/OFF VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I TA L STANDBY /ON o Å and ı 6CH Switch the control area for the extra components that are not connected to this unit without changing the input. p Input selector buttons Select the input source and change the control area. INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2 /DVR A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM TUNER PRESET /TUNING TUNING FM/AM MEMORY BASS MODE TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD PHONO PHONES S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 EFFECT SILENT 30° 30° VIDEO AUX – + – + Approximately 6 m (20 feet) Selects the source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks. s DSP program/Numeric buttons Select DSP programs or numbers according to the position of 10KEY/DSP. d MUTE f VOLUME +/– Increases or decreases the volume level. g STEREO/EFFECT • Do not spill water or other liquids on the remote control. • Do not drop the remote control. • Do not leave or store the remote control in the following types of conditions: – high humidity or temperature such as near a heater, stove or bath; – dusty places; or – in places subject to extremely low temperatures. h PARAMETER/SET MENU ADVANCED OPERATION Switches the normal stereo or DSP effect reproduction. When STEREO is selected, 2-channel input signals are directed to the main left and right speakers without effect sounds. All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals except for the LFE channel are also directed to the main left and right speakers. ■ Handling the remote control BASIC OPERAIONT Mutes the sound. The MUTE indicator turns on when the MUTE function is on. Press again to restore the audio output to the previous volume level. The remote control transmits a directional infrared beam. Be sure to aim the remote control directly at the remote control sensor on the main unit during operation. PREPARATION a 6CH INPUT Selects the PARAMETER mode or SET MENU mode. j Cursor buttons k/n/–/+ ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Select and adjust DSP program parameters and SET MENU items according to the position of PARAMETER/ SET MENU. k Cover Slides down to use the various setup buttons. Slides up when these buttons are not being used. APPENDIX English 7 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 7 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Front Panel Display 2 1 V AUX DSP EX 3 VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT ES DISCRETE MATRIX VIRTUAL DIGITAL 4 D TV/LD DVD 5 MD/TAPE CD R DTS Neo:6 DOLBY DIGITAL PRO LOGIC MOVIE TV THEATER 12 ENTERTAINMENT TUNER 6 78 CD PHONO STEREO AUTO TUNED MEMORY MUTE SLEEP BASS P. DIRECT 9 VOLUME LFE SILENT PRO LOGIC / PCM SP AB 0 qwe ft mS dB r 1 DSP indicator Lights up when you select a digital sound field program. 2 Decoder indicators When any of the decoders equipped on this unit functions, the indicator lights up. 3 VIRTUAL indicator Lights up when using Virtual CINEMA DSP (see page 33). 4 Input source indicator t y u i L C R RL RC RR o p a r DSP program indicators The name of the selected DSP program lights up when the ENTERTAINMENT, MOVIE THEATER 1, MOVIE THEATER 2, TV THEATER or V/DTS SURROUND DSP program is selected. t Multi-information display Shows the current DSP program name and other information when adjusting or changing settings. y STEREO indicator Shows the current input source with a cursor. Lights up when this unit is receiving a strong signal for an FM stereo broadcast while the “AUTO” indicator is lit. 5 AU TO indicator u TUNED indicator Shows that this unit is in the automatic tuning mode. 6 SLEEP indicator Lights up while the sleep timer is on. 7 MUTE indicator Lights up while the MUTE function is on. 8 BASS indicator Lights up while BASS EXTENSION is on. Lights up when this unit tunes in to a station. i MEMORY indicator Flashes to show a station can be stored. o P. DIRECT Lights up while PROCESSOR DIRECT is on. p Input channel indicator 9 VOLUME level indicator Indicates the channel components of input signals being received. Indicates the volume level. a 0 indicator Lights up when this unit is reproducing PCM (pulse code modulation) digital audio signals. PCM indicator Lights up when the input signal contains the LFE signal. LFE q SILENT indicator Lights up when headphones are connected with the sound effect (see “SILENT CINEMA DSP” on page 32). w SP A B indicator Lights up according to which set of main speakers is selected. Both indicators light up when both sets of speakers are selected. e Headphones indicator Lights up when headphones are connected. 8 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 8 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS Rear Panel 3 2 AUDIO DIGITAL OUTPUT OPTICAL AUDIO L R MD/TAPE VIDEO VIDEO L R MD/TAPE CONTROL OUT +12V RC-232C IN 15mA MAX. OUT CBL /SAT D-TV /LD R CD MONITOR OUT CBL /SAT IN (PLAY) SUB WOOFER IN A – + + – MAIN – + + – (SURROUND) – + AM ANT R B R REAR VCR 2 /DVR 75Ω UNBAL. CENTER REAR (SURROUND) L SURROUND L DIGITAL INPUT CENTER GND R SET BEFORE POWER ON – + – + MAIN A OR B: 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER CENTER REAR CENTER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER REAR REAR CENTER VIDEO CENTER SPEAKERS REAR CENTER S VIDEO 6CH INPUT 0 q w 1 DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks 2 Audio component jacks See pages 17 and 18 for connection information. See pages 14 to 16 for connection information. 4 RS-232C These are control expansion terminals for commercial use. Consult you dealer for details. 5 REMOTE IN/OUT jacks (U.S.A., Canada and 6 CONTROL OUT (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) This is a control expansion terminal for commercial use. t (U.S.A. model) w Antenna input terminals See page 19 for connection information. e OUTPUT jacks See page 20 for connection information. r Speaker terminals See pages 11 and 12 for connection information. t IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch Use this switch to match the amplifier output to your speaker impedance (see page 13). Set this unit in the standby mode before you change the setting of this switch. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Australia models only) See page 71 for details. r ADVANCED OPERATION 3 Video component jacks e < China and General models only > Use this inlet to plug in the supplied power cable (see page 21). VOLTAGE SELECTOR See page 21. APPENDIX 7 AC INLET (U.S.A. and Canada models only) FREQUENCY STEP switch See page 19. BASIC OPERAIONT 9 – R ZONE 2 OUT MONITOR OUT SUB WOOFER + SELECTEUR D'INPEDANCE D-TV /LD COAXIAL L MAIN A OR B: 4ΩMIN. /SPEAKER A+B: 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER CENTER REAR CENTER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER REAR FM ANT OUT – IMPEDANCE SELECTOR IN MAIN + AC OUTLETS L GND PHONO ZONE 2 OUT L MAIN TUNER OUT CD CBL /SAT – PREPARATION VCR 1 DVD + OUTPUT CD-R OUT (REC) CD REMOTE 8 DVD OUT (REC) CD-R 7 6 5 COMPONENT VIDEO PR/ CR PB/ CB Y S VIDEO DVD IN (PLAY) CD-R 4 INTRODUCTION 1 8 AC OUTLETS Use these outlets to supply power to your other A/V components (see page 21). 9 DIGITAL INPUT jacks 0 6CH INPUT jacks See page 20 for connection information. English q ZONE 2 OUT jacks (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) See page 71 for details. 9 0102V2300_1-9_EN(U) 9 02.8.9, 10:36 AM PREPARATION SPEAKER SETUP Speakers to Be Used This unit has been designed to provide the best soundfield quality with a 6-speaker system, using left and right main speakers, left and right rear speakers, and a center and rear center speakers. If you use different brands of speakers (with different tonal qualities) in your system, the tone of a moving human voice and other types of sound may not shift smoothly. We recommend that you use speakers from the same manufacturer or speakers with the same tonal quality. The main speakers are used for the main source sound plus the effect sounds. They will probably be the speakers from your present stereo system. The rear speakers are used for the effect and surround sounds, and the center speaker is for the center sounds (dialog, vocals, etc.). If for some reason it is not practical to use a center speaker, you can do without it. Best results, however, are obtained with the full system. The main speakers should be high-performance models and have enough power-handling capacity to accept the maximum output of your audio system. The other speakers do not have to be equal to the main speakers. For precise sound localization, however, it is ideal to use the models of equivalent performance with the main speakers. ■ Use of a subwoofer expands your sound field It is also possible to further expand your system with the addition of a subwoofer. The use of a subwoofer is effective not only for reinforcing bass frequencies from any or all channels, but also for reproducing the LFE (low-frequency effect) channel with high fidelity when the Dolby Digital signal or the DTS signal is played back. The YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System is ideal for natural and lively bass reproduction. Speaker Placement Refer to the following diagram when you place the speakers. Center speaker Main speaker (R) Rear speaker (R) Subwoofer Main speaker (L) 1.8 m (6 feet) Rear center speaker Rear speaker (L) ■ Main speakers Place the left and right main speakers an equal distance from the ideal listening position. The distance of each speaker from each side of the video monitor should be the same. ■ Center speaker Align the front face of the center speaker with the front face of your video monitor. Place the speaker as close to the monitor as possible, such as directly over or under the monitor and centrally between the main speakers. ■ Rear speakers Place these speakers behind your listening position, facing slightly inwards, nearly 1.8 m (6 feet) above the floor. ■ Rear center speaker Place the rear center speaker in the center between the left and right rear speakers at the same height from the floor as the rear speakers. ■ Subwoofer The position of the subwoofer is not so critical, because low bass sounds are not highly directional. But it is better to place the subwoofer near the main speakers. Turn it slightly toward the center of the room to reduce the wall reflections. CAUTION Use magnetically shielded speakers. If this type of speakers still creates the interference with a monitor, place the speakers away from the monitor. Note • If you do not use any effect speakers (rear, center and/or rear center), change the settings of SPEAKER SET items in the SET MENU to designate the signals to other terminals you connect speakers to. 10 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 10 02.8.9, 10:36 AM SPEAKER SETUP Connecting the Speakers CAUTION • Use speakers with the specified impedance shown on the rear panel of this unit. • Do not let the bare speaker wires touch each other and do not let them touch any metal part of this unit. This could damage this unit and/or speakers. ■ Speaker cables A speaker cord is actually a pair of insulated cables running side by side. One of the cables is colored or shaped differently, perhaps with a stripe, groove or ridge. 10 mm (3/8”) 2 Remove approximately 10 mm (3/8”) of insulation from each of the speaker cables. 2 Twist the exposed wires of the cable together to prevent short circuits. ■ Connecting to the SPEAKERS terminals 3 Red: positive (+) Black: negative (–) 1 Banana plug Unscrew the knob. 3 Tighten the knob to secure the wire. Insert one bare wire into the hole in the side of each terminal. ADVANCED OPERATION 2 1 2 BASIC OPERATION 1 1 PREPARATION If necessary, use the SET MENU to change the speaker mode settings according to the number and size of the speakers in your configuration after you finish connecting your speakers. INTRODUCTION Be sure to connect the left channel (L), right channel (R), “+” (red) and “–” (black) properly. If the connections are faulty, no sound will be heard from the speakers, and if the polarity of the speaker connections is incorrect, the sound will be unnatural and lack bass. y ADDITIONAL INFORMATION (For U.S.A., Canada, Australia, China and General models) • Banana plug connections are also possible. First, tighten the knob and then insert the banana plug connector into the end of the corresponding terminal. ■ MAIN SPEAKERS terminals ■ REAR SPEAKERS terminals A rear speaker system can be connected to these terminals. ■ CENTER SPEAKER terminals APPENDIX One or two speaker systems can be connected to these terminals. If you use only one speaker system, connect it to either of the MAIN A or B terminals. A center speaker can be connected to these terminals. English ■ REAR CENTER SPEAKER terminals A rear center speaker can be connected to these terminals. 11 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 11 02.8.9, 10:36 AM SPEAKER SETUP Main A speaker Subwoofer system Right 1 AUDIO DIGITAL OUTPUT OPTICAL R MD/TAPE AUDIO L CD-R VIDEO VIDEO L R MD/TAPE OUT (REC) D-TV /LD IN (PLAY) CBL /SAT REMOTE CONTROL OUT +12V RC-232C IN 15mA MAX. OUT CBL /SAT R MONITOR OUT SUB WOOFER IN VCR 1 DVD – A – + + – MAIN – + + – (SURROUND) – + L AM ANT R B R REAR VCR 2 /DVR CENTER 75Ω UNBAL. REAR (SURROUND) L SURROUND + – – + D-TV /LD COAXIAL DIGITAL INPUT CENTER GND + – R SET BEFORE POWER ON SELECTEUR D'INPEDANCE MAIN A OR B: 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER CENTER REAR CENTER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER REAR R ZONE 2 OUT MONITOR OUT SUB WOOFER L MAIN A OR B: 4ΩMIN. /SPEAKER A+B: 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER CENTER REAR CENTER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER REAR FM ANT OUT – IMPEDANCE SELECTOR L IN MAIN ZONE 2 OUT + AC OUTLETS TUNER GND PHONO L MAIN OUT CD CBL /SAT + OUTPUT CD-R OUT (REC) CD 3 COMPONENT VIDEO PR/ CR PB/ CB Y S VIDEO Left DVD CD CD-R Right 2 DVD IN (PLAY) Main B speaker Left REAR CENTER VIDEO CENTER SPEAKERS REAR CENTER S VIDEO 6CH INPUT (U.S.A. and Canada models) 6 7 Rear speaker 4 5 Center speaker Left Right 4 Rear Center speaker 2 1 3 6 5 7 The diagram above shows the speaker layout in the listening room. ■ SUBWOOFER jack When using a subwoofer with built-in amplifier, including the YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System, connect the input jack of the subwoofer system to this jack. Low bass signals distributed from the main, center and/or rear channels are directed to this jack if they are assigned to this jack. (The cut-off frequency of this jack is 90 Hz.) The LFE (low-frequency effect) signals generated when Dolby Digital or DTS is decoded are also directed if they are assigned to this jack. Note • Depending on the settings of “1 SPEAKER SET” and “10 LFE LEVEL” on the SET MENU, some signals may not be output from the SUBWOOFER jack. 12 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 12 02.8.9, 10:36 AM SPEAKER SETUP ■ IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch Select the left and right position according to the impedance of the speakers in your system. Be sure to move this switch only when this unit is in the standby mode. IMPEDANCE SELECTOR Switch position Speaker Impedance level SET BEFORE POWER ON SELECTEUR D'INPEDANCE MAIN A OR B: A+B: : CENTER REAR CENTER : : REAR 4ΩMIN. 8ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. MAIN A OR B: : CENTER REAR CENTER : : REAR /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER 8ΩMIN. 8ΩMIN. 8ΩMIN. 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER Main Left The impedance must be 6 Ω or higher. Rear Center The impedance must be 6 Ω or higher. ZONE 2 OUT – L + – R Main AC OUTLETS SET BEFORE POWER ON MAIN A OR B: 4ΩMIN. /SPEAKER A+B: 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER CENTER REAR CENTER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER REAR If you use one set of main speakers, the impedance of each speaker must be 8 Ω or higher. If you use two sets of main speakers, the impedance of each speaker must be 16 Ω or higher. [U.S.A. and Canada models only] The impedance of each speaker must be 8 Ω or higher. Right MAIN A OR B: 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER CENTER REAR CENTER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER REAR Center The impedance must be 8 Ω or higher. Rear Center The impedance must be 8 Ω or higher. The impedance of each speaker must be 8 Ω or higher. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Rear (U.S.A. and Canada models) ADVANCED OPERATION IMPEDANCE SELECTOR SELECTEUR D'INPEDANCE The impedance of each speaker must be 6 Ω or higher. BASIC OPERATION Center Rear + If you use one set of main speakers, the impedance of each speaker must be 4 Ω or higher. If you use two sets of main speakers, the impedance of each speaker must be 8 Ω or higher. PREPARATION IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch INTRODUCTION WARNING Do not change the IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch setting while the power of this unit is on, otherwise this unit may be damaged. If this unit fails to turn on when STANDBY/ON (or SYSTEM POWER) is pressed, the IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch may not be fully slid to either position. If so, slide the switch to either position fully when this unit is in the standby mode. APPENDIX English 13 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 13 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONNECTIONS Before Connecting Components CAUTION Never connect this unit and other components to mains power until all connections between components have been completed. • Be sure all connections are made correctly, that is to say L (left) to L, R (right) to R, “+” to “+” and “–” to “–”. Some components require different connection methods and have different jack names. Refer to the operation instructions for each component to be connected to this unit. • Use commercially available video pin cables when connecting to the S VIDEO and COMPONENT VIDEO jacks. Connecting Video Components ■ About the video jacks There are three types of video jacks. VIDEO jack VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO jacks transmit composite signals. y • The COMPONENT VIDEO jacks on this unit are independent of the S VIDEO and VIDEO jacks. • Connection depends on the availability of input jacks on your monitor. The signals input through the S VIDEO jacks can be converted to composite signals inside of this unit and output through the VIDEO jacks on this unit as well. • (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) The signals input through the VIDEO jack on this unit can be output through the S VIDEO jack by setting “V CONV.” in “13 DISPLAY SET” on the SET MENU to ON (see page 67). • When signals input through both S VIDEO and VIDEO jacks, signals input through the S VIDEO jack has priority. • You can designate the input for the COMPONENT VIDEO A and B jacks according to your component by using “7 I/O ASSIGNMENT” on the SET MENU (see pages 63 and 64 for details). Note • When you are using the COMPONENT VIDEO jacks, check the details in the owner’s manual that came with the component being connected. ■ VIDEO AUX jacks (on the front panel) These jacks are used to connect any video input source such as a game console and a camcorder to this unit. S VIDEO VIDEO S V L AUDIO R OPTICAL VIDEO AUX S VIDEO jack S VIDEO L R O OPTICAL OUT S VIDEO jacks transmit S-video signals. S-video signals are separated into luminance (Y) and color (C) video signals to achieve high-quality color reproduction. AUDIO OUT R AUDIO OUT L VIDEO OUT S VIDEO OUT COMPONENT VIDEO jacks COMPONENT VIDEO PR/ CR PB/ CB Y COMPONENT VIDEO jacks transmit component signals. Component signals are separated into luminance (Y) and color difference (PB/ CB, PR/CR) to provide the best quality in picture reproduction. Refer to the owner’s manuals for your monitor and other components being connected to reproduce these signals correctly. You can connect an S-video output and component video output of your video components to this unit. Connect an S-video output to the S VIDEO jack and component video output to the COMPONENT VIDEO jack on this unit. 14 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 14 02.8.9, 10:36 AM Game console or video camera CONNECTIONS OPTICAL OUTPUT DVD player COMPONENT OUTPUT AUDIO OUTPUT L O V R AUDIO DIGITAL OUTPUT OPTICAL AUDIO L R MD/TAPE VIDEO VIDEO L R V (U.S.A. and Canada models) COMPONENT VIDEO PR/ CR PB/ CB Y S VIDEO OUT (REC) D-TV /LD IN (PLAY) CBL /SAT CBL /SAT MONITOR OUT OUTPU SUB WOOFER CD-R TUNER IN VCR 1 DVD PREPARATION MD/TAPE OUT (REC) AM ANT OUT CD BASIC OPERATION CBL /SAT GND PHONO IN VCR 2 /DVR CD V DVD CD CD-R V S DVD IN (PLAY) CD-R S VIDEO OUTPUT INTRODUCTION VIDEO OUTPUT MAIN FM ANT OUT CENTER 75Ω UNBAL. (S SURROUND D-TV /LD COAXIAL ZONE 2 OUT MONITOR OUT CENTER GND REAR CENTER VIDEO ADVANCED OPERATION DIGITAL INPUT SUB WOOFER S VIDEO 6CH INPUT L C R S V AUDIO OUTPUT S V S VIDEO OUTPUT VIDEO INPUT COMPONENT INPUT V V R indicates right analog cables O indicates optical cables C indicates coaxial cables V indicates video cables V indicates S-video cables English S indicates component video cables APPENDIX indicates left analog cables V Video monitor COAXIAL OUTPUT L V S VIDEO INPUT TV/digital TV or LD player indicates signal direction V 15 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 15 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION VIDEO OUTPUT 8/19/02, 1:45 PM CONNECTIONS OPTICAL OUTPUT Cable TV or Satellite tuner AUDIO OUTPUT VIDEO OUTPUT L O AUDIO DIGITAL OUTPUT OPTICAL R MD/TAPE AUDIO L VIDEO VIDEO L R V DVD MD/TAPE OUT (REC) D-TV /LD IN (PLAY) CBL /SAT CBL /SAT MONITOR OUT S WO CD-R OUT (REC) TUNER IN VCR 1 DVD CD OUT PHONO IN AM ANT CBL /SAT GND VCR 2 /DVR CD V COMPONENT VIDEO PR/ CR PB/ CB Y S VIDEO CD CD-R V S DVD IN (PLAY) CD-R S VIDEO OUTPUT V R COMPONENT OUTPUT MAIN FM ANT OUT CEN 75Ω UNBAL. SURROUND D-TV /LD COAXIAL ZONE 2 OUT MONITOR OUT DIGITAL INPUT CENTER GND RE CEN SUB WOOFER VIDEO S VIDEO 6CH INPUT (U.S.A. and Canada models) L R L R V VIDEO OUTPUT AUDIO INPUT S V S V VIDEO INPUT VCR 1 or VCR 2/ DVR (digital video recorder) AUDIO OUTPUT S VIDEO OUTPUT COMPONENT INPUT V V R indicates right audio pin cables O indicates optical cables V indicates video pin cables S indicates component video cables V indicates S-video cables 16 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 16 V Video monitor S VIDEO INPUT indicates left audio pin cables V S VIDEO INPUT VIDEO INPUT indicates signal direction L S 02.8.9, 10:36 AM V CONNECTIONS Connecting Audio Components This unit has digital jacks for direct transmission of digital signals through either coaxial or fiber optic cables. You can use the digital jacks to input PCM, Dolby Digital and DTS bitstreams. When you connect components to both the COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to the input signals from the COAXIAL jack. All digital input jacks are acceptable for 96-kHz sampling digital signals. • You can designate the input for each digital jacks according to your component by using “7 I/O ASSIGNMENT” on the SET MENU (see pages 63 and 64 for details). ■ Connecting an MD recorder, tape deck or CD recorder y • DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks and analog OUT (REC) are independent. Only digital signals are output from DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks and analog signals from OUT (REC) jacks. • When you connect your recording component to both the analog and digital input and output jacks, the priority is given to the digital signal. Note • When you connect a recording component to this unit, keep its power on while using this unit. If the power is off, this unit may distort the sound from other components. BASIC OPERATION About the dust protection cap Pull out the cap from the optical jack before you connect the fiber optic cable. Do not discard the cap. When you are not using the optical jack, be sure to put the cap back in place. This cap protects the jack from dust. • The COAXIAL CD and OPTICAL CD jacks are available for a CD player which has coaxial or optical digital output jacks. • When you connect a CD player to both the COAXIAL CD and OPTICAL CD jacks, priority is given to the input signals from the COAXIAL CD jack. PREPARATION y ■ Connecting a CD player y INTRODUCTION ■ Connecting to digital jacks Notes ADVANCED OPERATION • DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks and analog OUT (REC) jacks are independent. Only digital signals are output from DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks and analog signals from OUT (REC) jacks. • The OPTICAL jacks on this unit conform to the EIA standard. If you use a fiber optic cable that does not conform to this standard, this unit may not function properly. ■ Connecting a turntable ADDITIONAL INFORMATION PHONO jacks are for connecting a turntable with an MM or high-output MC cartridge. If you have a turntable with a low-output MC cartridge, use an in-line boosting transformer or MC-head amplifier when connecting to these jacks. y • Connect your turntable to the GND terminal to reduce noise in the signal. However you may hear less noise without the connection to the GND terminal for some record players. APPENDIX English 17 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 17 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONNECTIONS INPUT OPTICAL INPUT MD recorder or tape deck OUTPUT L O R L R OPTICAL INPUT AUDIO DIGITAL OUTPUT OPTICAL R MD/TAPE L OUTPUT IN (PLAY) MD/TAPE CD-R O CD L IN (PLAY) O CD player INPUT OUT (REC) OPTICAL OUTPUT CD recorder CD-R CD-R R O L R OUT (REC) OUTPUT DVD OPTICAL OUTPUT CD L CBL /SAT R PHONO MAIN CD C COAXIAL OUTPUT SURROUND D-TV /LD COAXIAL DIGITAL INPUT CENTER GND SUB WOOFER 6CH INPUT (U.S.A. and Canada models) L R L GND R SURROUND OUTPUT OUTPUT SUBWOOFER OUTPUT External decoder See page 20 CENTER OUTPUT Turntable indicates signal direction L indicates left analog cables R indicates right analog cables O indicates optical cables C indicates coaxial cables 18 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) L 18 02.8.9, 10:36 AM R MAIN OUTPUT CONNECTIONS Connecting the Antennas Connect each antenna correctly to the designated terminals. FREQUENCY STEP switch (For China and General models) Because the interstation frequency spacing differs in different areas, set the FM AM FREQUENCY STEP switch (locating on the rear panel) according to the frequency spacing in your area. North, Central and South America: 100 kHz/10 kHz Other area: 50 kHz/9 kHz Before setting this switch, disconnect the AC power plug of this unit from the AC outlet. ■ Connecting the AM loop antenna 1 Set up the AM loop antenna, then connect it. 2 Press and hold the tab to insert the AM loop antenna lead wires into the AM ANT and GND terminals. 3 Release the tab to fix the lead wires. 100kHz/10kHz INTRODUCTION Both AM and FM indoor antennas are included with this unit. In general, these antennas should provide sufficient signal strength. 50kHz/9kHz Indoor FM antenna (included) COMPONENT VIDEO PR / C R PB / C B Y VD BASIC OPERATION AM loop antenna (included) PREPARATION FREQUENCY STEP BL AT ADVANCED OPERATION NITOR UT W TUNER AM ANT GND FM ANT 75Ω UNBAL. C y Ground (GND terminal) For maximum safety and minimum interference, connect the antenna GND terminal to a good earth ground. A good earth ground is a metal stake driven into moist earth. Connect the included indoor FM antenna to the 75Ω UNBAL. FM ANT terminal. Notes • The AM loop antenna should be placed away from this unit. • The AM loop antenna should always be connected, even if an outdoor AM antenna is connected to this unit. A properly installed outdoor antenna provides clearer reception than an indoor one. If you experience poor reception quality, an outdoor antenna may improve the quality. Consult the nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center about the outdoor antennas. APPENDIX ■ Connecting the indoor FM antenna • The AM loop antenna can be removed from the stand and attached to a wall, etc. • Orient the AM loop antenna for the best reception. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION C English 19 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 19 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONNECTIONS Connecting to an External Amplifier If you want to increase the power output to the speakers, or want to use another amplifier, connect an external amplifier to the OUTPUT jacks as follows. Notes • When RCA pin plugs are connected to the OUTPUT jacks for output to an external amplifier, it is not necessary to use the corresponding SPEAKERS terminals. Set the volume of the amplifier connected to this unit to the maximum. • No signals will be output from any other OUTPUT jacks than MAIN jacks when SPEAKER A is turned off with ZONE B selected for “1G SP B SET” on the SET MENU. OUTPUT SUB WOOFER MAIN L 3 1 R CENTER REAR (SURROUND) 4 5 L 2 R Connecting to the 6CH INPUT Jacks This unit is equipped with 6 additional input jacks (left and right MAIN, CENTER, left and right SURROUND and SUBWOOFER) for discrete multi-channel input from an external decoder, sound processor or pre-amplifier. Connect the output jacks on your external decoder to the 6CH INPUT jacks. Be sure to match the left and right outputs to the left and right input jacks for the main and surround channels. Notes • When 6CH INPUT is selected, the signals input to the 6CH INPUT jacks have priority over any other input source. • When you select 6CH INPUT as the input source, this unit automatically turns off the digital sound field processor, and you cannot listen to DSP programs. • When you select 6CH INPUT as the input source, settings of “1 SPEAKER SET (1A to 1E)” on the SET MENU do not apply. • When headphones are used, only main L/R channels are output. • Setting for “15 6CH INPUT SET” on the SET MENU will be applied when 6CH INPUT is selected. REAR CENTER 1 MAIN jacks Main channel line output jacks. Note • The signals output through these jacks are affected by the BASS, TREBLE and BASS EXTENSION settings. 2 REAR (SURROUND) jacks Rear channel line output jacks. 3 SUBWOOFER jack When using a subwoofer with built-in amplifier, including the YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System, connect the input jack of the subwoofer system to this jack. Low bass signals distributed from the main, center and/or rear channels are directed to this jack if they are assigned to this jack. (The cut-off frequency of this jack is 90 Hz.) The LFE (low-frequency effect) signals generated when Dolby Digital or DTS is decoded are also directed if they are assigned to this jack. Notes • Adjust the volume level of the subwoofer with the control on the subwoofer. It is also possible to adjust the volume level by using the remote control of this unit (see ADJUSTING THE LEVEL OF THE EFFECT SPEAKERS on page 69). • Depending on the settings of “1 SPEAKER SET” and “10 LFE LEVEL” on the SET MENU, some signals may not be output from the SUBWOOFER jack. 4 CENTER jack Center channel line output jack. 5 REAR CENTER jack Rear center channel line output jack. 20 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 20 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONNECTIONS Connecting the Power Supply Cords To AC outlet [U.S.A. and Canada models] Plug the power cord into the AC inlet when all connections are complete, and then plug in this unit to the wall outlet. AC IN AC OUTLETS Caution A OR B: A+B: : ER CENTER : : 4ΩMIN. 8ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER AIN A OR B: 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER ENTER EAR CENTER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER : 8ΩMIN. /SPEAKER EAR [Australia, China and General models] Plug this unit into the wall outlet. Plug in the other components connected to this unit to the wall outlet. PREPARATION • Do not use other AC power cords than the one provided. Otherwise it may result in causing fire or an electrical shock. EDANCE SELECTOR T BEFORE POWER ON INTRODUCTION ■ Connecting the AC power cord ■ AC OUTLET(S) (SWITCHED) AC OUTLETS ADDITIONAL INFORMATION The VOLTAGE SELECTOR on the rear panel of this unit must be set for your local main voltage BEFORE plugging into the AC main supply. Voltages are 110/120/ 220/240 V AC, 50/60 Hz. VOLTAGE SELECTOR MAINS ADVANCED OPERATION ■ VOLTAGE SELECTOR (China and General models only) VOLTAGE SELECTOR BASIC OPERATION U.S.A., Canada, China and General models ............................................ 2 OUTLETS Australia model .............................................. 1 OUTLET Use these outlets to connect the power cords from your components to this unit. The power to the AC OUTLET(S) is controlled by this unit’s STANDBY/ON (or SYSTEM POWER and STANDBY). These outlets will supply power to any connected component whenever this unit is turned on. The maximum power (total power consumption of components) that can be connected to the AC OUTLET(S) is: U.S.A. and Canada models ...................................... 80 W China and general models ........................................ 50 W Australia model ...................................................... 100 W (U.S.A. and Canada models) PEDANCE SELECTOR T BEFORE POWER ON 4ΩMIN. 8ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. 6ΩMIN. /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER MAIN A OR B: 8ΩMIN. A+B: 16ΩMIN. : 8ΩMIN. CENTER REAR CENTER : 8ΩMIN. : 8ΩMIN. REAR APPENDIX N A OR B: A+B: : TER R CENTER : : R /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER /SPEAKER English (China and General models) 21 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 21 02.8.9, 10:36 AM CONNECTIONS Turning on the Power When all connections are completed, turn on the power of this unit. 1 VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I TA L STANDBY /ON 6CH INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM PRESET /TUNING TUNER VCR 1 PHONO TUNING MODE FM/AM MEMORY BASS TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD VCR2 /DVR PHONES S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 EFFECT SILENT VIDEO AUX – + – + MACRO TRANSMIT 1 RE-NAME CLEAR LEARN SYSTEM MACRO OFF ON POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY SELECT POWER 1 REC SOUND MENU – SEARCH STOP CHAPTER PAUSE + PLAY Press STANDBY/ON (SYSTEM POWER on the remote control) to turn on the power of this unit. SYSTEM POWER or STANDBY /ON Remote control Front panel 2 Turn on the video monitor connected to this unit. 22 0103V2300_10-22_EN(U) 22 02.8.9, 10:36 AM ON-SCREEN DISPLAY (OSD) y OSD Modes 1 Turn on the video monitor connected to this unit. 2 Press ON SCREEN on the remote control repeatedly to change the display mode. The OSD mode changes in the following order: full display, short display, and display off. PARAMETER ON SCREEN LEVEL SLEEP TEST SET MENU PREPARATION • If a video source is being reproduced, the OSD is superimposed over the image. • The OSD signal is not output to the REC OUT jack, and will not be recorded with any video signal. • You can set the OSD to turn on (gray background) or off when a video source is not being reproduced (or the source component is turned off) by using “13 DISPLAY SET” on the SET MENU (see page 67). Selecting the OSD Mode INTRODUCTION You can display the operation information for this unit on a video monitor. If you display the SET MENU and DSP program parameter settings on a monitor, it is much easier to see the available options and parameters than it is by reading this information on the front panel display. Notes Full display This mode always shows the DSP program parameter settings on the video monitor. ADVANCED OPERATION Short display This mode briefly shows the same contents as the front panel display at the bottom of the screen and then disappears. • If your video monitor is connected only to the COMPONENT VIDEO jacks of this unit, the OSD is not shown. Make sure to connect your video monitor to the COMPONENT VIDEO jacks and either VIDEO or S VIDEO jacks if you want to see the OSD. • Playing back video software that has an anti-copy signal or video signals with a lot of noise may produce unstable images. Display off This mode briefly shows the “DISPLAY OFF” message at the bottom of the screen and then disappears. Afterwards, no changes to operations appear on the monitor except those of the ON SCREEN button. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION P01 CONCERT HALL 1 ≥ DSP LEVEL…………0dB INIT.DLY…………30ms ROOM SIZE…………1.O LIVENESS…………………5 P01 CONCERT HALL 1 Full display BASIC OPERAIONT You can change the amount of information the OSD shows. Short display y APPENDIX • When you choose the full display mode, INPUT, VOLUME and some other types of operation information are displayed at the bottom of the screen in the same format as that for the front panel display. • The SET MENU and test tone display appear regardless of the OSD mode. English 23 0104V2300_23-26_EN(U) 23 02.8.9, 10:36 AM SPEAKER MODE SETTINGS This unit has 7 SPEAKER SET items on the SET MENU that you must set according to the number of speakers in your configuration and their size. The following table summarizes these SPEAKER SET items, and shows the initial settings as well as other possible settings. If the initial settings shown in the following table are not appropriate for your speaker configuration, change settings following the steps described in “1 SPEAKER SET” from pages 58 to 61. Summary of SPEAKER SET Items 1A through 1G Item Description Control value (default setting indicated in bold) 1A CENTER SP Selects the output mode according to whether or not a center speaker is being used and its performance. LRG/SML/NONE 1B MAIN SP Selects the output mode according to the performance of the main speakers. LARGE/SMALL 1C REAR L/R SP Selects the output mode according to whether or not rear L/R speakers are being used and their performance. LRG/SML/NONE 1D REAR CT SP Selects the Rear Center channel output according to the size of the Rear Center speaker. LRG/SML/NONE 1E LFE/BASS OUT Selects the speaker according to use for LFE signal output and low bass signal. SWFR/MAIN/BOTH 1F MAIN LEVEL Selects the main speaker level. Normal/–10 dB 1G SP B SET Select the location of the main speakers to be connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals. MAIN / ZONE B 24 0104V2300_23-26_EN(U) 24 02.8.9, 10:36 AM ADJUSTING THE SPEAKER OUTPUT LEVELS Using the Test Tone (TEST DOLBY SUR.) Use the test tone to balance the output levels of the 6 speakers required for a surround sound system. The adjustment of each speaker output level should be made at your listening position with the remote control. A/B/C/D/E PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL MUTE VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT PARAMETER ON SCREEN LEVEL SLEEP TEST PREPARATION Note • Since this unit cannot enter the test mode while headphones are connected to this unit, be sure to unplug the headphones from the PHONES jack when using the test tone. SET MENU 2, 5 INTRODUCTION This section explains how to adjust the speaker output levels by using the test tone generator. When this adjustment is made, the output level heard at the listening position will be the same from each speaker. This is important for the best performance of the digital sound field processor, and various decoders (Dolby Digital, Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Pro Logic , DTS, DTS ES, and DTS Neo: 6). 3 1 4 Before You Begin VOLUME D I G I TA L 1 STANDBY /ON 6CH INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2 /DVR BASIC OPERAIONT NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM TUNER PRESET /TUNING FM/AM MEMORY TUNING MODE BASS TREBLE PHONES S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R SET MENU OPTICAL V–AUX EFFECT REC OUT /ZONE 2 PARAMETER MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD PHONO Set PARAMETER/SET MENU on the remote control to PARAMETER. SILENT VIDEO AUX – + 3 1 Turn on the video monitor connected to this unit. 2 Press SPEAKERS A or B to select the main speakers to be used. If you are using two sets of the main speakers, press both A and B. 3 Set the BASS and TREBLE controls on the front panel to the center position and turn off BASS EXTENSION and PROCESSOR DIRECT by pressing the buttons. “BASS EXT. OFF” and “P. DIRECT OFF” appear on the front panel display. 2 3 Press TEST to output the test tone. TEST Adjust the volume so you can hear the test tone. VOLUME ADDITIONAL INFORMATION BASS SPEAKERS A B TREBLE APPENDIX BASS PROCESSOR EXTENSION DIRECT – ADVANCED OPERATION 2 3 – + + – + Set to OFF. English 25 0104V2300_23-26_EN(U) 25 02.8.9, 10:36 AM ADJUSTING THE SPEAKER OUTPUT LEVELS LEFT Notes RIGHT CENTER SUBWOOFER LEFT SURROUND RIGHT SURROUND REAR CENTER The test tone is heard from the left main speaker, center speaker, right main speaker, right rear speaker, rear center speaker, left rear speaker and subwoofer in order. The tone is produced for 2.5 seconds each time. The state of the test tone output is also shown on the monitor by an image of the audio listening room. This is convenient for adjusting each speaker level. TEST DOLBY SUR. LEFT Front panel display also indicates from which speaker the test tone is output in the order of TEST LEFT→TEST CENTER→TEST RIGHT→ TEST R SUR.→TEST REAR CNTR→TEST L SUR. →TEST SUBWOOFER • If “1A CENTER SP” on the SET MENU is set to NONE, the center channel sound is automatically output from the left and right main speakers. • If “1C REAR L/R SP” on the SET MENU is set to NONE, the output level of the rear right, left and center speakers cannot be adjusted in step 4. The test tone will be circulated in the order of LEFT→CENTER→RIGHT→SUBWOOFER→LEFT..., skipping the rear right and left speakers and the rear center speaker. • If “1D REAR CT SP” on the SET MENU is set to NONE, the output level of the rear center speaker cannot be adjusted in step 4. The test tone will be circulated in the order of LEFT→CENTER→RIGHT→RIGHT SURROUND→LEFT SURROUND→SUBWOOFER→LEFT ..., skipping the rear center speaker. • If “1E LFE/BASS OUT” on the SET MENU is set to MAIN, the output level of the subwoofer cannot be adjusted. The test tone will be circulated in the order of LEFT→CENTER→ RIGHT→RIGHT SURROUND→REAR CENTER→LEFT SURROUND→LEFT…, skipping the subwoofer. y • It is not necessary to readjust the speaker level once it is set as long as you do not change the speakers. You can enjoy listening to or watching the input source with the desired volume by adjusting the volume key. • You can increase the output levels of the effect speakers (center, left rear and right rear and rear center) to +10 dB. If the output level of these speakers is lower than that of the main speakers even after you have increased the output level of these speakers up to +10 dB, set “1F MAIN LEVEL” on the SET MENU to –10 dB (see page 61). This setting decreases the main speaker output level to about one-third of the normal level. After you have set “1F MAIN LEVEL” on the SET MENU to –10 dB, adjust the levels for the center and rear speakers again. Note • If the test tone cannot be heard, turn down the volume, set this unit in the standby mode and check the speaker connections. 4 Press –/+ repeatedly to adjust the output level of the effect speakers so that the output level coming from each speaker is the same. While adjusting, the test tone is heard from the selected speaker. Note • Main L/R speaker level cannot be adjusted by itself. Use VOLUME to adjust the main volume. 5 When the adjustment is complete, press TEST to stop the test tone. TEST 26 0104V2300_23-26_EN(U) 26 02.8.9, 10:36 AM BASIC PLAYBACK 6 4 VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I T A L STANDBY /ON 6CH INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM TUNER VCR 1 PRESET /TUNING FM/AM MEMORY PHONES PHONO TUNING MODE BASS TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD VCR2 /DVR Rotate INPUT (or press one of the input selector buttons on the remote control) to select the input source. The current input source name and input mode appear on the front panel display and on the video monitor for a few seconds. INTRODUCTION 14 4 S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL V–AUX EFFECT REC OUT /ZONE 2 SILENT VIDEO AUX – – + + PHONO 3 6 7 MACRO TRANSMIT 1 RE-NAME CLEAR LEARN SYSTEM MACRO A STANDBY B OFF ON TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR CD DVD CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD INPUT 10KEY DSP HALL 1 HALL 2 4 JAZZ CLUB 3 4 MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 7 6 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 A/B/C/D/E /DTS SUR. Remote control SELECT PRESET TV INPUT MUTE VOLUME CH TV VOL Front panel 8 5 MOVIE THEATER 1 CHP/INDEX STEREO TV MUTE 6CH INPUT CHURCH 2 ENTERTAINMENT 1 ROCK CONCERT PHONO EX/ES V-AUX MD/TAPE 6 7 POWER TUNER PREPARATION or V-AUX TITLE DISC 6 EFFECT ENTER V AUX SOURCE DISPLAY POWER SEARCH – CHAPTER VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT REC STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 DVD MD/TAPE CD R DVD SP A 10KEY DSP D TV/LD TUNER CD PHONO VOLUME + AUTO L R Selected input source Press STANDBY/ON (SYSTEM POWER on the remote control) to turn on the power. SYSTEM STANDBY /ON POWER or Remote control Turn on the video monitor connected to this unit. 3 Press SPEAKERS A or B to select the main speakers to be used. If you are using two sets of main speakers, press both A and B. The speaker indicator(s) for the selected set(s) lights up on the front panel display. To select a source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks Press 6CH INPUT until “6CH INPUT” appears on the front panel display and on the video monitor. SPEAKERS A B 6CH INPUT 6CH or Front panel ADDITIONAL INFORMATION 2 • The input source names correspond to the jack names on the rear panel of this unit, not the names of the component connected to this unit. ADVANCED OPERATION Front panel Note BASIC OPERATION SELECT SOUND MENU Remote control Notes APPENDIX • If “6CH INPUT” is shown on the front panel display and on the video monitor, no other source can be played. To select another input source with INPUT (one of the input selector buttons), press 6CH (INPUT) to turn off “6CH INPUT” from the front panel display and the video monitor. • If you want to enjoy an audio source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks together with a video source, first select the video source and then press 6CH (INPUT). English 27 0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 27 02.8.9, 10:36 AM BASIC PLAYBACK 5 Start playback or select a broadcast station on the source component. Refer to the operation instructions for the component. Note • If you playback a video source that uses scrambled or encoded signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the picture itself may be disturbed due to those signals. 6 Adjust the volume to the desired output level. VOLUME Remote control If desired, use BASS, TREBLE and BASS EXTENSION. These controls are only effective for sound from the main speakers. BASS The BGV function allows you to combine a video image from a video source with a sound from an audio source. For example, you can enjoy listening to classical music while having beautiful scenery from the video source on the video monitor. Select a source from the video group and then select a source from the audio group with the input selector buttons on the remote control. This selection for BGV cannot be made with INPUT on the front panel. PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD VOLUME or Front panel ■ BGV (background video) function ■ To mute the sound Press MUTE on the remote control. To resume the audio output, press MUTE again. TREBLE BASS EXTENSION MUTE y – + – + Notes • If the component connected to the VCR 1 OUT, VCR 2/DVR OUT, CD-R OUT and MD/TAPE OUT jacks is turned off, the reproduced sound may be distorted or the volume may be lowered for the characteristics of AV receivers. In this case, turn on the component. • BASS EXTENSION may not be effective if “1B MAIN SP” on the SET MENU is set to SMALL and “1E LFE/BASS OUT” is set to SWFR. 7 Select a DSP program if desired. Use PROGRAM l / h (DSP program buttons on the remote control) to select a DSP program. See pages 33 to 36 for details about the DSP program. 10KEY DSP PROGRAM or EX/ES CHP/INDEX Front panel HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH ■ When you have finished using this unit Press STANDBY/ON (STANDBY on the remote control) to set this unit in the standby mode. STANDBY STANDBY /ON or JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 /DTS SUR. • You can also cancel mute to press any operation buttons such as VOLUME +/–. • During muting, the “MUTE” indicator flashes on the front panel display. • When this unit enters the standby mode, the mute function will be cancelled. Front panel 8 SELECT Remote control 28 0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 28 02.8.9, 10:36 AM Remote control BASIC PLAYBACK ■ Notes on the digital signal Input Modes and Indications When you turn on the power of this unit, the input mode is set according to “8 INPUT MODE” on the SET MENU (see page 64 for details). PHONO or MODE V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 SP A CBL/SAT Remote control D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE DVD CD R TUNER CD PHONO AUTO VOLUME L R Input mode Notes APPENDIX • If digital signals are input from both the COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, the digital signal from the COAXIAL jack has precedence over the OPTICAL jack. • In playing the disc encoded with Dolby Digital or DTS on some LD or DVD players, the sound output delays for a moment when playback resumes after a search because the digital signal is selected again. • When playing the LD source that has not been digitally recorded, the sound may not be output for some LD players. In this case, set the input mode to ANALOG. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION In this mode, the input signal is automatically selected in the following order: 1) Digital signal 2) Analog signal DTS: In this mode, only the digital input signal encoded with DTS is selected even if another signal is input at the same time. ANALOG: In this mode, only the analog input signal is selected even if a digital signal is input at the same time. • If the digital output data of the player has been processed in any way, you may not be able to perform DTS decoding even if you make a digital connection between this unit and the player. • If you play a source encoded with a DTS signal and set the input mode to ANALOG, this unit reproduces the noise of an unprocessed DTS signal. When you want to play a DTS source, be sure to connect the source to a digital input jack and set the input mode to AUTO or DTS. • If you switch the input mode to ANALOG while playing a source encoded with a DTS signal, this unit reproduces no sound. • If you play a source encoded with a DTS signal with the input mode set to AUTO; – This unit automatically switches to the DTSdecoding mode (The “t” indicator lights up.) after having detected the DTS signal. When playback of the DTS source is completed, the “t” indicator may flash. While this indicator is flashing, only DTS source can be played. If you want to play a normal PCM source soon, set the input mode back to AUTO. – The “t” indicator may flash when a search or skip operation is performed while the DTS source is playing back with the input mode set to AUTO. If this status continues for longer than 30 seconds, this unit will automatically switch from “DTS-decoding” mode to PCM digital signal input mode. The “t” indicator will turn off. ADVANCED OPERATION AUTO: ■ Notes on playing DTS-CD/LDs BASIC OPERATION Front panel • DSP programs cannot be selected. Sound will be output as normal 2-channel stereo sound from only the left and right main speakers. • Use the coaxial input (COAXIAL IN) jack to input over 96 kHz digital signals. The signals may not be correctly played back if the optical input (OPTICAL IN) jack is used. • Level adjustment for effect speakers other than a subwoofer is not possible. PREPARATION Press INPUT MODE (the input selector button that you have pressed to select the input source on the remote control) repeatedly until the desired input mode is shown on the front panel display and on the video monitor. The digital input jacks of this unit can handle up to a 96 kHz sampling digital signal. However when inputting a higher digital signal than 48 kHz, be aware of the following points. INTRODUCTION This unit comes with various input jacks. You can set the priority of the input signal among different types of input signals. y English • When AUTO is selected, this unit automatically determines the type of signal. If this unit detects a Dolby Digital or DTS signal, the decoder automatically switches to the appropriate setting. • When you turn on the power of this unit, the input mode is set according to “8 INPUT MODE” on the SET MENU (see page 64 for details). 29 0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 29 02.8.9, 10:37 AM BASIC PLAYBACK 3 Selecting a Sound Field Program You can enhance your listening experience by selecting a DSP program. There are 11 programs with sub-programs available with this unit. However the selection depends on the input signal format and not all the sub-programs are possible for all input signal formats. For details about each program, see pages 33 to 37. After selecting the desired program, press the same button repeatedly to select the desired sub-program if available. For example, to select the sub-program “70 mm Sci-Fi”, press MOVIE THEATER 1 repeatedly. 10KEY DSP EX/ES HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX 8 /DTS SUR. SELECT VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I TA L STANDBY /ON 6CH INPUT Program name MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT PRESET/ TUNING A/B/C/D/E PRESET /TUNING TUNER VCR 1 VCR2 /DVR PHONO FM/AM MEMORY PHONES STEREO TUNING MODE BASS TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL PROGRAM V AUX V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 VCR2/DVR SILENT VIDEO AUX – – + DSP + CBL/SAT D TV/LD MOVIE PRO LOGIC / 2 1 VCR 1 DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO VOLUME EFFECT 10KEY DSP EX/ES HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 6 7 8 5 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 A/B/C/D/E /DTS SUR. 2,3 • When you select an input source, this unit automatically selects the last DSP program used with that source. • When you set this unit in the standby mode, the current source and DSP program are memorized and are automatically selected when you turn on the power again. • If a Dolby Digital or DTS signal is input when the input mode is set to AUTO, the DSP program (No. 9–11) automatically switches to the appropriate decoding program. • When a monaural source is being played with PRO LOGIC/ Normal or PRO LOGIC/Enhanced, PRO LOGIC Movie, or Neo: 6 Cinema, no sound will be heard from the main speakers and the rear speakers. Sound can only be heard from the center speaker. However, if “1A CENTER SP” on the SET MENU is set to NONE, the center channel sound is output from the main speakers. • When a source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks of this unit is selected, the digital sound field processor cannot be used. • When 48-kHz sampling digital signals are input to this unit, the DSP program cannot be selected. In this case, the sound is reproduced as normal 2-channel stereo. VOLUME STEREO DISC R Notes MUTE CH TV MUTE L SELECT PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL 70mm Sci-Fi Sub-program name ROCK CONCERT CHP/INDEX SP A THEATER 1 EFFECT 1 Set 10KEY/DSP to DSP on the remote control. 2 Press PROGRAM l / h (one of the DSP program buttons on the remote control) to select the desired program. The name of the selected program appears on the front panel display and on the video monitor. 10KEY DSP 10KEY DSP PROGRAM or EX/ES HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 7 5 6 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX /DTS SUR. 8 SELECT y Front panel Remote control • Choose a DSP program based on your listening preference, and not on the name of the program. The acoustics of your listening room affect the DSP program. Minimize the sound reflections in your room to maximize the effect created by the program. Program name V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 DSP CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO VOLUME MOVIE THEATER 1 PRO LOGIC / 96KHz /24Bit SP A 70mm Spectacle L R Sub-program name 30 0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 30 02.8.9, 10:37 AM BASIC PLAYBACK 4 Selecting PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC or Neo: 6 VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I TA L • When PRO LOGIC is selected Movie↔ Music • When Neo: 6 is selected Cinema ↔ Music STANDBY /ON 10KEY DSP 6CH INPUT SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B HALL 1 PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT PRESET/ TUNING A/B/C/D/E PRESET /TUNING TUNER VCR 1 STEREO S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL EX/ES PROGRAM 4 TV THEATER 5 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 EFFECT SILENT VIDEO AUX – + – CHP/INDEX + JAZZ CLUB 3 MUSIC VIDEO V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 CHURCH 2 ENTERTAINMENT TREBLE 8 /DTS SUR. SELECT Note • PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC only 2-channel sources. 2 10KEY DSP HALL 1 HALL 2 1 ROCK CONCERT EX/ES CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 2 3 4 ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E 7 SELECT PRESET TV INPUT MUTE VOLUME CH TV VOL ■ Playing the Dolby Digital EX or DTS ES software 2,3,4 8 /DTS SUR. and Neo: 6 decoders can decode STEREO TV MUTE Press EX/ES to turn on the Dolby Digital EX or DTS ES decoder to listen to the Dolby Digital EX and DTS ES software with a rear center speaker. EFFECT EX/ES Select a 2-channel source and start playback on the source component. 2 (Operating using the front panel) Select a decoder and subprogram. Press PROGRAM l / h on the front panel repeatedly to select PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC , or Neo: 6. PROGRAM Front panel EX/ES HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 7 5 6 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX /DTS SUR. 8 SELECT V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD DOLBY DSP PRO LOGIC / CD R TUNER CD PHONO P R O L O G I C II SP A VOLUME PRO LOGIC L R Select a decoder. Press SELECT to select PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC or Neo: 6. 10KEY DSP EX/ES CHP/INDEX HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO VOLUME LFE DIGITAL SP A Matrix 6.1 L C R RL RC RR (Example: when playing the Dolby Digital EX software) Press EX/ES to select the mode. (The modes that can be selected vary depending on the format of the software to play.) AUTO: This mode automatically switches Dolby Digital EX/DTS ES Matrix 6.1/DTS ES Discrete 6.1 depending on the signal in the input source that this unit can detect. Rear center speaker does not work for 5.1 channel sources. Discrete 6.1: This mode can be selected only when the source with DTS ES Discrete format has been detected. (The DISCRETE indicator lights up.) Matrix 6.1: This mode makes 6-channel playback of the input source with Matrix or Matrix compatible format through the Matrix 6.1 EX or MATRIX decoder. (Either indicator lights up.) OFF: Rear center speaker does not work in this mode. JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 /DTS SUR. EX 8 SELECT 31 0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 31 02.8.9, 10:37 AM English 3 MD/TAPE VCR2/DVR DSP APPENDIX Remote control V AUX ADDITIONAL INFORMATION (Operating using the remote control) Press V/DTS SUR. on the remote control. The previously selected sub program appears on the front panel display. CHP/INDEX ADVANCED OPERATION 1 BASIC OPERATION DISC 10KEY DSP PREPARATION PHONES PHONO BASS MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD VCR2 /DVR TUNING MODE FM/AM MEMORY HALL 2 1 ROCK CONCERT MODE INTRODUCTION You can enjoy the 2-channel sources decoded into five or six discrete channels by selecting PRO LOGIC, PRO LOGIC or Neo: 6 in the program No. 11. Select a subprogram suitable for the source. The selection switches as follows each time V/DTS SUR. is pressed. • When PRO LOGIC is selected Normal ↔ Enhanced BASIC PLAYBACK ■ Normal Stereo Reproduction Notes • Some 6.1-channel compatible discs do not have a signal (flag) which this unit can automatically detect. When playing these kinds of discs with 6.1-channel, select “Matrix 6.1”. • 6.1-channel playback is not possible even if EX/ES is pressed in the following cases: – When “1C REAR L/R SP”is set to “NONE”. – When the sound effect is turned off. – When the source connected to the 6CH INPUT jack is being played. – When the source being played does not contain rear L/R channel signals. – When Dolby Digital KARAOKE source is being played. – When headphones are connected. – When “6ch Stereo” is selected. • When the power of this unit is turned off, the input mode will be reset to AUTO. ■ Virtual CINEMA DSP With the Virtual CINEMA DSP, you can enjoy all the DSP programs without rear speakers. It creates the virtual speakers to reproduce the natural sound field. The sound field processing is changed to the Virtual CINEMA DSP mode according to the selected DSP program by setting “1C REAR L/R SP” on the SET MENU to NONE. Note • This unit is not set in the virtual CINEMA DSP mode even if “1C REAR L/R SP” is set to NONE in the following cases: – when the 6ch Stereo, DOLBY DIGITAL Normal, Pro Logic , DTS Normal or Neo: 6 program is selected; – when the sound effect is turned off; – when 6CH INPUT is selected as the input source; – when 96-kHz sampling digital signals are input to this unit; – when using the test tone; or – when connecting the headphones. Press STEREO/EFFECT to turn off the sound effect for normal stereo reproduction. Press STEREO/EFFECT again to turn the sound effect back on. or EFFECT EFFECT Front panel Remote control Notes • If “1B MAIN SP” on the SET MENU is set to “SMALL” and “1E LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “SWFR”, or “1E LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “BOTH”, the LFE signals will be output from the subwoofer. • If you turn off the sound effect while a Dolby Digital or DTS signal is being output, the dynamic range of the signal is automatically compressed and the sounds of the center and rear speaker channels are mixed and output from the main speakers. • The volume may be greatly reduced when you turn off the sound effect or if you set “11 D-RANGE” on the SET MENU to MIN. In this case turn on the sound effect. ■ Displaying the information about the input source You can display the information such as the type, format and sampling frequency of the signal input from the component connected to this unit. 1 Select the input source you want to obtain the information about by pressing an input selector button. PHONO ■ SILENT CINEMA DSP You can enjoy the powerful sound field as if there were actual speakers with the SILENT CINEMA DSP. You can listen to SILENT CINEMA DSP by connecting your headphones to the PHONES jack while the digital sound field processor is on. Enjoy all the DSP program using the headphones. The “SILENT” indicator lights up on the front panel display. (If the sound effect is off, you listen to the source with normal stereo reproduction.) STEREO STEREO 2 V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD Press STEREO/EFFECT to light STEREO. EFFECT 3 Press k/n to display the information about the input signal. PARAMETER Note ON SCREEN LEVEL SLEEP TEST SET MENU • This unit is not set in the SILENT CINEMA DSP mode even if the sound effect is on in the following cases: – when 6CH INPUT is selected as the input source – when over 48-kHz sampling digital signals are being input 32 0105V2300_27-32_EN(U) 32 STEREO 02.8.9, 10:37 AM DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP) PREPARATION A sound field is defined as the “characteristic sound reflections of a particular space.” In concert halls and other music venues, we hear early reflections and reverberations as well as the direct sound produced by the artist(s). The variations in the early reflections and other reverberations among the different music venues is what gives each venue its special and recognizable sound quality. YAMAHA sent teams of sound engineers all around the world to measure the sound reflections of famous concert halls and music venues, and collect detailed sound field information such as the direction, strength, range, and delay time of those reflections. Then we stored this enormous amount of data in the ROM chips of this unit. INTRODUCTION Understanding Sound Fields Hi-Fi DSP Programs BASIC OPERATION Recreating the sound field of a concert hall or an opera house requires localizing the virtual sound sources in your listening room. The traditional stereo system that uses only two speakers is not capable of recreating a realistic sound field. YAMAHA’s DSP requires four effect speakers to recreate sound fields based on the measured sound field data. The processor controls the strength and delay time of the signals output from the four effect speakers to localize the virtual sound sources in a full circle around the listener. CINEMA-DSP ADVANCED OPERATION ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Filmmakers intend the dialog to be located right on the screen, the effect sound a little farther back, the music spread even farther back, and the surround sound around the listener. Of course, all of these sounds must be synchronized with the images on the screen. CINEMA-DSP is an upgraded version of YAMAHA DSP specially designed for movie soundtracks. CINEMA-DSP integrates the DTS, Dolby Digital, and Dolby Pro Logic surround sound technologies with YAMAHA DSP sound field programs to provide the surround sound field. It recreates the most complete movie sound design in your audio room. In CINEMA-DSP sound field programs, YAMAHA’s exclusive DSP processing is added to the right and left Main and Center channels, so the listener can enjoy realistic dialogue, depth of sound, smooth transition between sound sources, and a surround sound field that goes beyond the screen. When a DTS or Dolby Digital signal is detected, the CINEMA-DSP sound field processor automatically chooses the most suitable sound field program for that signal. L SURROUND SOUND FIELD PRESENCE SOUND FIELD EFFECT APPENDIX DIALOG MUSIC R SURROUND SOUND FIELD English 33 0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 33 02.8.9, 10:37 AM DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP) Straight Decode This unit is equipped with various precise decoders; • Dolby Digital/DTS decoder for multi-channel reproduction of the original sound • Dolby Digital EX/DTS ES decoder for an additional rear center channel • Dolby Pro Logic/Pro Logic /DTS Neo:6 decoder for multi-channel reproduction of 2-channel sources Select any of the STRAIGHT DECODE modes in Program 11 (except for the sub-program “Enhanced.”) to use any of these decoders for reproducing the original sound without any sound effects added. In this case, no DSP effect is applied and the DSP indicator turns off. Sound Field Effect The 6-channel soundtracks found on 70-mm film produce precise sound field localization and rich, deep sound without using matrix processing. This unit’s MOVIE THEATER programs provide the same quality of sound and sound localization that 6-channel soundtracks do. The built-in Dolby Digital or DTS decoder brings the professional-quality sound designed for movie theaters into your home. With this unit’s MOVIE THEATER programs, you can recreate a dynamic sound that gives you the feeling of being at a public theater in your listening room by using Dolby Digital or DTS technology. ■ Dolby Digital/DTS + DSP sound field effect These programs use YAMAHA’s tri-field DSP processing on each of the Dolby Digital or DTS signals for the front, left surround and right surround channels. This processing enables this unit to reproduce the immense sound field and surround expression of a Dolby Digital- or DTSequipped movie theater without sacrificing the clear separation of all channels. Presence DSP sound field Left surround DSP sound field Right surround DSP sound field ■ Dolby Digital EX/DTS ES + DSP sound field effect These programs provide you with the maximum experience of the spacious surround effects since an extra rear center DSP sound field created from the rear center channel is added. ■ Dolby Pro Logic + DSP sound field effect Most movie software has 4-channel (left, center, right and surround) sound information encoded by Dolby Surround matrix processing and stored on the left and right tracks. These signals are processed by the Dolby Pro Logic decoder. The MOVIE THEATER programs for 2-channel sources are designed to recreate the spaciousness and delicate nuances of sound that tend to be lost in the encoding and decoding processes. Presence DSP sound field Surround DSP sound field ■ Dolby Pro Logic /DTS Neo: 6 Dolby Pro Logic and DTS Neo: 6 equipped on this unit decode the 2-channel Dolby Surround software into five or six full range channels. They also provide two modes; MOVIE/CINEMA for movies and MUSIC for 2-channel sources. 34 0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 34 02.8.9, 10:37 AM DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP) Features of DSP Programs Mode Hi-Fi DSP Sub program Features 1 CONCERT HALL 1 — This is a large fan-shaped concert hall which has approximately 2500 seats. Almost the whole interior is made of wood. There is relatively little reflection from the walls, and sound spreads finely and beautifully. 2 CONCERT HALL 2 — A large round concert hall with a rich surround effect. Pronounced reflections from all directions emphasize the extension of sounds. The sound field has a great deal of presence, and your virtual seat is near the center, close to the stage. 3 CHURCH — This program recreates the acoustic environment of a big church with a high dome and columns along each side. The reverberation delay is very long while the early reflections are smaller than with other sound field programs. 4 JAZZ CLUB — This is the sound field at stage front in “The Bottom Line”, a famous New York jazz club. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a sound field offering a real and vibrant sound. 5 ROCK CONCERT — The ideal program for lively, dynamic rock music. The data for this program was recorded at LA’s “hottest” rock club. The listener’s virtual seat is at the center-left of the hall. 6 ENTERTAINMENT For music sources 7 MUSIC VIDEO 8 TV THEATER 6ch Stereo Using this program increases the listening position range. This is a sound field suitable for background music at parties. Game This program adds a deep and spatial feeling to video game sounds. — This program produces an enthusiastic atmosphere and lets you feel as if you are at an actual jazz or rock concert. This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources (such as old movies). The program produces the optimum reverberation to create sound depth using only the presence sound field. Variety/Sports Though the presence sound field is relatively narrow, the surround sound field employs the sound environment of a large concert hall. With this program, you can enjoy watching various TV programs such as news, variety shows, music programs or sports programs. 35 0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 35 02.8.9, 10:37 AM English Mono Movie APPENDIX ENTERTAINMENT This program recreates the acoustic environment of a lively disco in the heart of a big city. The sound is dense and highly concentrated. It is also characterized by a high-energy, “immediate” sound. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION For audiovideo sources 6 Disco ADVANCED OPERATION Program BASIC OPERATION No. PREPARATION CINEMA DSP Type of sources INTRODUCTION The following list gives you a brief description of the sound fields produced by each of the DSP programs. Keep in mind that most of these are precise digital recreations of actual acoustic environments. Mode DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP) Type of sources No. 9 CINEMA DSP 10 Program MOVIE THEATER 1 Sub program Spectacle This program creates the extremely wide sound field of a 70-mm movie theater. It precisely reproduces the source sound in detail, making both the video and the sound field incredibly real. This is ideal for any kind of video source encoded with Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital or DTS (especially large-scale movie productions). Sci-Fi This program clearly reproduces dialog and sound effects in the latest sound form of science fiction films, thus creating a broad and expansive cinematic space amid the silence. You can enjoy science fiction films in a virtual-space sound field that includes Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital and DTS-encoded software employing the most advanced techniques. Adventure This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of the newest 70-mm and multichannel soundtrack films. The sound field is made to be similar to that of the newest movie theaters, so the reverberations of the sound field itself are restrained as much as possible. General This program is for reproducing sounds from 70-mm and multichannel soundtrack films, and is characterized by a soft and extensive sound field. The presence sound field is relatively narrow. It spatially spreads all around and toward the screen, restraining the echo effect of conversations without losing clarity. DOLBY DIGITAL Enhanced DTS DIGITAL SUR Enhanced PRO LOGIC Enhanced This program ideally simulates the multi-surround speaker systems of the 35-mm film theaters. Dolby Pro Logic decoding, Dolby Digital decoding or DTS decoding and digital sound field processing create precise effects without altering the original sound orientation. The surround effects produced by this sound field wrap around the viewer naturally from the back to the left and right, and toward the screen. DOLBY DIGITAL Normal DTS DIGITAL SUR Normal PRO LOGIC Normal PRO LOGIC Movie MOVIE THEATER 2 For movie programs 11 STRAIGHT DECODE 11 Features The built-in decoder precisely reproduces sounds and sound effects from sources. The highly efficient decoding process improves crosstalk and channel separation and makes sound positioning smoother and more precise. In this program, no DSP effect is applied. To reproduce 2 channel sources decoding into multichannels in each decoding mode. Music DTS Neo:6 Cinema Music 36 0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 36 02.8.9, 10:37 AM DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PROCESSING (DSP) Table of Program Names for Each Input Format No. 9 11 DOLBY DIGITAL EX decoder: active (on) DTS ES decoder: inactive (off) DTS ES decoder: active (on) 70 mm Spectacle DGTL Spectacle Spectacle EX DTS Spectacle Spectacle ES 70 mm Sci-Fi DGTL Sci-Fi Sci-Fi EX DTS Sci-Fi Sci-Fi ES MOVIE THEATER 2 70 mm Adventure DGTL Adventure Adventure EX DTS Adventure Adventure ES 70 mm General DGTL General General EX DTS General General ES — Normal Dolby D EX — — — Enhanced EX Enhanced — — — — — Normal ES Matrix 6.1*1 ES Dscrt 6.1 *2 — — — Enhanced Enhanced ES Normal — — — — Enhanced — — — — Movie — — — — Music — — — — Cinema — — — — Music — — — — DOLBY DIGITAL DTS DGTL SUR PRO LOGIC PRO LOGIC DTS Neo: 6 ADVANCED OPERATION DOLBY DIGITAL EX decoder: inactive (off) y Note ” indicator does not light up when selecting the program No. 11 except for the Enhanced mode. APPENDIX • If a Dolby Digital signal or DTS signal is input when the input mode is set to AUTO, the DSP program will be automatically switched to the Dolby Digital playback sound field or DTS playback sound field. • If Dolby Digital Surround EX software or DTS ES software is played when AUTO is selected by pressing the EX/ES button on the remote control, the Dolby Digital EX or DTS ES decoder will automatically turn on and the corresponding DSP program will be selected. • EX/ES on the remote control can be used to play Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1 channel sources with rear center speaker. In this case the program name changes to the corresponding name for 6.1 channel. • When playing 6.1 channel source with EX/ES on the remote control off, the program name changes to the corresponding name for 5.1 channel. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION *1 means the DTS ES Matrix decoder is active. *2 means the DTS ES Discrete decoder is active. • The “ BASIC OPERATION 2 channel Stereo Program MOVIE THEATER 1 DTS PREPARATION 10 DOLBY DIGITAL INTRODUCTION Input English 37 0106V2300_33-37_EN(U) 37 02.8.9, 10:37 AM TUNING 4 Automatic and Manual Tuning There are 2 ways of tuning; automatic and manual. Automatic tuning is effective when station signals are strong and there is no interference. ■ Automatic tuning Press PRESET/TUNING l / h once to begin automatic tuning. Press h to tune in to a higher frequency, or press l to tune in to a lower frequency. Press the same button again if the tuning search does not stop at the desired station. PRESET/ TUNING VCR 1 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER TUNED SP A CD AUTO A~~AM~1404 ~ VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 When tuned in to a station, the “TUNED” indicator lights up and the frequency of the received station is shown on the front panel display. D I G I T A L STANDBY /ON 6CH INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2 /DVR A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM PRESET /TUNING TUNER FM/AM MEMORY TUNING MODE BASS TREBLE y MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD PHONO PHONES S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 EFFECT SILENT VIDEO AUX – + – • Use the manual tuning method if the tuning search does not stop at the desired station because the signal is weak. + ■ Manual tuning 4 32 3 1 Rotate INPUT (press TUNER on the remote control) to select TUNER as the input source. If the signal from the station you want to select is weak, you must tune in to it manually. 1 Select TUNER and the reception band following steps 1 and 2 described in “Automatic tuning” on left. 2 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO) so that the “AUTO” indicator goes off from the front panel display. PHONO or V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD INPUT Front panel TUNING MODE Remote control AUTO Goes off AUTO/MAN'L MONO 2 Press FM/AM to select the reception band. “FM” or “AM” appears on the front panel display. If the colon (:) appears on the front panel display next to the band indication, press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn it off. FM/AM or PRESET /TUNING VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD TUNED 3 Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO) so that the “AUTO” indicator lights up on the front panel display. TUNING MODE AUTO Lights up AUTO/MAN'L MONO If the colon (:) appears on the front panel display next to the band indication, press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn it off. PRESET /TUNING VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER TUNED EDIT SP A CD EDIT 3 SP A Press PRESET/TUNING l / h to tune in to the desired station manually. PRESET/ TUNING Hold down the button to continue the tuning search. Note • Manually tuning in to an FM station will automatically change the reception mode to monaural to increase the signal quality. AUTO A~~AM~1404 ~ 38 0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 38 A~~AM~1404 ~ 02.8.9, 10:37 AM TUNING y Presetting Stations VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I TA L STANDBY /ON 6CH INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM PRESET /TUNING TUNER VCR 1 FM/AM MEMORY PHONES PHONO TUNING MODE BASS ■ Automatic preset tuning options TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD VCR2 /DVR S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 EFFECT SILENT VIDEO AUX – – + + Press FM/AM to select the FM band. FM/AM 2 TUNING MODE AUTO Lights up AUTO/MAN'L MONO 3 MEMORY ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Press and hold MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM) for more than 3 seconds. The preset number, the “MEMORY” and “AUTO” indicators flash. Then, after about 5 seconds, automatic preset tuning begins from the frequency currently displayed toward the higher frequencies. Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is set in the standby mode, the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet, or the power supply is temporarily cut due to power failure. However, if the power is cut for more than one week, the preset stations may be cleared. If so, store the stations again by using the presetting station methods. MAN'L/AUTO FM VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO MUTE SLEEP APPENDIX V AUX VOLUME AUTO MEMORY SP A A1:FM 87.5 MHz L ADVANCED OPERATION Press TUNING MODE (AUTO/MAN’L MONO) so that the “AUTO” indicator lights up on the front panel display. You can select the preset number from which this unit will store FM stations and/or begin tuning toward lower frequencies. 1. Repeat steps 1 and 2 in “Automatically presetting stations” on left. 2. After pressing MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM) for about 3 seconds, press A/B/C/D/E, then PRESET/ TUNING l / h to select the preset number under which the first station will be stored. Automatic preset tuning will stop when stations have all been stored up to E8. 3. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to turn off the colon (:) and then press PRESET/TUNING l to begin tuning toward lower frequencies. BASIC OPERATION 132 1 Notes • Any stored station data existing under a preset number is cleared when you store a new station under that preset number. • Only FM stations with sufficient signal strength are stored automatically by automatic preset tuning. If the station you want to store is weak in signal strength, tune in to it manually in the monaural mode, and store it by following the procedure in “Manually presetting stations” on page 40. PREPARATION You can use the automatic preset tuning feature to store FM stations. This function enables this unit to automatically tune in to FM stations with strong signals, and to store up to 40 (8 stations x 5 groups) of those stations in order. This feature enables you to easily tune in to any preset station by selecting the preset station number (see page 41). INTRODUCTION ■ Automatically presetting stations (for FM stations) • When a station data is stored under a preset number, the frequency and reception band are also stored. • You can manually replace a preset station with another FM or AM station by simply following the procedure in the section “Exchanging Preset Stations” on page 41. • If the number of the received stations does not reach E8, automatic preset tuning has automatically stopped after searching all stations. R When automatic preset tuning is completed, the front panel display shows the frequency of the last preset station. English 39 0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 39 02.8.9, 10:37 AM TUNING ■ Manually presetting stations 4 You can also store up to 40 stations (8 stations x 5 groups) manually. VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I TA L Press PRESET/TUNING l / h to select a preset station number (1 to 8) while the “MEMORY” indicator is flashing. Press h to select a higher preset station number. Press l to select a lower preset station number. STANDBY /ON PRESET/ TUNING 6CH INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM PRESET /TUNING TUNER VCR 1 PHONO TUNING MODE BASS TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD VCR2 /DVR FM/AM MEMORY PHONES S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 EFFECT SILENT VIDEO AUX – – + + V AUX 3 4 VCR2/DVR VCR 1 2,5 Tune in to a station. See page 38 for tuning instructions. V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER 5 CD PHONO MUTE SLEEP VOLUME TUNED SP A A :AM 630 kHz L R When tuned in to a station, the front panel display shows the frequency of received station. 2 D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO VOLUME TUNED MEMORY SP A 1 CBL/SAT Press MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM). The “MEMORY” indicator flashes for about 5 seconds. C3:AM 630 kHz L R Press MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM) on the front panel while the “MEMORY” indicator is flashing. MEMORY The station band and frequency MAN'L/AUTO FM appear on the front panel display with the preset group and number you have selected. V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO VOLUME TUNED MEMORY SP A C3:AM 630 kHz L R Shows the displayed station has been stored as C3. MEMORY MEMORY 6 MAN'L/AUTO FM Flashes 3 Repeat steps 1 to 5 to store other stations. Notes Press A/B/C/D/E repeatedly to select a preset station group (A to E) while the “MEMORY” indicator is flashing. The group letter appears and make sure that the colon (:) appears on the front panel display next to the band indication. • Any stored station data existing under a preset number is cleared when you store a new station under that preset number. • The reception mode (stereo or monaural) is stored along with the station frequency. A/B/C/D/E V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO MUTE SLEEP VOLUME TUNED MEMORY SP A C :AM 630 kHz L R 40 0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 40 02.8.9, 10:37 AM TUNING Tuning in to a Preset Station Exchanging Preset Stations You can exchange the assignment of two preset stations with each other. The example below describes the procedure for exchanging preset station “E1” with “A5”. INTRODUCTION You can tune any desired station simply by selecting the preset station number under which it was stored. VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I TA L VOLUME STANDBY /ON NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 6CH INPUT D I G I TA L MODE STANDBY /ON SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM PRESET /TUNING TUNER VCR 1 BASS TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO PHONES PHONO TUNING MODE FM/AM MEMORY EDIT CD VCR2 /DVR S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL 6CH INPUT MODE V–AUX SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R EFFECT REC OUT /ZONE 2 SILENT VIDEO AUX – + – + SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM TUNER VCR 1 PRESET /TUNING BASS TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO PHONES PHONO TUNING MODE FM/AM MEMORY EDIT CD VCR2 /DVR S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 EFFECT SILENT VIDEO AUX – – + + PREPARATION 1 2 10KEY DSP EX/ES 1 HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 0 +10 CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E /DTS SUR. SELECT 12 +100 PRESET TV INPUT 2 Press and hold PRESET/TUNING EDIT for more than 3 seconds. “E1” and the “MEMORY” indicator flash on the front panel display. STEREO DISC 2 EFFECT *1 These buttons can be used to directly select the preset group (A to E from left to right). *2 These buttons can be used to directly select the preset station number 1 to 8. SP A EDIT 3 or TV INPUT Front panel CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO TUNED MEMORY A/B/C/D/E A/B/C/D/E VCR 1 E1:FM 87.5 MHz Tune in to preset station “A5” by using the A/B/C/D/E and PRESET/TUNING. “A5” and the “MEMORY” indicator flash on the front panel display. V AUX Remote control VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD MD/TAPE DVD CD R TUNER CD PHONO MUTE SLEEP ADVANCED OPERATION Press A/B/C/D/E (A/B/C/D/E on the remote control) to select the preset station group. The preset group letter appears on the front panel display and changes each time you press A/B/C/D/E. PRESET /TUNING BASIC OPERATION Tune in to preset station “E1” by using the A/B/C/D/E and PRESET/TUNING l / h. See “Tuning in to a Preset Station” on left. VOLUME TV MUTE 1 1 MUTE CH TV VOL 1,3 1,3 2,4 *2 *1 VOLUME TUNED MEMORY SP A Note 2 Press PRESET/TUNING l / h (PRESET –/+ on the remote control) to select a preset station number (1 to 8). The preset group and number appear on the front panel display along with the station band, frequency and the “TUNED” indicator lights up. 4 R Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) again. The stations stored at the two preset assignments are exchanged. PRESET /TUNING EDIT L V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD MEMORY SP A EDIT E1-A5 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION • Make sure that “TUNER” mode is selected if operating using the remote control. A5:FM 90.6 MHz Shows the exchange of stations has been completed. PRESET APPENDIX PRESET/ TUNING or CH DISC Front panel CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD English VCR 1 Remote control PHONO TUNED SP A E1:FM 87.5 MHz 41 0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 41 02.8.9, 10:37 AM BASIC RECORDING REC OUT/ZONE 2 or REC OUT allows you to record one source while watching and/or listening to another source. Recording adjustments and other operations are performed from the recording components. Refer to the operation instructions for these components. VOLUME NATURAL SOUND AV RECEIVER RX-V2300 D I G I TA L STANDBY /ON 6CH INPUT MODE SOURCE /REMOTE DVD MD/TAPE D–TV/LD CD–R SPEAKERS A B PROCESSOR BASS DIRECT EXTENSION CBL/SAT A/B/C/D/E PRESET/ TUNING STEREO PROGRAM TUNER VCR 1 PHONO PRESET /TUNING FM/AM MEMORY TUNING MODE BASS TREBLE MAN'L/AUTO FM AUTO/MAN'L MONO EDIT CD VCR2 /DVR PHONES S VIDEO VIDEO L AUDIO R OPTICAL V–AUX REC OUT /ZONE 2 EFFECT SILENT VIDEO AUX – + – + (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models) 2 1 Turn on the power to this unit and all connected components. 2 Select the source component you want to record from by using REC OUT/ZONE 2 or REC OUT. • To record the current input source that you are watching or listening to, set REC OUT/ZONE 2 or REC OUT to SOURCE/REMOTE. SOURCE /REMOTE MD/TAPE DVD D-TV/LD CD-R CBL/SAT VCR 1 TUNER CD VCR2 /DVR V-AUX PHONO REC OUT/ZONE 2 • To record a source other than the one that you are watching or listening to, set REC OUT/ZONE 2 or REC OUT to the source you want to record. SOURCE /REMOTE MD/TAPE DVD D-TV/LD CD-R CBL/SAT VCR 1 TUNER CD VCR2 /DVR V-AUX PHONO REC OUT/ZONE 2 Note • At this setting, you can change the source to listen to or watch during recording by rotating INPUT (one of the input selector buttons on the remote control). 3 4 Start playback (or select a broadcast station) on the source component. Start recording on the recording component. y • Setting REC OUT/ZONE 2 or REC OUT to SOURCE/ REMOTE and using the BGV function (see page 28) allows the recording of audio and video from a different source. Notes • Do a test recording before you start an actual recording. • When this unit is set in the standby mode, you cannot record between other components connected to this unit. • The setting of BASS, TREBLE, BASS EXTENSION, VOLUME, “3 L/R BALANCE” on the SET MENU and DSP programs does not affect the recorded material. • A source connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks of this unit cannot be recorded. • S-video and composite video signals pass independently through this unit’s video circuits. Therefore, when recording or dubbing video signals, if your video source component is connected to provide only an S-video (or only a composite video) signal, you can record only an S-video (or only a composite video) signal by your VCR. • A given input source is not output on the same REC OUT channel. (For example, the signal input from VCR 1 IN is not output on VCR 1 OUT.) • Check the copyright laws in your country to record from records, CDs, radio, etc. Recording of copyrighted material may infringe copyright laws. If you playback a video source that uses scrambled or encoded signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the picture itself may be disturbed due to those signals. ■ Special considerations when recording DTS software The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Attempting to digitally record the DTS bitstream will result in noise being recorded. Therefore, if you want to use this unit to record sources that have DTS signals recorded on them, the following considerations and adjustments need to be made. For LDs, DVDs and CDs encoded with DTS, when your player is compatible with the DTS format, follow its operation instruction to make a setting so that the analog signal will be output from the player. ■ Timer playback/recording This unit can perform playback or recording with an external timer (not supplied). Refer to the operation instruction for the component and the timer to be used. Notes • The stored data such as input source will be reflected in the playback or recording with the timer. • If you do not want any sound output during the recording with a timer, turn the volume down. Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data (input source, volume level, set menu settings and so on) from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode (disconnected from the AC outlet). However if the timer is turned off for more than one week, the stored data will be lost. 42 0107V2300_38-42_EN(U) 42 02.8.9, 10:37 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES This remote control also has two sophisticated features: Learn and Macro. The Learn feature allows it to acquire functions from the remote controls of other components in your system (or other household appliances) equipped with an infrared remote control receiver. The Macro feature allows you to program a series of operations in sequence for operation by a single button, or to use the factory-set macros to operate other YAMAHA components. These features make it possible for you to reduce the number of remote control in your entertainment room. PREPARATION Notes • For the operating distance of the remote control and notes about batteries, see pages 3 and 7. • For the name and function of each part and button, see pages 6 and 7. Control Area ■ Control area for each component The control area of this unit is the shaded area shown below. You can use the functions within this area no matter which component control area is selected. The component control area is the shaded area shown below. Each component has different functions for the operation buttons in the component control area. The component which has been chosen by pressing an input selector button or SOURCE SELECT k/n can be controlled and the display window shows the corresponding name of the component to be operated. MACRO TRANSMIT RE-NAME CLEAR LEARN SYSTEM OFF ON A V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD B PHONO 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE SELECT REC 10KEY DSP EX/ES – SEARCH POWER DSP is selected SOUND MENU DISPLAY STOP HALL 1 CHAPTER PAUSE HALL 2 CHURCH + PLAY JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 MACRO TRANSMIT RE-NAME CLEAR LEARN SYSTEM MACRO OFF ON STANDBY A V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD POWER B PHONO 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE TITLE SELECT SOUND MENU DISPLAY – SEARCH CHAPTER + ENTER SELECT POWER REC DISPLAY PAUSE STOP – SEARCH A/B/C/D/E 10KEY DSP MUTE ROCK CONCERT STEREO DISC EFFECT 6.1/ES PARAMETER LEVEL SLEEP TEST HALL 2 CHURCH POWER REC JAZZ CLUB STOP HALL 1 1 VOLUME CH TV MUTE ON SCREEN CHAPTER + PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL SOUND MENU PLAY 10 key is selected 2 3 ENTERTAINMENT TV SPORTS 5 6 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 CHP/INDEX 7HALL 1 A/B/C/D/E ROCK 11 CONCERT PRESET EX/ES SET MENU TV INPUT TV VOL /DTS SUR. 1 +10 0 CH DISC PLAY CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 5 MONO MOVIE 8HALL 2 SELECT2 ENTER12 TAINMENT +100 6 3 4 MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 MUTE CHP/INDEX TV MUTE PAUSE 4 /DTS SUR. SELECT VOLUME A/B/C/D/E PRESET STEREO ADDITIONAL INFORMATION CHP/INDEX /DTS SUR. Å/ı buttons and input selector buttons switch the control area for each component. * Å/ı buttons is to operate the other components that are not connected to this unit. Factory setting: Å ........... LD player ı ..... Satellite tuner ADVANCED OPERATION Input selector buttons, and Å/ı buttons MACRO STANDBY BASIC OPERATION ■ Control area of this unit POWER INTRODUCTION The remote control can operate other A/V components of YAMAHA and other manufacturers as well as this unit. To control those components, you must set up remote control with the manufacturer codes. TV INPUT EFFECT CH TV VOL TV MUTE DISC APPENDIX Component control area There are 13 component control areas. You can set up the manufacturer code and program other remote control functions in each area. See pages 52 to 56. English 43 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 43 02.8.9, 10:37 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES Setting the Manufacturer Code You can control other components by setting a manufacturer code. A code can be set up in each input area. The following table shows factory-set component (Library: component category) and the manufacturer code for each area. If you are to make a setting for different component from the factory setting, change the library as described in step 3 on right. Input area Component category (Library) Manufacturer A LD Yamaha B SAT – PHONO TV – V-AUX VCR – TUNER TUNER Yamaha-1 MD/TAPE MD Yamaha-1 CD-R CD-R Yamaha D-TV/LD TV – VCR 1 VCR – VCR 2/DVR VCR – DVD DVD Yamaha-1 CD CD Yamaha-1 CBL/SAT CABLE – • Press LEARN for at least 3 seconds, otherwise the learning process is started. • Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise, the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case, press LEARN again. 3 ENTER If you want to change a library (component category), press l / h. You can set a different component from the input selector name. Library choices: L:DVD, L:LD, L:CD, L:CDR, L:MD, L:TAP, L:TUN, L:AMP*, L:TV, L:CAB, L:DBS, L:SAT, L:VCR Press an input selector button, Å or ı to select the source component you want to set up. A B V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD PHONO The code to operate this unit has been preset in the supplied remote control. However you can change the code in Amplifier Library if necessary. Amplifier Library has the following three codes: YPC: Code to operate this unit. Zone 2: Code to use the Zone 2 function. DSP: Code to operate other Yamaha DSP amplifiers that cannot be operated with the YPC code. NO: Code to operate other manufacturers’ amplifiers using this unit’s remote control. 4 2 Press k / n to select the name of your component’s manufacturer. You will find the names of most worldwide audiovideo manufacturers in alphabetical order in the display window. ■ Amplifier Library (L:AMP) Note • You may not be able to operate your Yamaha component even if Yamaha manufacture code is initially set as listed above. In this case, try to set other Yamaha manufacture code(s). 1 Notes Press and hold LEARN for about 3 seconds by using a ballpoint pen or similar object. “SETUP” and the selected component name appear alternately in the display window. Press one of the buttons shaded below to check if it works for the component being set. If it does, the manufacturer code setting has been correctly made. 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY LEARN SELECT POWER SEARCH REC SOUND MENU STOP – CHAPTER PAUSE + PLAY Note • If the manufacturer of your component has more than one codes, try each of them until you find the correct one. y • If you continuously want to set up another code for another component, press ENTER and repeat steps 1, 3 and 4. 44 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 44 02.8.9, 10:37 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES 5 Press LEARN again to exit from the setup mode. 3 LEARN CD LEARN MACRO B OFF ON PHONO MACRO DVD CLEAR CD-R RE-NAME VCR2/DVR TRANSMIT STANDBY VCR 1 MD/TAPE SYSTEM TUNER A POWER CBL/SAT 6CH INPUT V-AUX TITLE ENTER 4 Press LEARN by using a ballpoint pen or similar object. Do not press and hold LEARN longer than three seconds. Otherwise this unit enters the manufacturer code setting mode. BASIC OPERATION LEARN If you want to program functions not included in the basic operations covered by the manufacturer code, or a manufacturer code is not available, the following procedure needs to be performed. The possible programming area is the same as a component control area, so the buttons are programmable independently for each source component area. 5 Press the button for which you want to program the new function. “LEARN” is displayed. MACRO ON MACRO OFF CD PHONO DVD 6CH INPUT ADDITIONAL INFORMATION LEARN B CLEAR A CD-R RE-NAME STANDBY MD/TAPE VCR2/DVR TRANSMIT POWER TUNER VCR 1 SYSTEM V-AUX CBL/SAT ENTER D-TV/LD TITLE Set 10KEY/DSP to 10KEY. Notes • Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise, the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case, press LEARN again. • Do not press and hold LEARN longer than 3 seconds. Otherwise this unit enters the manufacturer code setting mode. SOURCE ■ Programming a new remote control function Flashes alternately ADVANCED OPERATION Note • This remote control transmits infrared rays. If the other remote control also uses infrared rays, this remote control can learn most of the other remote control’s functions. However, you may not be able to program some special signals or extremely long transmissions. (Refer to the operation instructions for the other remote control.) PREPARATION 5 to 10 cm (2 to 4 inch) Learn Feature 1 D-TV/LD SOURCE Notes • Supplied remote control does not store all the manufacturer codes for commercially availabvle AV components (including Yamaha AV components). Therefore it may not work to operate your AV component. If operation is not possible with any of the manfacturer codes, program the new remote control function with the Learn feature (see page 45) or use the remote control for the component. • If you have already programmed a remote control function for a button, the function by learning programming takes priority over the setup manufacturer code’s function. • “ERROR” appears in the display window when pressing buttons other than indicated in each step, or more than one button at once. INTRODUCTION Place this remote control and the other remote control about 5 to 10 cm apart on a flat surface so that their infrared transmitters are aimed at each other. 10KEY DSP Notes 2 APPENDIX • It is also possible to program in the control area of this unit with 10KEY/DSP set to DSP. However, if you program functions in this area, you cannot control this unit and select a DSP program. Press an input selector button, Å or ı to select a source component. A B V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD PHONO English 45 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 45 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES 6 Press and hold the button on the other remote control that has the function you want to program into this remote control until “OK” appears in the display window. Changing the Source Name in the Display Window LEARN MACRO B CLEAR A CD-R RE-NAME STANDBY MD/TAPE TRANSMIT POWER TUNER VCR2/DVR SYSTEM V-AUX VCR 1 ENTER CBL/SAT TITLE D-TV/LD SOURCE You can change the name that appears in the display window on the remote control if you want to use the different name from the original input selector button names. This is useful when different component is set in the input selector button. ON MACRO OFF CD PHONO DVD 6CH INPUT 1 Press an input selector button, Å or ı to select the source component you want to rename. The selected component name appears in the display window. Notes • “NG” appears in the display window when programming has not been done correctly. In this case, start over from step 5. • This remote control can learn approximately 120 functions. However depending on the signals learned, “FULL” may appear in the display window much earlier than this number. In this case, clear unnecessary programmed functions to make further learning on the remote control. 7 Repeat steps 5 and 6 to program additional functions. 8 Press LEARN again to exit from the learning mode. 2 3 A B V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD PHONO Press RE-NAME by using a ballpoint pen or similar object. RE-NAME Press k / n to select a character. Choices are A to Z, a to z, 0 to 9, space, -(hyphen), and /(slash). ENTER LEARN 4 Notes • Learning may not be possibe in the following cases: – when the batteries in the remote control for this unit or other components are weak – when the distance between the two remote controls is too much or too little – when the remote control infrared windows are not facing at the appropriate angle – when the remote control is exposed to the direct sunlight – when the function to be programmed is continuous or uncommon • “ERROR” appears in the display window when pressing more than one button at once. Press l / h to move the cursor to the next position. ENTER y • If you continuously want to rename another source component, press ENTER and repeat steps 1, 3 and 4. 5 Press RE-NAME again to exit from the renaming mode. RE-NAME Note • “ERROR” appears in the display window when pressing butons other than indicated in each step, or more than one button at once. 46 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 46 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES Using the Macro Feature Press one of the macro buttons Automatically transmits signals of each button sequentially CD SYSTEM CD POWER (CD area) Second Third PHONO First PHONO – V-AUX V-AUX – TUNER TUNER – (*4) MD/TAPE MD/TAPE PREPARATION Macro buttons PLAY INTRODUCTION The Macro feature makes it possible to perform a series of operations by pressing just one button. For example, when you want to play a CD, normally you would turn on the components, select the CD input, and press the play button to start playback. The Macro feature lets you perform all those operations by simply pressing the CD macro button. The macro buttons (the input selector buttons, Å and ı buttons, SYSTEM POWER and STANDBY) are factory set with macro programs. You can also program your own macros (see page 48). PLAY BASIC OPERATION (MD/TAPE area) (*3) CD-R CD-R CD CD D-TV/LD D-TV/LD – CBL/SAT – PLAY (CD-R area) (*3) PLAY (CD area) (*3) SYSTEM POWER CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR 1 VCR2/DVR VCR2/DVR DVD DVD PLAY PLAY (VCR 1 area) (*3) (VCR 2/DVR area) (*3) ADVANCED OPERATION (*1) PLAY (DVD area) (*3) – – B – – SYSTEM POWER POWER (D-TV/LD area) (*2) STANDBY STANDBY – ADDITIONAL INFORMATION A – – 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 47 8/21/02, 11:15 AM English 47 APPENDIX *1 In order to turn on some components (including YAMAHA components) connected to this unit, connect those components to the AC OUTLET(S) on the rear panel. (Power control may not be synchronized with this unit depending on the component. For details, please refer to the operation instruction for the connected component.) *2 If the macro you select includes power control functions, the component may be turned off if it is already on when you press the macro button. For example, if your TV is on and you press the SYSTEM POWER macro button, the TV is turned off. *3 Playback can be started with any YAMAHA remote control-compatible MD recorders, CD players, CD recorders, DVD players, and LD players. When using macros to operate other components, it is either necessary to program the PLAY button on the control area of that component (see pages 45 and 46) or to set up a manufacturer code (see page 44). *4 When TUNER is selected as the input source, this unit receives the last station when this unit is set in the standby mode. REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ■ Operating the macro MACRO TRANSMIT RE-NAME CLEAR SYSTEM 1 2 LEARN MACRO OFF ON POWER STANDBY A B V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD 2 MACRO MACRO ON/OFF PHONO Press a macro button for which you want to program the macro operation. The button you chose for programming the macro operation and the selected component name appear alternately in the display window. Macro buttons Set MACRO ON/OFF to ON. B TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD PHONO Press a macro button. Notes Notes • When you have finished using the Macro feature, set MACRO ON/OFF to OFF. • While this unit is carrying out a macro program, this unit does not receive any other button’s function until the macro operation has been completed (the TRANSMIT indicator stops flashing). • Continue to aim the remote control at the component the macro is operating until the macro operation has been completed. • “AGAIN” appears in the display window when a button other than the macro buttons is pressed. • If you want to change the source component, use SOURCE SELECT k / n. When you use the input selector buttons, selecting the input is programmed as a macro step, whereas SOURCE SELECT k / n only changes the component. 3 ■ Programming a macro You can program your own macros and use the Macro feature to transmit many remote control commands by pressing a single button. Notes Press the buttons of the functions that you want to include in the macro operation sequence in order. y • You can set up to 10 steps (10 functions). After you have set 10 steps, “FULL” appears and the remote control automatically exits from the macro mode. • The factory-set macro is not cleared when a new macro is programmed for a button. The factory-set macro can be used again when the programmed macro is cleared. • It is not possible to add a new signal (macro step) to the factory-set macro. Programming a macro changes all macro contents. • A macro programming is used to transmit learning or setup (or YAMAHA preset) button signals of this remote control to a macro button. If necessary, set up the manufacturer code or program a function with the remote control for your component. • This remote control handles button signals that operate continuously, such as volume control, as short time interval codes. Macro programming that include these types of macro steps are therefore not recommended. 1 A V-AUX SYSTEM POWER STANDBY A B V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD PHONO 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY SELECT POWER SEARCH REC SOUND MENU STOP – CHAPTER PAUSE + PLAY 1 2 MCR 1 : DVD a MCR 2 : DVD p indicate the number of macro steps you entered Press MACRO by using a ballpoint pen or similar object. “MCR ?” appears in the display window. appear alternately so that you can set up the next step MACRO Note • Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise, the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case, press MACRO again. Note • “NG” appears in the display window when programming has not been done correctly. In this case, start over from step 2. 48 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 48 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES 4 MACRO 3 Press and hold CLEAR again for about 3 seconds. “C:OK” appears in the display window. INTRODUCTION Press MACRO again when the operation sequence you want to program is complete. Note • “ERROR” appears in the display when pressing butons other than indicated in each step, or more than one button at once. 1 Press CLEAR by using a ballpoint pen or similar object. CLEAR • “C:NG” appears in the display window if the operation is unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 2. 4 Press CLEAR to exit from the clearing mode. Once you have cleared a learned function or macro for a button, the button reverts to the factory setting. CLEAR Note • “ERROR” appears in the display window under the following circumstances: – when pressing a button other than the cursor and ENTER; – when pressing more than one button at once; or – when MACRO ON/OFF, 10KEY/DSP or PARAMETER/SET MENU is switched to another position. BASIC OPERATION Clearing Learned Functions, Macros, Renamed Source Names, and Setup Manufacturer Codes Note PREPARATION Memory back-up If the remote control is without batteries for more than 3 minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the remote control, the contents of the memory may be cleared. When the memory is cleared, insert new batteries, set up the manufacturer code and program any acquired functions that may have been cleared. CLEAR Note ADVANCED OPERATION • Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise, the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case, press CLEAR again. 2 Press k / n to select the clear mode. The mode is shown in the display window in the following order: ADDITIONAL INFORMATION (L: name of a component) Clears all learned functions for the component area. Press the input selector button, Å or ı to select the component. Clears all learned functions for this unit control area. APPENDIX Clears all learned functions. Clears all programmed macros. English Clears all renamed source names in the display window. Clears all programmed functions including setup manufacturer codes. This returns to the factory settings. 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 49 49 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES Clearing a Learned Function ■ Clearing a macro function 1 You can clear the function learned in a certain programmable button in each area. 1 Press an input selector button, Å or ı to select the source component you want to clear the function. The selected component name appears in the display window. A 2 B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD Press MACRO to clear a programmed macro by using a ballpoint pen or similar object. MACRO Note • Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case, press MACRO again. 2 Press LEARN by using a ballpoint pen or similar object. “LEARN” and the selected component name appear alternately in the display window. Press and hold CLEAR by using a ballpoint pen or similar object, then press the button for which you want to clear the macro for about 3 seconds. “C:OK” appears in the display window. MACRO TRANSMIT RE-NAME CLEAR SYSTEM MACRO OFF ON STANDBY V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD POWER LEARN LEARN A B PHONO y Note • Complete each of the following steps in 30 seconds. Otherwise the learning mode will be automatically canceled. In this case, press LEARN again. 3 Press and hold CLEAR by using a ballpoint pen or similar object, then press the button for which you want to clear the function for about 3 seconds. “C:OK” appears in the display window. • You can clear other learned functions and macros at this time by holding down CLEAR again and pressing the other buttons for which those learned functions or macros have been programmed. Note • “C:NG” appears in the display window if the operation is unsuccessful. In this case, try step 2 again. 3 Press MACRO again to exit from the clearing mode. Once you have cleared macro for a button, the button reverts to the factory setting. MACRO TRANSMIT RE-NAME CLEAR SYSTEM 4 LEARN MACRO OFF ON MACRO POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD LEARN Press LEARN again to exit. Once you have cleared a learned function for a button, the button reverts to the factory setting. 50 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 50 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ■ SOURCE SELECT k / n INTRODUCTION You can control another component independently from the input you have selected by pressing an input selector button. PREPARATION Press SOURCE SELECT k / n to choose the component and set the remote control to be used for it. The display window will show one of the following: (when pressing n) OPTN (option), Å, ı, PHONO, V-AUX, TUNER, MD, CD-R, CD, TV/LD (TV or digital TV/LD), CBSAT (cable TV/satellite tuner), VCR 1, VCR 2, DVD. y • Pressing k shows the same in the reverse order, but you cannot select OPTN. SOURCE BASIC OPERATION SELECT ■ OPTN (option) area OPTN is an extra component control area that can be programmed with other remote control functions. Note ADVANCED OPERATION • You cannot set up the manufacturer code in this area. See pages 45, 46 for the programming procedure. 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY SELECT POWER – SEARCH REC SOUND MENU STOP CHAPTER PAUSE + PLAY ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Pressing n always selects OPTN first ■ Zone 2 (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) APPENDIX When you make up a second audio-video room with this unit’s Zone 2 feature, you must set “Zone2” as the amplifier library in the remote control first. Selecting “Zone2” by pressing k sets the remote control to the Zone 2 mode. See pages 71 and 72 for details. 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY SELECT POWER SEARCH REC SOUND MENU STOP – CHAPTER PAUSE + PLAY English Pressing k selects “Zone2” first 51 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 51 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES Each Component Control Area The general operational buttons are shown for each area. Some of them may not function depending on the component you have. After setting the manufacturer code, press an input selector button, Å / ı, or SELECT k / n to select a component you want to control. ■ Operating a DVD player (DVD area) SYSTEM POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD TITLE 6CH INPUT TITLE Menu cursor/ENTER ENTER MENU DISPLAY SEARCH POWER Return SOURCE – SEARCH POWER REC Audio SOUND MENU DISPLAY SELECT STOP + CHAPTER PAUSE Skip search PLAY PLAY PAUSE HALL 1 10KEY DSP STOP EX/ES HALL 2 JAZZ CLUB 2 3 4 ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 7 8 5 6 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 Title/Index CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E * CHURCH 1 ROCK CONCERT /DTS SUR. Numeric buttons SELECT Clear PRESET TV INPUT MUTE TV VOL DISC +/– (disc skip) VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT * TV VOL +/–, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both DTV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area. ■ Operating a VCR (VCR 1 and VCR 2/DVR areas) SYSTEM POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE SELECT SOUND MENU DISPLAY – SEARCH CHAPTER + SEARCH POWER Record (Press twice to start recording) STOP POWER REC STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB PLAY PAUSE 10KEY DSP EX/ES TV/Video input 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX * A/B/C/D/E Numeric buttons 8 SELECT PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL /DTS SUR. MUTE VOLUME CH CH +/– (channel) STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT * TV VOL +/–, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both DTV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area. 52 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 52 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ■ Operating a TV/digital TV (D-TV/LD area) or a cable TV/satellite TV (CBL/ SAT area) SYSTEM STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD INTRODUCTION POWER 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY – SEARCH POWER REC CHAPTER + STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB POWER HALL 1 10KEY DSP EX/ES CHP/INDEX TV VOL +/– TV VOL 2 3 4 ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 A/B/C/D/E /DTS SUR. * Numeric buttons SELECT PRESET TV INPUT MUTE VOLUME CH CH +/– (channel) STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT TV MUTE * SEARCH, REC, STOP, PAUSE and PLAY function to operate your VCR without switching the input to VCR 1 if the manufacturer code is set in VCR 1. SYSTEM POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD ADVANCED OPERATION ■ Operating an LD player (D-TV/LD area) BASIC OPERATION Enter TV INPUT 1 ROCK CONCERT PREPARATION SELECT SOUND MENU DISPLAY 6CH INPUT TITLE ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY SELECT SOUND MENU DISPLAY – SEARCH CHAPTER CHAPTER –/+ (chapter search) SEARCH POWER POWER STOP SOUND + 10KEY DSP EX/ES Chapter/Time REC HALL 1 STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 A/B/C/D/E * SELECT Clear PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL /DTS SUR. Numeric buttons APPENDIX CHP/INDEX PLAY PAUSE MUTE VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT Set the manufacture code for your LD player following the setting procedure described on page 44 because TV is factory-set for this input selector button. English * TV VOL +/–, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the manufacturer code is set in PHONO. 53 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 53 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ■ Operating a CD player (CD area) SYSTEM POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY SELECT SOUND MENU DISPLAY – SEARCH + CHAPTER SEARCH Skip search POWER REC STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB POWER STOP PLAY PAUSE 10KEY DSP EX/ES INDEX 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX * A/B/C/D/E /DTS SUR. Numeric buttons SELECT Clear PRESET TV INPUT MUTE TV VOL VOLUME CH DISC +/– (disc skip) STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT * TV VOL +/–, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both DTV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area. ■ Operating a CD recorder (CD-R area) or an MD recorder (MD/TAPE area) SYSTEM POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE DISPLAY SELECT SOUND MENU DISPLAY – SEARCH CHAPTER + Skip search SEARCH POWER Record (MD only) POWER 10KEY DSP STOP EX/ES INDEX (CD-R only) * REC HALL 1 STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E Numeric buttons SELECT Clear (CD-R only) PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL /DTS SUR. PLAY PAUSE MUTE VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT * TV VOL +/–, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both DTV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area. 54 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 54 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ■ Operating a tape deck (MD/TAPE area) SYSTEM STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD INTRODUCTION POWER 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE SELECT SOUND MENU DISPLAY – SEARCH A/B + CHAPTER Direction A/B SEARCH backward/forward REC STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB Record HALL 1 10KEY DSP STOP EX/ES 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 INDEX CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E /DTS SUR. PREPARATION POWER PLAY PAUSE Numeric buttons SELECT PRESET TV INPUT MUTE VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT * TV VOL +/–, TV INPUT, and TV MUTE function to operate your TV without switching the input if the manufacturer code is set in D-TV/LD or PHONO. When the manufacturer code for your TV is set up in the both DTV/LD and PHONO areas, priority is given to the signal in the D-TV/LD area. BASIC OPERATION TV VOL ■ Operating a tuner (TUNER area) STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD ADVANCED OPERATION SYSTEM POWER 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SELECT POWER POWER 10KEY DSP EX/ES Preset group A Preset group B REC HALL 1 CHAPTER + STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 8 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 SELECT Preset group E Preset group D PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL /DTS SUR. Preset number 1 to 8 MUTE VOLUME CH APPENDIX A/B/C/D/E PRESET +/– STEREO TV MUTE Preset group A/B/C/D/E – SEARCH CHP/INDEX Preset group C SOUND MENU DISPLAY ADDITIONAL INFORMATION SOURCE DISC EFFECT English 55 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 55 02.8.9, 10:38 AM REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES ■ Operating the component set in Å or ı These buttons are not input selector buttons but simply provide the space for an extra component to control with this unit’s remote control without making connection to this unit. The white area shown below can be used for the component set in Å and ı, and the function for each button differs depending on the component. YAMAHA LD player is factory-set in Å and sattellite tuner in ı. However if you want to set other component, set the manufacturer code for the component you want to set in the Å / ı button following the manufacturer code setting procedure described on page 44. SYSTEM POWER STANDBY A B PHONO V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE POWER The functions of these buttons in the component control area differ for the component you set in Å or ı. 10KEY DSP EX/ES SOUND MENU DISPLAY SELECT – SEARCH REC HALL 1 CHAPTER + STOP PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E 8 SELECT PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL 7 /DTS SUR. MUTE VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT 56 0108V2300_43-56_EN(U) 56 02.8.9, 10:38 AM ADVANCED OPERATION SET MENU y Adjustment should be made with the remote control. Adjustment procedures are explained using SET MENU 2 LOW FRQ TEST as an example. 5 10KEY DSP EX/ES HALL 1 HALL 2 3 4 MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 A/B/C/D/E 1 SELECT MUTE VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC 2, 3, 5 3, 4 8 /DTS SUR. PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL • The indication on the front panel display is the abbreviation of the OSD. JAZZ CLUB 2 ENTERTAINMENT 5 MOVIE THEATER 1 CHP/INDEX Note CHURCH 1 ROCK CONCERT EFFECT PARAMETER ON SCREEN LEVEL SLEEP TEST PREPARATION • You can adjust the items on the SET MENU while playing a source. • We recommend that you adjust the items on the SET MENU while using a video monitor. It is easier to see the video monitor than it is to see the front panel display on this unit while adjusting the items. Adjusting the Items on the SET MENU INTRODUCTION The SET MENU consists of 16 items including the speaker mode setting, center graphic equalizer and parameter initialization features. Choose the appropriate item and adjust or select the values as necessary. SET MENU 1 SPEAKER SET 1 1B MAIN SP 1C REAR L/R SP Set PARAMETER/SET MENU to SET MENU. PARAMETER SET MENU 1D REAR CT SP 2 1E LFE/BASS OUT Press k / n repeatedly to select the item (1 to 16) you want to adjust. 1F MAIN LEVEL SET MENU 1/4 LOW FRQ TEST 3 L/R BALANCE 4 HP TONE CTRL CENTER GEQ 6 INPUT RENAME 7 I/O ASSIGNMENT SPEAKER SET LOW FRQ TEST L/R BALANCE HP TONE CTRL / : Up/Down -/+ : Enter Note • If k is pressed when SET MENU 1 is selected, and if n is pressed when SET MENU 16 is selected, SET MENU will be closed. Press k / n to open SET MENU again. 3 7A CMPNT-V INPUT 7B OPTICAL OUT Press –/+ once to enter the setup mode of the selected item. The last setting you adjusted appears on the video monitor or on the front panel display. 7C OPTICAL IN 2 LOW FRQ TEST 7D COAXIAL IN INPUT MODE 9 PARAM. INI ≥ TEST TONE………OFF OUTPUT…MAIN L/R FRQ……………………88Hz 10 LFE LEVEL Depending on the item, press k / n to select a sub item. 11 D-RANGE APPENDIX 8 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION 5 1 ≥ 2 3 4 ADVANCED OPERATION 1G SP B SET 2 BASIC OPERATION 1A CENTER SP 12 SP DELAY 2 LOW FRQ TEST 13 DISPLAY SET 14 MEMORY GUARD English TEST TONE………OFF ≥ OUTPUT…MAIN L/R FRQ……………………88Hz 15 6CH INPUT SET 16 ZONE 2 SET (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models) 57 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 57 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU 4 Press –/+ repeatedly to change the setting of the item. 2 LOW FRQ TEST ≥ TEST TONE…………ON OUTPUT…MAIN L/R FRQ……………………88Hz 1 SPEAKER SET (speaker mode settings) Use this feature to select suitable output modes for your speaker configuration. Notes 5 Press k / n repeatedly until the current DSP program appears or simply press one of the DSP program group buttons to exit from the SET MENU. 10KEY DSP or HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 7 /DTS SUR. 8 SELECT Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode. However if the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than one week, the stored data will be lost. If so, adjust the items again. • When 96-kHz sampling digital signals are input to this unit, level adjustments in items 1B,1E and 1F are possible, but those in items 1A,1C and 1D are not affected. • When 6CH INPUT is selected as the input source, level adjustments in items 1A through 1E are not affected. y • Select SML if the woofer diameter of you speaker is smaller than 16 cm. If it is larger than 16 cm, select LRG. ■ 1A CENTER SP (center speaker mode) By adding a center speaker to your speaker configuration, this unit can provide good dialog localization for many listeners and superior synchronization of sound and images. The OSD shows a large, small or no center speaker depending on how you set this item. Choices: LRG (large), SML (small), NONE Initial setting: LRG LRG Select this if you have a large center speaker. The entire range of the center channel signal is directed to the center speaker. 1A CENTER SP LRG SML NONE SML Select this if you have a small center speaker. The lowfrequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the center channel are directed to the speakers selected with “1E LFE/BASS OUT”. 1A CENTER SP LRG SML NONE NONE Select this if you do not have a center speaker. All of the center channel signal are directed to the left and right main speakers. 1A CENTER SP LRG SML NONE 58 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 58 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU ■ 1B MAIN SP (main speaker mode) The OSD shows large or small main speakers depending on how you set this item. LARGE Select this if you have large main speakers. The entire range of the left and right main channel signal is directed to the left and right main speakers. Choices: LRG (large), SML (small), NONE Initial setting: LRG LRG Select this if you have large left and right rear speakers or if a rear subwoofer is connected to the rear speakers. The entire range of the rear channel signal is directed to the left and right rear speakers. 1C REAR L/R SP LARGE SMALL 1B MAIN SP LRG SML NONE SML Select this if you have small left and right rear speakers. The low-frequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the rear channel are directed to the speakers selected with “1E LFE/BASS OUT”. 1C REAR L/R SP BASIC OPERATION SMALL Select this if you have small main speakers. The lowfrequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the main channel are directed to the speakers selected with “1E LFE/BASS OUT”. PREPARATION 1B MAIN SP The OSD shows large, small or no rear speakers depending on how you set this item. INTRODUCTION Choices: LARGE, SMALL Initial setting: LARGE ■ 1C REAR L/R SP (rear speaker mode) LARGE SMALL ADVANCED OPERATION Note LRG SML NONE • When you select MAIN for “1E LFE/BASS OUT”, the lowfrequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the main channel are directed to the main speakers even if you select SMALL for the main speaker mode. NONE Select this if you do not have rear speakers. 1C REAR L/R SP ADDITIONAL INFORMATION LRG SML NONE Note • If “1C REAR L/R SP” is set to NONE, “1D REAR CT SP” will be skipped. y APPENDIX • This unit is set in the virtual CINEMA DSP mode by selecting NONE for “1C REAR L/R SP” (see page 32). English 59 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 59 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU ■ 1D REAR CT SP (rear center speaker mode) ■ 1E LFE/BASS OUT (bass out mode) By adding a rear center speaker to your speaker configuration, this unit can provide more realistic frontto-back and transitions. The initial setting is “LRG”. LFE signals carry low-frequency effects when this unit decodes a Dolby Digital or DTS signal. Low-frequency signals are defined as 90 Hz and below. The Lowfrequency signals are directed to both main right and left speakers, and the subwoofer (subwoofer can be used for both stereo reproduction and the DSP program). Note • If “1C REAR L/R SP” is set to NONE, “1D REAR CT SP” will be skipped. Choices: LRG (large), SML (small), NONE Initial setting: LRG LRG Select this if you have a large rear center speaker. The entire range of the rear center channel signal is directed to the rear center speaker. Choices: SWFR (subwoofer), MAIN, BOTH Initial setting: BOTH SWFR Select this if you use a subwoofer. The LFE signals are directed to the subwoofer. 1E LFE/BASS OUT 1D REAR CT SP SWFR MAIN BOTH LRG SML NONE SML Select this if you have a small rear center speaker. The low-frequency signals (90 Hz and below) of the rear center channel are directed to the speakers selected with “1E LFE/BASS OUT”. MAIN Select this if you do not use a subwoofer. The LFE signals are directed to the main speakers. 1E LFE/BASS OUT SWFR MAIN BOTH 1D REAR CT SP LRG SML NONE NONE Select this if you do not have a rear center speaker. All of the rear center channel signal are directed to the left and right rear speakers. BOTH Select this if you use a subwoofer and you want to mix the main channel low-frequency signals with the LFE signals. LFE signals for the main L/R speakers are output from both L/R speakers and subwoofer. 1E LFE/BASS OUT 1D REAR CT SP SWFR MAIN BOTH Note LRG SML NONE • The low-frequency signals (90 Hz and below) from all main, center, rear and rear center channels are directed to the LFE channel when you select the small speaker setting in items 1A, 1B, 1C and 1D. 60 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 60 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU ■ 1F MAIN LEVEL (main level mode) 1G SP B SET Choices: Normal, –10 dB Initial setting: Normal MAIN 1F MAIN LEVEL Normal -10dB 1F MAIN LEVEL • When a DSP program is selected, this unit automatically enters the Virtual CINEMA DSP mode. If the headphones are connected to PHONES jack on this unit in the Virtual CINEMA DSP mode, this unit enters the SILENT CINEMA DSP mode and the sound is output from both headphones and SPEAKERS B. 2 LOW FRQ TEST Use this feature to adjust the output level of the subwoofer so it matches that of the other speakers in your configuration. Change the setting with the remote control while sitting in the listening position. 1 Press –/+ to set “TEST TONE” to ON, and adjust the volume with VOLUME +/– so you can hear the tone. ADVANCED OPERATION Normal y -10dB 2 LOW FRQ TEST ≥ TEST TONE…………ON OUTPUT…MAIN L/R FRQ……………………88Hz ■ 1G SP B SET (speaker B set) Use this feature to select the location of the main speakers to be connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals. Notes MAIN Select this to turn on/off SPEAKERS A and B when the speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals are set in the main room. 1G SP B SET ZONE B -/+ : Select / : Exit 2 Press n to go to “OUTPUT” and press –/+ to select the speaker you want to compare with the subwoofer. If SWFR is selected, the test tone above 90 Hz will not be output from the subwoofer. The test tone will not necessarily be output from the selected speakers. The output mode of the test tone depends on the settings of “1 SPEAKER SET” on the SET MENU. APPENDIX “MAIN • Do not turn up the volume too high. • If no test tone is heard, turn down the volume, set this unit in the standby mode and make sure all the necessary connections are correct. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Choices: MAIN, ZONE B Initial setting: MAIN BASIC OPERATION –10 dB Select this if you cannot match the output level of your effect speakers with that of your main speakers when using the test tone. -/+ : Select / : Exit PREPARATION Normal Select this if you can match the output level of your effect speakers with that of your main speakers when using the test tone. “ZONE B INTRODUCTION Change this setting if you cannot match the output level of the center, rear (L/R) and rear center speakers with the main speakers because of the unusually high-efficiency performance of the main speakers. ZONE B Select this if the speakers connected to the SPEAKERS B terminals are set in the second room. If SPEAKERS A is turned OFF and SPEAKERS B is turned ON, all the effect speakers in the main room are muted and the sound is output only from SPEAKERS B. 2 LOW FRQ TEST English TEST TONE………OFF ≥ OUTPUT…MAIN L/R FRQ……………………88Hz 61 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 61 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU 3 Press n to go to “FRQ” and press –/+ to select the frequency you want to use. 2 LOW FRQ TEST TEST TONE………OFF OUTPUT…MAIN L/R ≥ FRQ……………………88Hz 4 HP TONE CTRL (headphone tone control) Use this feature to adjust the level of the bass and treble when you use your headphones. Control range (dB): –6 to +3 for both BASS and TRBL (treble) Initial setting: 0 dB for both BASS and TRBL (treble) 4 Adjust the volume of the subwoofer with the controls on the subwoofer so it matches that of the speaker you are comparing it to. 4 HP TONE CTRL ≥ BASS TRBL + - 0dB ■ About the test tone The test tone is produced by the tone generator. The tone generator produces a narrow-band noise centered on a specified frequency by the band pass filter besides a wide-band noise. You can change this center frequency from 35 Hz through 250 Hz in one-sixth octave steps. You can use the test tone not only for adjusting the subwoofer level, but also for checking the low-frequency characteristics of your listening room. Low-frequency sounds are especially affected by the listener’s position, speaker placement, subwoofer polarity and other conditions. Digital generator (wide band noise produced) 5 CENTER GEQ (center graphic equalizer) Use this feature to adjust the built-in 5-band graphic equalizer so that the center speaker tonal quality matches that of the left and right main speakers. You can select the 100 Hz, 300 Hz, 1 kHz, 3 kHz, or 10 kHz frequencies. Control range (dB): –6 to +6 Initial setting: 0 dB for 5-band 1 Noise 5 CENTER GEQ ≥ 100Hz 300Hz 1kHz 3kHz 10kHz Freq. Center freq. Press n to select a higher frequency and k to select a lower frequency. - 35 Hz – 250 Hz 2 Band pass filter Control range: 10 steps for L/R Initial setting: 0 dB for L/R Press + to decrease the output level for the left main speaker. Press – for the right main speaker. 3 L/R BALANCE Press –/+ to adjust the level of that frequency. 5 CENTER GEQ - + • You can monitor the center speaker sound while adjusting this item by using the test tone. Press TEST before starting the foregoing procedure. “TEST DOLBY SUR.” appears on the video monitor, and the test tone starts alternating among the speakers. Once you begin this procedure, the test tone remains at the center speaker and you can hear how the sound changes as you adjust the various frequency levels. To stop the test tone, press TEST (see pages 25 and 26). -/+ : Adjust / : Exit 62 62 +3dB y L …………………… ……………………R 0 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) + 100Hz ≥ 300Hz 1kHz 3kHz 10kHz 3 L/R BALANCE (balance of the left and right main speakers) Use this feature to adjust the balance of the output level from the left and right main speakers. 0dB 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU 6 INPUT RENAME 1 Press an input selector button to select the input you want to change the name of. 6 INPUT RENAME DVD ≥ DVD -/+ : Position / : Character Press –/+ to place the _ (under-bar) under the space or the character you want to edit. 6 INPUT RENAME DVD ≥ DVD ■ 7A CMPNT-V INPUT for COMPONENT VIDEO INPUT jacks [A] and [B] Choices: -/+ : Position / : Character 7A CMPNT-V INPUT ≥ [A]…………… DVD [B]……………CBL/SAT 3 6 INPUT RENAME DVD ≥ DVD1 Choices: (1) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/ SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD (2) CD-R, CD, PHONO, V-AUX, VCR 2/ DVR, VCR 1, CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/TAPE Initial settings: (1) MD/TAPE (2) CD-R 7B OPTICAL OUT ≥ (1)……………MD/TAPE (2)…………… CD-R Note • You can use up to 8 characters to rename the inputs. 4 ADDITIONAL INFORMATION -/+ : Position / : Character ■ 7B OPTICAL OUT for OPTICAL OUTPUT jacks (1) and (2) ADVANCED OPERATION Press k / n to select the character you want to use and –/+ to move to the next one. • Press n to change the character in the following order, or press k to go in the reverse order. A to Z, a space, 0 to 9, a space, a to z, a space, #, *, +, and so on. • Follow the foregoing procedure to rename other inputs. BASIC OPERATION [A] DVD, V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD [B] CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1 Initial settings: [A] DVD [B] CBL/SAT PREPARATION 2 It is possible to assign jacks according to the component to be used if this unit’s COMPONENT VIDEO input jack or DIGITAL INPUT/OUTPUT jack settings (component names for jacks) differ from that component. This makes it possible to change the jack assignment and effectively connect more component. Once you assign, you can select that component with INPUT (the input selector buttons on the remote control). INTRODUCTION Use this feature to change the name of the input which appears on the OSD or the front panel display. 7 I/O ASSIGNMENT Press + repeatedly to exit from INPUT RENAME. APPENDIX English 63 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 63 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU ■ 7C OPTICAL IN for OPTICAL INPUT jacks (3) to (6) Choices: (3) CD, PHONO, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/ TAPE, CD-R (4) CD-R, CD, PHONO, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/TAPE (5) DVD, MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/ SAT, D-TV/LD (6) CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/ TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, VCR 2/ DVR, VCR 1 Initial settings: (3) CD (4) CD-R (5) DVD (6) CBL/SAT 7C OPTICAL IN (3)…………… CD (4)…………… CD-R ≥ (5)…………… DVD (6)……………CBL/SAT 8 INPUT MODE (initial input mode) Use this feature to designate the input mode for sources connected to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks when you turn on this unit (see page 29 for details about the input mode). 8 INPUT MODE AUTO LAST -/+ : Select / : Exit Choices: AUTO, LAST Initial setting: AUTO AUTO Select this to allow this unit to automatically detect the type of input signal and select the appropriate input mode. LAST Select this to set this unit to automatically select the last input mode used for that source. Note ■ 7D COAXIAL IN for COAXIAL INPUT jacks (7) and (8) • Even if LAST is selected, the last setting for the EX/ES button will not be recalled. Choices: (7) CD, PHONO, V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/SAT, D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/TAPE, CD-R (8) D-TV/LD, DVD, MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, V-AUX, VCR 2/DVR, VCR 1, CBL/SAT Initial settings: (7) CD (8) D-TV/LD 7D COAXIAL IN (7)…………… CD ≥ (8)……………D-TV/LD Note • You cannot select an item more than once for the same type of jack. 64 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 64 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU 9 PARAM. INI (parameter initialization) 2 Press –/+ to adjust the LFE level. Press the corresponding numeric button for the DSP program that you want to initialize. The asterisk (*) next to the program number means that the parameter values have been changed. INTRODUCTION 10 LFE LEVEL Use this feature to initialize the parameters for each DSP program within a DSP program group. When you initialize a DSP program group, all of the parameter values within that group revert to their initial settings. ≥ SPEAKER…………-11dB HEADPHONE…………0dB Note 9 PARAM. INI 1 2 3 *4 *5 6 7 8 9 *10 Press 11 D-RANGE (dynamic range) 11 No. Key • You cannot initialize the individual DSP programs within a group separately. • When “14 MEMORY GUARD” is set to ON (see page 67), you cannot initialize any program groups. • Once you initialize a DSP program group, you cannot automatically revert to the previous parameter settings. BASIC OPERATION Notes Use this feature to adjust the dynamic range. This setting is effective only when this unit decodes Dolby Digital signals. 11 D-RANGE ≥ SP: MAX STD MIN HP: MAX STD MIN This setting is effective only when this unit decodes Dolby Digital or DTS signals. MAX Select the “MAX” setting for feature films. Use this feature to adjust the output level of the LFE (low-frequency effect) channel when playing back a Dolby Digital or DTS signal. The LFE signal carries the low-frequency special effect sound which is only added to certain scenes. STD Select the “STD” (Standard) setting for general use. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MIN Select the “MIN” setting for listening to sources at extremely low volume levels. Control range (dB): –20 to 0 for both SPEAKER and HEADPHONE Initial setting: 0 dB for both SPEAKER and HEADPHONE 1 ADVANCED OPERATION Choices: MAX, STD, MIN Initial setting: MAX (for both speakers and headphones) 10 LFE LEVEL PREPARATION • Adjust the LFE level according to the capacity of your subwoofer or headphones. Press k / n to select the item to be adjusted. APPENDIX 10 LFE LEVEL ≥ SPEAKER………………0dB HEADPHONE…………0dB English 65 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 65 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU ■ Setting by “msec” 12 SP DELAY Control range: Use this feature to adjust the delay of the Center and the Rear Center channel sounds. This feature works when there is sound output from the center speakers with a source like Dolby Digital or DTS, etc. Ideally, the Center speaker and the Rear Center speaker should be the same distance from the main listening position as the left and right Main speakers. However, in most home situations, the Center speaker or the Rear Center speaker is placed in line with the Main speakers or the Rear speakers. By delaying the sound from the Center speaker and the Rear Center speaker, the apparent distance from the Center speaker and the Rear Center speaker to the main listening position can be adjusted to make it seem the same as the distance between the left and right Main speaker, and the left and right Rear speakers to the listening position. Adjusting the delay time for the Center speaker is especially important for giving depth to the dialogue. 1 2 Press –/+ to select the unit to be used for setting. Select one from “msec”, “meters”, and “feet”. ■ Setting by “meters” Control range: Initial settings: 12 SP DELAY ■ Setting by “feet” Initial settings: Press k / n to select the speaker for which the delay is adjusted. 12 SP DELAY 0.5 to 100 ft (for main L/R, center, rear L/R, rear center) 10.0 ft (for main L/R, center, rear L/ R), 7.0 ft (for rear center) 12 SP DELAY ≥ UNIT……………………feet MAIN L/R……10.0ft CENTER…………10.0ft REAR L/R……10.0ft REAR CT…………7.0ft Press –/+ to set the delay. Press + for higher value and – for lower value. ≥ UNIT……………………msec CENTER……………0.0ms REAR CT…………3.0ms 0.15 to 30.00 m (for main L/R, center, rear L/R, rear center) 3.00 m (for main L/R, center, rear L/ R), 2.10 m (for rear center) ≥ UNIT………………meters MAIN L/R………3.00m CENTER……………3.00m REAR L/R………3.00m REAR CT…………2.10m Control range: • Setting items change depending on the unit chosen. • When “meters” or “feet” is selected, enter the distance from your listening position to each speaker. 4 12 SP DELAY ≥ UNIT……………………msec CENTER……………0.0ms REAR CT…………3.0ms Press k / n to select “UNIT”. Notes 3 Initial settings: 0 to 5.0 ms (for center), 0 to 30.0 ms (for rear center) 0 ms (for center), 3.0 ms (for rear center) Note • No delay will be set if the same distance is set for the main L/R and center, or the rear L/R and rear center with “meters” or “feet” selected. Center speaker image C L RL C R RC RR RC 66 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 66 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU 13 DISPLAY SET 14 MEMORY GUARD ≥ DIMMER………………………0 OSD SHIFT………………0 GRAY BACK………AUTO V CONV.………………OFF Use this feature to prevent accidental changes to DSP program parameter values and other settings on this unit. Choices: ON, OFF Initial setting: OFF 14 MEMORY GUARD ■ DIMMER OFF You can adjust the brightness of the front panel display. ON -/+ : Select / : Exit This setting is used to adjust the vertical position of the OSD. Press + to lower the position of the OSD. Press – to raise the position of the OSD. ■ GRAY BACK Notes • When “14 MEMORY GUARD” is set to ON, you cannot use the test tone. • When “14 MEMORY GUARD” is set to ON, you cannot select any other SET MENU items. ADVANCED OPERATION Selecting AUTO for the on-screen display setting displays a gray background when there’s no video signal input. Nothing is displayed on the screen including the onscreen display if OFF is selected. BASIC OPERATION Control range: +5 (downward) to –5 (upward) Initial setting: 0 Select ON to protect the following features: • DSP program parameters • All SET MENU items • Center, rear speakers, rear center, and subwoofer levels • The on-screen display (OSD) mode PREPARATION Control range: –4 to 0 Initial setting: 0 ■ OSD SHIFT (OSD off-set position) INTRODUCTION 13 DISPLAY SET Choices: AUTO, OFF Initial setting: AUTO Note • If “GRAY BACK” is set to OFF, no information will be displayed on the screen when video signals are not being input. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION ■ V CONV. (Video conversion) Use this feature to turn on/off the function to convert composite signals to S-video signals to output through the S-video jack when no S-video signals are input. Choices: ON, OFF Initial setting: OFF APPENDIX OFF Select this not to convert composite signals to S-video signals. ON Select this to convert composite signals to S-video signals. English 67 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 67 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SET MENU 15 6CH INPUT SET Use this feature to set the direction of the signals input into the center and subwoofer channels when the source component is connected to the 6CH INPUT jacks. 16 ZONE2 SET (U.S.A., Canada and Australia models only) Use this feature to make a setting for audio output to ZONE 2 OUT. ■ 15A CENTER to (direction of the center channel signals) 16 ZONE2 SET ≥ ZONE2 OUT…………VAR ZONE2 SP OUT…OFF This item sets the direction of the signals input into the CENTER jack. Choices: CENTER, MAIN Initial setting: CENTER 15A CENTER to CENTER MAIN CENTER The input signals are output from the center speaker. MAIN The input signals are directed to the main L/R speakers with same level. ■ OUTPUT VOL (output volume) This item changes the volume control setting for audio output to ZONE 2 OUT. Choices: VAR., FIX Initial setting: VAR. VAR. To adjust the ZONE 2 OUT volume with VOL +/– on the remote control. FIX To fix the ZONE 2 OUT volume to the volume level of this unit. ■ 15B SWFR to (direction of the signals input into the subwoofer) ■ SP OUT This item sets the direction of the signals input into the SUBWOOFER jack. Use this feature to switch assignment of the center and rear center speakers’ ouput destination. Choices: SWFR, MAIN Initial setting: SWFR Choices: OFF, ON Initial setting: OFF 15B SWFR to SWFR MAIN SWFR The input signals are output from the subwoofer. MAIN The input signals are directed to the main L/R speakers with same level. ON To assign the amplifier outputs for the center and rear center channels to the ZONE 2 OUT SPEAKERS terminals. OFF To assign the amplifier outputs for the center and rear center channels to CENTER and REAR CENTER speaker terminals as normal operation. y • When SP OUT is set to ON, 1A CENTER SP and 1D REAR CT SP will be automatically set to NONE. When it is switched to OFF, 1A CENTER SP and 1D REAR CT SP will be set to the previous setting. Note • When SP OUT is set to ON, it is not necessary to connect ZONE 2 OUT jacks. 68 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 68 02.8.9, 10:38 AM ADJUSTING THE LEVEL OF THE EFFECT SPEAKERS Adjustment should be made with the remote control. A/B/C/D/E MUTE VOLUME CH STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT PARAMETER ON SCREEN LEVEL SLEEP TEST SET MENU 1 Notes 1 Set PARAMETER/SET MENU to PARAMETER. PARAMETER SET MENU Press LEVEL repeatedly to select the speaker(s) you want to adjust. Each time you press LEVEL, the selected speaker changes and appears on the front panel display and on the video monitor as follows: center, right rear, rear center left rear and subwoofer. BASIC OPERATION 2 • When you adjust the output level with LEVEL, the settings you made with the test tone will be changed. • When PARAMETER/SET MENU is set to SET MENU, you cannot adjust the output level by using LEVEL. However, each time you press LEVEL, the current level of each speaker appears on the front panel display and you can check the speaker level. • When the speaker output modes for “1A CENTER SP” and “1C REAR L/R SP” are set to NONE, and “1E LFE/BASS OUT” to MAIN, the output level of those speakers cannot be adjusted because there is no sound coming from these speakers. • During playback of the source input through the 6CH INPUT jacks, the level can be adjusted independently for the center, right and left rear, and subwoofer. PREPARATION 2 3 Press –/+ to adjust the speaker output level. • The control range for the center, left and right rear or rear center speakers is from +10 dB to –10 dB. • The control range for the subwoofer is from 0 dB to –20 dB. PRESET TV INPUT TV VOL 3 INTRODUCTION You can adjust the output level of each effect speaker (center, left and right rear, rear center and subwoofer) while listening to a music source. LEVEL ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Right rear speaker output level ADVANCED OPERATION Center speaker output level Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode. However if the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet, or the power supply is cut for more than one week, the stored data will be lost. If so, set the output level again. Rear center speaker output level Left rear speaker output level Subwoofer output level APPENDIX y • Once you press LEVEL, you can also select the speaker(s) to be adjusted by pressing n/k. English 69 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 69 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SLEEP TIMER Use this feature to automatically set this unit in the standby mode after the amount of time you have set. The sleep timer is useful when you are going to sleep while this unit is playing or recording a source. The sleep timer also automatically turns off the external components connected to AC OUTLET(S). Canceling the Sleep Timer Press SLEEP repeatedly until “SLEEP OFF” appears on the front panel display. After a few seconds, “SLEEP OFF” disappears, the “SLEEP” indicator goes off and the display returns to the previous indication. The sleep timer can only be set with the remote control. y SLEEP • By connecting a commercially available timer to this unit, you can also set a wake-up timer. Refer to the operation instructions of the timer. • The sleep timer setting can also be canceled by setting this unit in the standby mode by using STANDBY on the remote control (or STANDBY/ON on the front panel) or by disconnecting the AC power cord from the AC outlet. Setting the Sleep Timer 10KEY DSP EX/ES HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 6 7 5 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 CHP/INDEX A/B/C/D/E /DTS SUR. y 8 SELECT PRESET TV INPUT MUTE VOLUME CH TV VOL STEREO TV MUTE DISC EFFECT PARAMETER ON SCREEN LEVEL SLEEP TEST SET MENU 2 1 Select a source and start playback on the source component. 2 Press SLEEP repeatedly to set the amount of time. Each time you press SLEEP, the front panel display changes as shown below. The SLEEP indicator flashes while switching the amount of time for sleep timer. SLEEP 120 min. SLEEP OFF V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT SLEEP 90 min. SLEEP 30 min. D TV/LD DVD SLEEP MD/TAPE CD R SLEEP 60 min. TUNER CD PHONO SLEEP VOLUME DSP DIGITAL SLEEP SP A 120min L R The “SLEEP” indicator soon lights up on the front panel display after the sleep timer has been set. The display then returns to the previous indication. V AUX VCR2/DVR VCR 1 CBL/SAT D TV/LD DVD MD/TAPE CD R TUNER CD PHONO SLEEP VOLUME DSP DIGITAL SP A CONCERT HALL1 L R 70 0109V2300_57-70_EN(U) 70 02.8.9, 10:38 AM ZONE 2 (for U.S.A., Canada and Australia models) Only analog signals are sent to the second room. For any source you want to listen to in the second room, you must connect the analog output jack from the source to the corresponding analog input jack on this unit. Zone 2 Connections PREPARATION To use the multi-room functions of this unit, you need the following additional equipment: • An infrared signal receiver in the second room • An infrared emitter in the main room This emitter transmits the infrared signals from the remote control in the second room to the main room (for example, to a CD player or LD player). • An amplifier and speakers for the second room • A video monitor for the second room INTRODUCTION You can make up a multi-room audio-video system with this unit. This feature enables you to set this unit to reproduce separate input sources in the main room and second room (Zone 2) with the supplied remote control in the second room. y IN OUT This unit • Since there are so many ways to connect and use this unit in a multi-room installation, we recommend that you consult with the nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center for the Zone 2 connections which will best meet your requirements. • Some YAMAHA models are able to connect directly to the REMOTE CONTROL OUT jack of this unit. If you own these products, you may not need to use an infrared emitter. Up to 6 YAMAHA components can be connected as shown. ADVANCED OPERATION ■ Example of a system configuration and connections ZONE 2 VIDEO OUT ZONE 2 AUDIO OUT Main room Second room Amplifier This unit Video monitor ADDITIONAL INFORMATION DVD player (or other component) Remote control DVD INPUT Infrared signal receiver Infrared emitter REMOTE CONTROL IN Notes • When not using the main room, turn down the volume of this unit in the main room. Adjust the Zone 2 volume with the control on the amplifier in the second room. • DO NOT USE the Zone 2 feature for CDs encoded with DTS to avoid unexpected noise. APPENDIX REMOTE CONTROL OUT BASIC OPERAIONT IN OUT REMOTE CONTROL OUT English 71 0110V2300_71-72_EN(U) 71 02.8.9, 10:38 AM ZONE 2 ■ Special considerations when using DTS software 5 Press SOURCE SELECT k to display “Zone2” in the display window. The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Therefore, if you attempt to send the DTS signal to the second room, you will only be able to hear the digital noise sound that could damage your speakers. SOURCE Due to this characteristic of DTS encoded discs, the following considerations and adjustments need to be made. For LDs or DVDs encoded with DTS Only 2-channel analog audio signals may be sent to the second room, as follows: • LDs Set your LD player’s left and right outputs to the analog soundtrack. • DVDs Use the disc menu to set the DVD player’s mixed 2channel left and right audio outputs to the PCM or Dolby Digital soundtrack. For CDs encoded with DTS DO NOT USE the Zone 2 feature for CDs encoded with DTS to avoid unexpected noise. SELECT 6 Press an input selector button to select the input source you want to listen to in the second room. The display window shows “2: name of selected input” if the remote control is in the Zone 2 mode. PHONO 7 V-AUX TUNER MD/TAPE CD-R CD D-TV/LD CBL/SAT VCR 1 VCR2/DVR DVD You can control the component by using the component control area buttons. 6CH INPUT TITLE ENTER SOURCE Remote Control in Zone 2 POWER In the second room (Zone 2), the supplied remote control can be used for the Zone 2 remote control. You can select the input source and control the component which is located in the main room directly from the second room regardless of the listening condition in the main room. 10KEY DSP EX/ES REC HALL 1 PAUSE PLAY HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 A/B/C/D/E Press l / h to select “L:AMP”. Press k / n to select “Zone2”. VOLUME STEREO DISC EFFECT Note • Adjust the Zone 2 volume with the control on the amplifier in the second room. 8 Press SOURCE SELECT k / n to exit from the Zone 2 mode. SOURCE SELECT ENTER 4 Press LEARN to complete the Zone 2 setup. LEARN 72 0110V2300_71-72_EN(U) 72 8 SELECT MUTE CH ENTER 3 /DTS SUR. PRESET TV MUTE 2 + STOP TV INPUT Repeat steps 1 and 2 of the procedure in “Setting the Manufacturer Code” on page 44. CHAPTER ROCK CONCERT TV VOL 1 – SEARCH CHP/INDEX Before starting the following procedure, set REC OUT/ ZONE 2 on the front panel to SOURCE/REMOTE. SOUND MENU DISPLAY SELECT 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SOUND FIELD PROGRAM PARAMETER EDITING What really creates the rich, full tones of a live instrument are the multiple reflections from the walls of the room. In addition to making the sound “live”, these reflections enable us to tell where the player is situated, and the size and shape of the room in which we are sitting. In any environment, in addition to the direct sound coming straight to our ears from the player’s instrument, there are two distinct types of sound reflections that combine to make up the sound field: Direct sound, early reflections and subsequent reverberation taken together help us to determine the subjective size and shape of the room, and it is this information that the digital sound field processor reproduces in order to create sound fields. See “DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS” on pages 75 to 78. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION If you could create the appropriate early reflections and subsequent reverberations in your listening room, you would be able to create your own listening environment. The acoustics in your room could be changed to those of a concert hall, a dance floor, or virtually any size room at all. This ability to create sound fields at will is exactly what YAMAHA has done with the digital sound field processor. ADVANCED OPERATION Reverberations These are caused by reflections from more than one surface — walls, ceiling, the back of the room — so numerous that they merge together to form a continuous sonic “afterglow”. They are non-directional, and lessen the clarity of the direct sound. Each DSP program has a set of parameters that allow you to change the characteristics of the acoustic environment to precisely create the effect you want. These parameters correspond to the many natural acoustic factors that create the sound field you experience in an actual concert hall or other listening environment. The size of the room, for example, affects the length of time between the early reflections. The “ROOM SIZE” parameter provided in many of the DSP programs alters the timing between these reflections, thus changing the shape of the “room” you are listening. In addition to room size, the shape of the room and the characteristics of its surfaces have a significant effect on the final sound. Surfaces that absorb sound, for example, cause the reflections and reverberations to die out more quickly, while highly reflective surfaces allow the reflections to carry on for a longer period of time. The digital sound field parameters allow you to control these and many other factors that contribute to your personal sound field, allowing you to essentially “redesign” the concert halls, theaters, etc. provided to create custom-tailored listening environments that ideally match your mood and music. BASIC OPERATION Early reflections Reflected sounds reach our ears extremely rapidly (50 ms – 100 ms after the direct sound), after reflecting from one surface only — for example, from the ceiling or a wall. Early reflections actually add clarity to the direct sound. DSP programs consist of some parameters to determine the apparent room size, reverberation time, distance from you to the performer, etc. In each program, these parameters are set with values precisely calculated by YAMAHA to create a sound field unique to the program. It is recommended to use DSP programs without changing the values of parameters; however, this unit also allows you to create your own sound fields. Starting with one of the built-in programs, you can adjust those parameters. PREPARATION ■ Elements of a sound field Sound Field Program Parameters INTRODUCTION What Is a Sound Field? APPENDIX English 73 0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 73 02.8.9, 10:38 AM SOUND FIELD PROGRAM PARAMETER EDITING Changing Parameter Settings You can enjoy good quality sound with the factory-set parameters. Although you do not have to change the initial settings, you can change some of the parameters to better suit the input source or your listening room. 3 10KEY DSP EX/ES HALL 1 HALL 2 2 3 4 ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 6 7 5 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 A/B/C/D/E TV INPUT Repeat steps 3 to 5 above as necessary to change other program parameters. MUTE VOLUME EFFECT PARAMETER TEST 6 SELECT STEREO DISC LEVEL Press –/+ to change the parameter value. When you set the parameter to a value other than the factoryset value, an asterisk mark (*) appears by the parameter name on the video monitor. 8 /DTS SUR. CH TV MUTE SLEEP 5 PRESET TV VOL ON SCREEN Press k / n to select the parameter. JAZZ CLUB 1 ROCK CONCERT CHP/INDEX 4 2 5 CHURCH 4 SET MENU 1 Notes 1 2 3 Set PARAMETER/SET MENU to PARAMETER. PARAMETER SET MENU Turn on the video monitor and press ON SCREEN repeatedly to select the full display mode. ON SCREEN Select a DSP program you want to adjust. 10KEY DSP HALL 1 HALL 2 CHURCH JAZZ CLUB 1 2 3 4 ROCK CONCERT ENTERTAINMENT MUSIC VIDEO TV THEATER 5 6 7 MOVIE THEATER 1 MOVIE THEATER 2 9 10 11 12 0 +10 +100 Program No. /DTS SUR. 8 SELECT Program name P05 ROCK CONCERT Cursor DSP LEVEL…………0dB ≥ INIT.DLY…………15ms ROOM SIZE…………1.0 LIVENESS…………………5 REV.TIME…………1.6s REV.DELAY……120ms Parameters Parameter valves Example of the parameter setting display • The available parameters may be displayed on more than one OSD page for some of the programs. To scroll through pages, press k / n. • You cannot change parameter values when “14 MEMORY GUARD” on the SET MENU is set to ON. If you want to change the parameter values, set “14 MEMORY GUARD” to OFF (see page 67). Memory back-up The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data from being lost even if this unit is set in the standby mode, the power cord is disconnected from the AC outlet, or the power supply is temporarily cut due to power failure. However, if the power is cut for more than one week, the parameter value you edited will return to the factory setting. If so, edit the parameter value again. Resetting a Parameter to the Factory-set Value ■ To reset some of the parameters to the factory-set values Select the parameter you want to reset. Then press and hold –/+ until the value temporarily stops at the factoryset value. The asterisk mark (*) by the parameter name disappears on the video monitor. ■ To reset all of the parameters to the factory-set values Use “9 PARAM. INI” on the SET MENU to reset all of the parameter values of all DSP programs within the selected group to the factory-set values (see page 65). This operation resets all of the parameter values of all DSP programs within that group to the factory-set values. 74 0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 74 02.8.9, 10:38 AM DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS ■ DSP LEVEL Function: Description: Control Range –6 dB – +3 dB This parameter adjusts the level of all the DSP effect sounds within a narrow range. Depending on the acoustics of you listening room, you may want to increase or decrease the DSP effect level relative to the direct sound. Function: Description: Control Range 1 – 99 msec This parameter changes the apparent distance from the source sound by adjusting the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection heard by the listener. The smaller the value, the closer the sound source seems to the listener. The larger the value, the farther the apparent distance seems. For a small room, this parameter would be set to a small value, and for a large room, it would be set to a large value. PREPARATION ■ INIT. DLY (Initial Delay) [P. INT. DLY for the presence sound field] INTRODUCTION You can adjust the values of certain digital sound field parameters so the sound fields are recreated accurately in your listening room. Not all of the following parameters are found in every program. Source Sound BASIC OPERATION Level Level Level Early Reflections Time Time INIT.DLY Time INIT.DLY INIT.DLY Sound Source ADVANCED OPERATION Reflection Face Small value = 1 ms Large value = 99 ms ■ ROOM SIZE [P. ROOM SIZE for the presence sound field] Description: This parameter adjusts the apparent size of the surround sound field. The larger the value, the larger the surround sound field becomes. As the sound is repeatedly reflected around a room, the larger the hall is, the longer the time between the original reflected sound and the subsequent reflections. By controlling the time between the reflected sounds, you can change the apparent size of the virtual venue. Changing this parameter from one to two, doubles the apparent length of the room. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Function: Control Range 0.1 – 2.0 Time Level Level Time Early Reflections APPENDIX Level Source Sound Time Sound Source English Small value = 0.1 Large value = 2.0 75 0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 75 02.8.9, 10:38 AM DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS ■ LIVENESS Function: Description: Control Range 0 – 10 This parameter adjusts the reflectivity of the virtual walls in the hall by changing the rate at which the early reflections decay. The early reflections of a sound source decay much faster in a room with acoustically absorbent wall surfaces than in one which has highly reflective surfaces. A room with acoustically absorbent surfaces is referred to as “dead”, while a room with highly reflective surfaces is referred to as “live”. The LIVENESS parameter lets you adjust the early reflection decay rate, and thus the “liveness” of the room. Source Sound Level Dead Level Level Live Time Time Time Sound Source Small Reflected Sound Large Reflected Sound Small value = 0 ■ S. DELAY (Surround Delay) Function: Large value = 10 Control Range 0 – 49 msec (The range depends on the signal format.) This parameter adjusts the delay for surround signals and surround sound field. ■ S. INIT. DLY (Surround Initial Delay) Function: This parameter adjusts the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection on the surround side of the sound field. You can only adjust this parameter when at least two front channels and two rear channels are used. ■ S. ROOM SIZE (Surround Room Size) Function: Control Range 1 – 49 msec Control Range 0.1 – 2.0 This parameter adjusts the apparent size of the surround sound field. ■ S. LIVENESS (Surround Liveness) Function: This parameter adjusts the apparent reflectivity of the virtual walls in the surround sound field. ■ RC INIT. DLY (Rear Center Initial Delay) Function: Control Range 0.1 – 2.0 This parameter adjusts the apparent size of the rear center sound field. ■ RC LIVENESS (Rear Center Liveness) Function: Control Range 1 – 49 msec This parameter adjusts the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection in the rear center sound field. ■ RC ROOM SIZE (Rear Center Room Size) Function: Control Range 0 –10 Control Range 0 – 10 This parameter adjusts the apparent reflectivity of the virtual wall in the rear center sound field. 76 0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 76 02.8.9, 10:38 AM DIGITAL SOUND SOUND FIELD FIELD PROGRAM PARAMETER PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS EDITING ■ REV. TIME (Reverberation Time) Function: This parameter adjusts the amount of time it takes for the dense, subsequent reverberation sound to decay by 60 dB (at 1 kHz). This changes the apparent size of the acoustic environment over an extremely wide range. Set a longer reverberation time for “dead” sources and listening room environments, and a shorter time for “live” sources and listening room environments. Reverberation Source Sound Reverberation Early Reflections 60 dB 60 dB 60 dB REV. TIME REV. TIME Long Reverberation Short Reverberation Large value = 5.0 s ■ REV. DELAY (Reverberation Delay) This parameter adjusts the time difference between the beginning of the direct sound and the beginning of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the later the reverberation sound begins. A later reverberation sound makes you feel like you are in a larger acoustic environment. ADVANCED OPERATION Level Description: Control Range 0 – 250 msec BASIC OPERATION Small value = 1.0 s Function: PREPARATION REV. TIME Sound Source INTRODUCTION Description: Control Range 1.0 – 5.0 sec Source Sound (dB) 60 dB Reverberation Time REV. TIME ■ REV. LEVEL (Reverberation Level) Control Range 0 – 100 % This parameter adjusts the volume of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the stronger the reverberation becomes. Source Sound APPENDIX Level Function: Description: ADDITIONAL INFORMATION REV. DELAY REV. LEVEL English Time 77 0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 77 02.8.9, 10:38 AM DIGITAL SOUND FIELD PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS For 6ch Stereo ■ CT LEVEL (Center Level) Function: These parameters adjust the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode. ■ RL LEVEL (Rear Left Level) Function: Music ■ PANORAMA Control Range OFF/ON Extends the front stereo image to include the surround speakers for wraparound effect. ■ DIMENSION Function: Control Range –3 – STD – +3 Gradually adjusts the soundfield either towards the front or towards the rear. ■ CT WIDTH (Center Width) Function: Control Range 0 – 100 % These parameters adjust the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode. For PRO LOGIC Function: Control Range 0 – 100 % These parameters adjust the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode. ■ RC LEVEL (Rear Center Level) Function: Control Range 0 – 100 % These parameters adjust the volume level for each channel in 6-channel stereo mode. ■ RR LEVEL (Rear Right Level) Function: Control Range 0 – 100 % Control Range 0 – 7 Adjusts the center image from all three front speakers to varying degrees. For DTS Neo: 6 Music ■ C. IMAGE (Center Image) Function: Control Range 0 – 0.5 This parameter adjusts the center image from all three front speakers to varying degrees. 78 0111V2300_73-78_EN(U) 78 02.8.9, 10:38 AM TROUBLESHOOTING ■ General Problem Set the switch fully to the left or right position when this unit is in the standby mode. The protection circuitry has been activated. Make sure all speaker wire connections on this unit and on all speakers are secure and that the wire for each connection does not touch anything other than its respective connection. This unit has been exposed to a strong external electric shock (such as lightning and strong static electricity). Set this unit in the standby mode, disconnect the power cord, plug it back in after 30 seconds, and start operating. The setting for the on-screen display is set to “DISPLAY OFF”. Select the full display or short display mode (see page 23). The GRAY BACK setting under “13 DISPLAY SET” on the SET MENU is set to OFF, and no video signal is input to this unit. Set GRAY BACK to AUTO to always show the OSD (see page 67). Incorrect input or output cable connections. Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. An appropriate input source has not been selected. Select an appropriate input source with INPUT or 6CH (INPUT) (or the input selector buttons) (see page 27). The speaker connections are not secure. Secure the connections (see page 11). The main speakers to be used have not been selected properly. Select the main speakers with SPEAKERS A and/or B (see page 27). The volume is turned down. Turn up the volume. The sound is muted. Press MUTE or any operation buttons of this unit to cancel a mute and adjust the volume (see page 28). The signals that this unit cannot reproduce such as a CD-ROM are being input. Play a source whose signals this unit can reproduce. The output and input for the picture are connected to different types of video jacks. Make connections using the same type of jack (between S VIDEO, VIDEO (composite), or COMPONENT VIDEO jacks) for both the input and output. APPENDIX The IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch on the rear panel is not fully set to the left or right position. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Firmly connect the power cord. ADVANCED OPERATION No sound and/or no picture. The power cord is not connected or the plug is not completely inserted. BASIC OPERAIONT On-screen display does not appear. Remedy PREPARATION This unit fails to turn on when STANDBY/ ON (or SYSTEM POWER) is pressed, or enters in the standby mode soon after the power has been turned on. Cause INTRODUCTION Refer to the chart below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below or if the instruction below does not help, set this unit in the standby mode, disconnect the power cord, and contact the nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center. English 79 0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 79 02.8.9, 10:39 AM TROUBLESHOOTING Problem Cause The sound suddenly goes off. The protection circuit has been activated because of a short circuit, etc. Remedy Check the IMPEDANCE SELECTOR switch is set to the appropriate position and then turn this unit back on. Check the speaker wires are not touching each other and then turn this unit back on. Only the speaker on one side can be heard. No sound from the effect speakers. The sleep timer has functioned. Turn on the power, and play the source again. The sound is muted. Press MUTE or any operation buttons of this unit to cancel a mute and adjust the volume (see page 28). Incorrect cable connections. Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. Incorrect setting of “3 L/R BALANCE” on the SET MENU. Adjust it to the appropriate position. The sound effect is off. Press STEREO/EFFECT to turn it on (see page 32). The source encoded with a Dolby Digital or DTS signal does not have a center, rear L/R or rear center channel signals. A 96-kHz sampling digital signal is being input to this unit. No sound from the center speaker. No sound from the rear speakers. No sound from the rear center speaker. No sound from the subwoofer. The output level of the center speaker is set to minimum. Raise the level of the center speaker (see pages 25, 26). “1A CENTER SP” on the SET MENU is set to NONE. Select the appropriate mode for your center speaker (see page 58). One of the Hi-Fi DSP programs (1 to 6 except for Game and 6ch Stereo) has been selected. Select another DSP program. The output level of the rear speakers is set to minimum. Raise the output level of the rear speakers (see pages 25, 26). “1C REAR L/R SP” on the SET MENU is set to NONE. Select the appropriate speaker mode for the rear L/R speakers (see page 59). A monaural source is being played with the program 10. Select another DSP program. “1C REAR L/R SP” on the SET MENU is set to NONE. If the speaker mode for the rear L/R speakers is set to NONE, the speaker mode for the rear center speaker is automatically set to NONE. Select the appropriate speaker mode for the rear L/R speaker mode (see page 59). “1D REAR CT SP” on the SET MENU is set to NONE. Select LRG or SML (see page 60). “1E LFE/BASS OUT” on the SET MENU is set to MAIN when a Dolby Digital or DTS signal is being played. Select SWFR or BOTH (see page 60). “1E LFE/BASS OUT” on the SET MENU is set to SWFR or MAIN when a 2-channel source is being played. Select BOTH (see page 60). The source does not contain low bass signals (90 Hz and below). 80 0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 80 02.8.9, 10:39 AM TROUBLESHOOTING Problem Cause Remedy “Digital output” and “Dolby Digital” or “DTS” are not selected on the connected components. Make an appropriate setting following the operation instructions for your component. Poor bass reproduction. “1E LFE/BASS OUT” on the SET MENU is set to SWFR or BOTH and your system does not include a subwoofer. Select MAIN (see page 60). The output mode for each speaker (main, center, rear, or rear center) on the SET MENU does not match your speaker configuration. Select the appropriate output mode for each speaker based on the size of the speakers in your configuration (see pages 58 – 61). Incorrect cable connections. Firmly connect the audio plugs. If the problem persists, the cables may be defective. No connection from the turntable to the GND terminal. Connect the grounding cord of your turntable to the GND terminal of this unit (see page 18). The volume level is low while playing a record. The record is being played on a turntable with an MC cartridge. The turntable should be connected to this unit through an MC-head amplifier (see page 17). The volume level cannot be increased, or the sound is distorted. The component connected to the OUT(REC) jacks of this unit is turned off. Turn on the power to the component. The sound effect cannot be recorded. It is not possible to record the sound effect by a recording component. A source cannot be recorded. A source component is connected to the analog input jacks of this unit for digital recording. Connect the source component to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks. Digital connections are not made between this unit and other components for playback or recording. Make digital connections. A source component is connected to the digital input jacks of this unit for analog recording. Connect a source component to the analog input jacks. Analog connections are not made between this unit and other components for playback or recording. Make analog connections. PREPARATION A “humming” sound can be heard. INTRODUCTION Dolby Digital or DTS sources cannot be played. (Dolby Digital or DTS indicator on the front panel display does not light up.) BASIC OPERAIONT ADVANCED OPERATION ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Some recording components cannot record the Dolby Digital or DTS sources. “14 MEMORY GUARD” on the SET MENU is set to ON. Select OFF (see page 67). This unit does not operate properly. The internal microcomputer has been frozen by an external electric shock (such as lightning or excessive static electricity) or by a power supply with low voltage. Disconnect the AC power cord from the outlet and then plug it in again after about 30 seconds. “CHECK SP WIRES” appears on the front panel display. Speaker cables are short circuited. Make sure all speaker cables are connected correctly. APPENDIX The sound field parameters and some other settings on this unit cannot be changed. English 81 0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 81 02.8.9, 10:39 AM TROUBLESHOOTING Problem Remedy Cause The sound is degraded when listening with headphones connected to a tape deck or CD player that is connected to this unit. This unit is in the standby mode. Turn on the power of this unit. There is noise interference from digital or high-frequency equipment, or this unit. This unit is too close to the digital or highfrequency equipment. Move this unit further away from such equipment. This unit suddenly turns into the standby mode. The internal temperature becomes too high and the overheat protection circuitry has been activated. Wait until this unit cools down and then turn it back on. ■ Tuner Problem FM/ AM FM AM Cause Remedy Previously preset stations can no longer be tuned in. This unit has been disconnected for a long period. Re-store the stations. FM stereo reception is noisy. The characteristics of FM stereo broadcasts may cause this problem when the transmitter is too far away or the antenna input is poor. Check the antenna connections. Try using a high-quality directional FM antenna. Use the manual tuning method. There is distortion, and clear reception cannot be obtained even with a good FM antenna. There is multipath interference. Adjust the antenna position to eliminate multipath interference. The desired station cannot be tuned in with the automatic tuning method. The station is too weak. Use the manual tuning method. Use a high-quality directional FM antenna. The desired station cannot be tuned in with the automatic tuning method. The signal is weak or the antenna connections are loose. Tighten the AM loop antenna connections and orient it for best reception. Use the manual tuning method. There are continuous crackling and hissing noises. Noises result from lightning, fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats and other electrical equipment. Use an outdoor antenna and a ground wire. This will help somewhat, but it is difficult to eliminate all noise. There are buzzing and whining noises (especially in the evening). A TV set is being used nearby. Move this unit away from the TV. 82 0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 82 02.8.9, 10:39 AM TROUBLESHOOTING ■ Remote control Problem Remedy The remote control will function within a maximum range of 6 m (20 feet) and no more than 30 degrees off-axis from the front panel (see page 7). Direct sunlight or lighting (from an inverter type of fluorescent lamp, etc.) is striking the remote control sensor of this unit. Reposition this unit. The batteries are weak. Replace the batteries. The manufacturer code has not been correctly set. Set the manufacturer code correctly (see pages 44, 45). Try to set the other codes of the same maufacturer (see pages 44, 45). The batteries of this remote control and/ or the other remote control are too weak. Replace the batteries (see page 3). The distance between the two remote controls is too much or too little. Place the remote controls at the proper distance (see page 45). The signal coding or modulation of the other remote control is not compatible with this remote control. Learning is not possible. Memory capacity is full. Further learning is not possible without deleting unnecessary functions (see page 46). ADVANCED OPERATION Program the necessary functions independently into the programmable buttons on this unit‘s remote control using the Learn feature. BASIC OPERAIONT The remote control does not “learn” new functions. Even if the maufacturer code is correctly set, there are some models that do not respond to the remote control. PREPARATION Wrong distance or angle. INTRODUCTION The remote control does not work nor function properly. Cause ADDITIONAL INFORMATION APPENDIX English 83 0112V2300_79-83_EN(U) 83 02.8.9, 10:39 AM GLOSSARY ■ Dolby Surround Dolby Surround uses a four analog channel recording system to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: two left and right main channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog (monaural), and a rear channel for special sound effects (monaural). The rear channel reproduces sound within a narrow frequency range. Dolby Surround is widely used with nearly all video tapes and laser discs, and in many TV and cable broadcasts as well. The Dolby Pro Logic decoder built into this unit employs a digital signal processing system that automatically stabilizes the volume on each channel to enhance moving sound effects and directionality. ■ DTS (Digital Theater Systems) Digital Surround DTS digital surround was developed to replace the analog soundtracks of movies with a six-channel digital sound track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie theaters around the world. Digital Theater Systems Inc. has developed a home theater system so that you can enjoy the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of DTS digital surround in your home. This system is practically distortion-free, clear 6-channel sound (technically, a left, right and center channels, two rear channels, plus an LFE 0.1 channel as a subwoofer, for a total of 5.1 channels). ■ Dolby Digital ■ Neo: 6 Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives you completely independent multi-channel audio. With three front channels (left, center and right), and two rear stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides five fullrange audio channels. With an additional channel especially for bass effects, called LFE (low frequency effect), the system has a total of 5.1 channels (LFE is counted as 0.1 channel). Using two-channel stereo for the rear speakers, more accurate moving sound effects and surround sound environment are possible than with Dolby Surround. The wide dynamic range (from maximum to minimum volume) reproduced by the five full-range channels and the precise sound orientation generated using digital sound processing provide listeners with previously unheard of excitement and realism. With this unit, any sound environment from monaural up to a 5.1-channel configuration can be freely selected for your enjoyment. Neo: 6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6 channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables playback with the full-range channels with higher separation just like digital discrete signal playback. Two modes are available; “Music mode” for playing music sources and “Cinema mode” for movies. ■ Dolby Digital Surround EX This unit is equipped with the Dolby Digital decoder that can reproduce 5.1-channel sources adding a rear center channel. (The sound to be output from a rear center speaker is created by mixing the content of rear L/R channels.) This decoder is the most suitable to reproduce the soundtrack for the movies recorded by Dolby Digital Surround EX. You can enjoy dynamic and realistic sounds by adding another channel. ■ Dolby Pro Logic Dolby Pro Logic is the improved technique to decode vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround programs. This new technology enables a discrete 5-channel playback with two left and right main channels, a center channel, and two left and right rear channels compared with one limited rear channel for the conventional Pro Logic technology. Also the music mode is available for 2channel sources in addition to the movie mode. ■ LFE 0.1 channel This channel is for the reproduction of low bass signals. The frequency range for this channel is 20 Hz to 120 Hz. This channel is counted as 0.1 because it only enforces a low frequency range compared to the full-range reproduced by the other 5 channels in a Dolby Digital or DTS 5.1 channel systems. ■ CINEMA DSP ■ SILENT CINEMA YAMAHA has developed a natural, realistic sound effect DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for headphones have been set for each sound field so that accurate representations of all the sound field programs can be enjoyed on headphones. 84 0113V2300_84-86_EN(U) 84 D I G I T A L Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect is best felt in a theater having many speakers and designed for acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can differ so widely, it’s inevitable that there are differences in the sound heard as well. Based on a wealth of actually measured data, YAMAHA CINEMA DSP uses YAMAHA original sound field technology to combine Dolby Pro Logic, Dolby Digital and DTS systems to provide the visual and audio experience of movie theater in the listening room of your own home. 02.8.9, 10:39 AM GLOSSARY ■ Virtual CINEMA DSP ■ S VIDEO signal ■ Component video signal Although component is normally connected according to jack names shown on the rear panel, this unit includes a function that assigns jacks according to the component being connected. If the component being used differs from the component name shown for this unit’s component video input jacks or digital input/output jacks, it is possible to assign jacks according to the component being connected. This makes it possible to change the jack assignment and effectively connect more component. ADVANCED OPERATION ■ PCM (Linear PCM) BASIC OPERAIONT With the component video signal system, the video signal is separated into the Y signal for the luminance and the PB/CB and PR/CR signals for the chrominance. Color can be reproduced more faithfully with this system because each of these signals is independent. The component signal is also called the “color difference signal” because the luminance signal is subtracted from the color signal. A monitor with component input jacks is required in order to use the component signal for output. ■ I/O assignment (SET MENU) PREPARATION With S VIDEO signal system, the video signal normally transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted as the Y signal for the luminance and the C signal for the chrominance through the S VIDEO cable. Using the S VIDEO jack eliminates video signal transmission loss and allows recording and playback of even more beautiful images. When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of times the signal is sampled per second is called the sampling frequency, while the degree of fineness when converting the sound level into a numeric value is called the number of quantized bits. The range of rates that can be played back is determined based on the sampling rate, while the dynamic range representing the sound level difference is determined by the number of quantized bits. In principle, the higher the sampling frequency, the wider the range of frequencies that can be played back, and the higher the number of quantized bits, the more finely the sound level can be reproduced. INTRODUCTION YAMAHA has developed a virtual CINEMA DSP algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP sound field surround effects even without any rear speakers by using virtual rear speakers. It is even possible to enjoy virtual CINEMA DSP in a minimum two-speaker system that does not include a center speaker. ■ Sampling frequency and number of quantized bits ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without using any compression. This is used as a method of recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per very small unit of time. Standing for “pulse code modulation”, the analog signal is encoded as pulses and then modulated for recording. APPENDIX English 85 0113V2300_84-86_EN(U) 85 02.8.9, 10:39 AM SPECIFICATIONS AUDIO SECTION FM SECTION • Minimum RMS Output Power for Main, Center, Rear, R. Center 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.04% THD, 8 Ω ..................................... 110 W • Tuning Range [U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................ 87.5 to 107.9 MHz [Other models] .............................................. 87.50 to 108.00 MHz • Maximum Power (EIAJ) [China and General models] 1 kHz, 10% THD, 8 Ω ......................................................... 165 W • Usable Sensitivity (IHF) ....................................... 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf) • Dynamic Power (IHF) 8/6/4/2 Ω ........................................................ 155/195/240/275 W • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF) Mono/Stereo .............................................................. 76 dB/70 dB • Damping Factor (IHF) 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 Ω ................................................... 80 or more • Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz) Mono/Stereo ................................................................. 0.2%/0.3% • Frequency Response CD to Main L/R ...................................... 10 Hz to 100 kHz, –3 dB • Stereo Separation (1 kHz) ....................................................... 45 dB • Total Harmonic Distortion 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 55 W, 8 Ω, Main L/R ................................ 0.04% • Frequency Response ........................... 20 Hz to 15 kHz +0.5, –2 dB AM SECTION • Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network) Phono MM (5 mV) to Main L/R .......................................... 86 dB CD (250 mV, shorted) to Main L/R, Effect Off .................. 100 dB • Tuning Range [U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................... 530 to 1710 kHz [Australia model] ................................................. 531 to 1611 kHz [Other models] ..................................... 530/531 to 1710/1611 kHz • Residual Noise (IHF-A Network) Main L/R ................................................................ 150 µV or less • Usable Sensitivity ............................................................. 300 µV/m • Channel Separation (1kHz/10 kHz) CD (5.1 kΩ terminated) to Main L/R ........................ 60 dB/45 dB GENERAL • Tone Control (Main L/R) BASS Boost/Cut ...................................................... ±10 dB/50 Hz TREBLE Boost/Cut ............................................... ±10 dB/20 kHz BASS EXTENSION .................................................. +6 dB/60 Hz • Phones Output ........................................................... 150 mV/100 Ω • Input Sensitivity PHONO ................................................................... 2.5 mV/47 kΩ CD, etc .................................................................... 150 mV/47 kΩ 6CH INPUT ............................................................ 150 mV/47 kΩ • Output Level REC OUT .............................................................. 150 mV/1.2 kΩ PRE OUT .................................................................. 1.0 V/1.2 kΩ SUBWOOFER .......................................................... 4.0 V/1.2 kΩ ΖΟΝΕ 2 [U.S.A., Canada and Australia models] .. 150 mV/1.5 kΩ • Power Supply [U.S.A. and Canada models] ............................... AC 120 V/60 Hz [Australia model] ................................................. AC 240 V/50 Hz [China model] ...................................................... AC 220 V/50 Hz [General model] ........................ AC 110/120/220/240 V, 50/60 Hz • Power Consumption [U.S.A. and Canada models] .................................. 440 W/550 VA [Other models] ..................................................................... 450 W Standby mode ............................................................ 1.2 W or less • AC Outlets [U.S.A. and Canada models] ...... 2 (Total 80 W /0.8 A maximum) [Australia model] ................................. 1 (Total 100 W maximum) [China and General models] .................. 2 (Total 50 W maximum) • Dimension (W x H x D) ................................... 435 x 171 x 434 mm (17-1/8" x 6-3/4" x 17-1/16") • Weight ......................................................................... 15 kg (33 lbs) VIDEO SECTION • Video Signal Type .......................................................... NTSC/PAL • Signal to Noise Ratio ............................................................... 50 dB • Frequency Response (MONITOR OUT) Composite, S-Video ................................. 5 Hz to 10 MHz, –3 dB Component ................................................. DC to 60 MHz, –3 dB 86 0113V2300_84-86_EN(U) 86 02.8.9, 10:39 AM U RX-V2300 AV Receiver YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA YAMAHA ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, USA 6660 ORANGETHORPE AVE., BUENA PARK, CALIF. 90620, U.S.A. CANADA MUSIC LTD. 135 MILNER AVE., SCARBOROUGH, ONTARIO M1S 3R1, CANADA ELECTRONIK EUROPA G.m.b.H. SIEMENSSTR. 22-34, 25462 RELLINGEN BEI HAMBURG, F.R. OF GERMANY ELECTRONIQUE FRANCE S.A. RUE AMBROISE CROIZAT BP70 CROISSY-BEAUBOURG 77312 MARNE-LA-VALLEE CEDEX02, FRANCE ELECTRONICS (UK) LTD. YAMAHA HOUSE, 200 RICKMANSWORTH ROAD WATFORD, HERTS WD1 7JS, ENGLAND SCANDINAVIA A.B. J A WETTERGRENS GATA 1, BOX 30053, 400 43 VÄSTRA FRÖLUNDA, SWEDEN Printed MUSIC AUSTRALIA PTY, LTD. 17-33 MARKET ST., SOUTH MELBOURNE, 3205 VIC., AUSTRALIA 0100V2300(U)-cv1/4 1 OWNER’S MANUAL in Malaysia V958390-2 2002.10.17, 12:00
1 / 1

Yamaha RX-V2300 de handleiding

Categorie
Ontvanger
Type
de handleiding